ARMY TM 9-2320-289-20 Mantainance Truck (Chevy) 1 - TON 4X4 Tactical Nov95
ARMY TM 9-2320-289-20 Mantainance Truck (Chevy) 1 - TON 4X4 Tactical Nov95
ARMY TM 9-2320-289-20 Mantainance Truck (Chevy) 1 - TON 4X4 Tactical Nov95
TM 9-2320-289-20
ARMY TM 9-2320-289-20
AIR FORCE TO 36A12-1A-2082-1
MARINE CORPS TM 2320-20/2
Supersedes Copy Dated April 1983
See Page i For Details
TM 9-2320-289-20
TO 36A12-1A-2082-1
TM 2320-20/2
C4
File this change sheet in front of the publication for reference purposes.
Approved for public release; distribution is unlimited.
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
DENNIS J. REIMER
General, United States Army
Official: Chief of Staff
YVONNE M. HARRISON
Administrative Assistant to the
Secretary of the Army
01227
RONALD R. FOGLEMAN
General, United States Air Force
Chief of Staff
Official:
DISTRIBUTION:
To be distributed in accordance with DA Form 12-38-E, block 0370, requirements for
TM 9-2320-289-20.
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
TO 36A12-1A-2082-1
TM 2320-20/2
C3
3. File this change sheet in the front of the publication for information purposes.
GORDON R. SULLIVAN
General, United States Army
Chief of Staff
Official:
MILTON H. HAMILTON
Administrative Assistant to the
Secretary of the Army
04027
RONALD W. YATES
General, United States Air Force
Commander, Air Force Logistics Command
Distribution:
To be distributedin accordance with DA Form 12–38–E (Block 0370) requirements for TM9–2320–289–20.
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2330-289-20.
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
WARNING
Carbon monoxide is without color or smell, but can kill you. Breathing air with carbon monoxide
produces symptoms of headache, dizziness, loss of muscular control, a sleepy feeling, and coma.
Brain damage or death can result from heavy exposure. Carbon monoxide occurs in the exhaust
fumes of fuel-burning heaters and internal combustion engines. Carbon monoxide can become
dangerously concentrated under conditions of no air movement. Precautions must be followed to
ensure crew safety when personnel heater or main or auxiliary engines of any truck are operated for
any purpose.
Warning a
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
WARNING
ACCELERATOR SYSTEM
Use extreme caution to ensure that clothing or tools DO NOT get caught in truck’s operating
drivebelts. Failure to follow this warning may result in serious injury to personnel or equipment
damage.
WARNING
BATTERY SYSTEM
Battery acid (electrolyte) is extremely dangerous. Always wear goggles and rubber gloves when
performing battery checks or inspections. Serious injury to personnel will result if battery acid
contacts skin or eyes.
DO NOT perform battery system checks or inspections while smoking or near fire, flames, or
sparks. Batteries may explode, causing serious injury or death to personnel.
Rotate cover to underside of clamp as each cable is disconnected. Remove all jewelry such as
dog tags, rings, bracelets, etc. If jewelry or disconnected battery ground cable contacts battery
terminal, a direct short will result. Failure to follow proper disconnection procedures will result in
serious injury or death to personnel or equipment damage.
Both negative battery cables must be disconnected before removing any electrical system
components. Failure to follow this warning may result in serious injury or death to personnel.
DO NOT charge, test, or slave start battery when built-in hydrometer shows clear or light yellow.
An explosion may occur causing serious injury or death to personnel.
WARNING
Radiator grille guard is heavy. Failure to use an assistant during removal or installation may cause
serious injury to personnel.
Support bumper during removal or installation. If dropped, it may cause serious injury to
personnel.
Warning b
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
WARNING
Use extreme caution when removing rear door assembly (M1010). Rear door assembly is heavy
and if dropped will cause equipment damage and serious injury to personnel.
Wear heavy gloves when handling glass to avoid risk of injury. If glass is cracked but still intact,
crisscross it with masking tape to reduce risk of injury to personnel.
Ambulance attendant’s seat stem assembly is spring loaded. Carefully raise and lower
attendant’s seat to avoid risk of injury to personnel.
Only authorized and trained personnel are to remove and service gas-particulate filters that have
been used in an NBC environment. See local SOP for disposing of contaminated filters. Failure to
follow this warning may result in serious illness or death to personnel.
Special protective clothing (see TM 10-277) must be used and special safety measures and
decontamination procedures (see FM 3-5) must be followed when replacing contaminated filters.
Failure to follow this warning may result in serious illness or death to personnel.
WARNING
BRAKE SYSTEM
DO NOT use a dry brush or compressed air to clean brake shoes, brake pads, or brake
components. There may be asbestos dust on brake shoes, brake pads or brake components
which can be dangerous to you if you breathe it. Brake shoes, brake pads, and brake
components must be wet, and a soft brush must be used. Failure to follow this warning may result
in serious illness or death to personnel.
Always wear goggles when bleeding brakes. Failure to follow this warning may result in serious
eye injury.
Always wear goggles during removal and installation of brake shoe springs. Failure to follow this
warning may result in serious eye injury.
Cautiouslv feel each wheel hub and brake drum. Wheel hub or brake drum may be hot. Failure to
follow this warning may result in burns.
Warning c
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
WARNING
CLEANING AGENTS
Dry cleaning solvent P-D-680 is toxic and flammable. Always wear protective goggles and gloves
and use only in a well-ventilated area. Avoid contact with skin, eyes, and clothes and DO NOT
breathe vapors. DO NOT use near open flame or excessive heat. The solvent’s flash point is
10O°F-138°F (38°C-59°C). If you become dizzy while using cleaning solvent, immediately get
fresh air and medical help. If solvent contacts eyes, immediately wash your eyes with water and
get medical aid.
Compressed air used when checking for restrictions or cleaning purposes should never exceed
30 psi (207 kPa). Use only effective chip guarding and personnel protective equipment
(goggles/shield, gloves, etc.). Failure to follow this warning may result in serious injury to
personnel.
WARNING
COOLING SYSTEM
Servicing of engine cooling system should only be performed on a cool engine. Never remove a
clamp or hose when engine is hot. Pressurized steam or hot water will cause serious burns.
Wait for pressure release before removing radiator cap, Pressurized steam or hot water will cause
serious burns.
Never remove radiator cap when engine is hot. Pressurized steam or hot water will cause serious
burns.
DO NOT repair and reuse a fan with a bent or damaged blade. Replace fan as an assembly. A
damaged fan is out of balance and may fall apart during use causing serious injury or death to
personnel.
WARNING
EXHAUST SYSTEM
Before attempting to inspect or service any part of exhaust system, allow exhaust system to cool.
Failure to follow this warning will result in serious burns.
Warning d
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
WARNING
FUEL SYSTEM
Diesel fuel is flammable. When disconnecting fuel lines to test fuel flow, direct fuel spray away
from source of ignition. A fire extinguisher must be on hand in work area. Failure to follow this
warning may result in serious injury or death to personnel,
A!low engine to cool before replacing drainback hose or pipe assembly. Failure to follow this
warning may result in serious burns.
Diesel fuel is flammable, DO NOT perform procedures near fire, flames, or sparks. A fire
extinguisher must be on hand in work area. Failure to follow this warning may result in serious
injury or death.
Always wear goggles when working on underside of truck. Fuel and hydraulic fluid spillage can
occur. Failure to follow this warning may result in serious eye injury.
WARNING
STARTER SYSTEM
Support starter during removal and installation. Failure to support starter may cause it to fall,
resulting in injury to personnel.
WARNING
TRANSMISSION
Always wear goggles when working on underside of truck. Hydraulic fluid spillage can occur when
removing transmission oil pan. Failure to follow this warning may result in serious eye injury.
Warning e
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
WARNING
WHEELS
Position wheel chocks at front and rear of tires opposite axle to be raised. Truck must be on level
surface before attempting to remove wheel. Failure to follow this warning may result in serious
injury or death to personnel.
All air must be removed from tire before removing tire from wheel rim. Failure to follow this
warning may result in serious injury to personnel.
The tapered end of inner bearing assembly must be facing toward the outboard (cap end) of the
axle shaft. The tapered end of the outer wheel bearing assembly must be facing toward the
inboard (splined end) of the axle shaft. Failure to follow this warning may force wheel off truck
during operation, causing serious injury or death to personnel.
Splash shield and caliper bracket are factory-installed with 6 locknuts and washers. Refer to
TM 9-2320-289-20P for proper replacement parts. Using improper replacement parts may cause
caliper to fall off during operation, resulting in serious injury or death to personnel.
Use extreme caution when lowering or raising spare tire and carrier. Spare tire is heavy. Dropping
it may result in serious injury to personnel.
Warning f
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
* TM 9-2320-289-20
(Army) You can help improve this manual. If you find any mistakes or if you know of a way to
improve the procedures, please let us know. Mail your letter, DA Form 2028 ( R e c o m m e n d e d
Changes to Publications and Blank Forms), or DA Form 2028-2, located in the back of this manual,
direct to: Commander, U.S. Army Tank-Automotive Command, ATTN: AMSTA-MB, Warren, Ml
48397-5000. (Marine Corps) Submit NAVMC 10772 to the Commanding General, Marine Corps
Logistic Base (Code 850), Albany, GA 31704, A reply will be furnished to y O U.
TABLE OF CONTENTS
Page
Change 2 i
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
3-1
ii
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
Glossary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Glossary 1
Alphabetical Index . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Index 1
Foldouts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ..... FP-1
iii/(iv blank)
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
This manual is designed to help operate and maintain the CUCV Series trucks. This manual
describes in detail the Unit Maintenance prescribed by the Maintenance Allocation Chart
(Appendix B) and Source, Maintenance, and Recoverability (SMR) Codes (TM 9-2320-289-20P).
Bleed-to-edge indicators on the cover and on the edge of applicable manual pages
provide quick access to chapters and sections most often used.
WARNING S, CAUTIONS, NOTES, subject headings, and other important information are
highlighted in BOLD print as a visual aid.
Statements and words of particular importance are printed in capital letters to create
emphasis.
Instructions are located together with figures that illustrate the specific task you are
working on. In many cases, the task steps and illustrations are located side-by-side,
making identification and procedure sequence easier to follow.
Quickly read through this manual and become familiar with its contents before
proceeding to specific maintenance tasks.
A warning summary is provided at the beginning of this manual and should be read
before performing any maintenance tasks.
In the actual maintenance tasks, follow all WARNING S, CAUTIONS, and NOTES. These
are given immediately preceding the procedural steps to which they apply. If these
instructions are not followed, or care is not taken, you may injure yourself or cause
equipment damage.
Within a chapter, section, or paragraph, headings are used to help mount the material
and assist you in quickly finding tasks. Read all preliminary information found at the
beginning of each task. After completing a task, ALWAYS perform the follow-on
maintenance at the end of the task.
The operator of a CUCV truck complains that the truck engine cranks but will not start. The
truck has been assigned to you for repair. To correct the problem you will need to follow these steps:
Turn to the cover of your manual. On the right margin, find the listing for
Troubleshooting and turn to the page listing given. When you reach the troubleshooting
section, locate the paragraph entitled Troubleshooting Symptom Index (paragraph
2-11).
v
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
Read through the index until you find a symptom listing which most closely matches the
problem. The symptom “Cranks But Will Not Start” is found under the “ENGINE”
category of mechanical troubleshooting. Turn to the page for the troubleshooting
procedure that will help solve your problem.
Follow the instructions for each “Step” listed in the troubleshooting procedure. Start
with Step 1 and proceed in order until you reach the step where a problem is actually
found. In this case, let’s assume that steps 1-5 are performed without difficulty, Step 6
reveals that the problem is with the fuel pump. The Corrective Action for Step 6 tells
you where in the manual to go to correct the problem: “If fuel flow is insufficient,
replace fuel pump. (See paragraph 3-10).”
Paragraph 3-10 is located in Chapter 3. Using the Tab/e of Contents, find the listings for
Chapter 3. Because the fuel pump is part of the fuel system, you would proceed to
Section II, Fuel System Maintenance. The index at the beginning of Section II will tell you
on which page paragraph 3-10 is located,
Paragraph 3-10 is the maintenance procedure for replacing the fuel pump. Carefully
read through the procedure, follow all instructions, and perform all steps in the proper
sequence. When you have finished the last step, you will have replaced the fuel pump,
When maintenance instructions in this manual instruct you to use RTV sealant (Item 41,
Appendix C), wait a minimum of 15 minutes before installing the part or assembly to allow the RTV
sealant to cure.
Maintenance tasks in this manual do not allow for trucks which may have swingfire heaters
installed. If the truck you are working on has a swingfire heater, you may have to disconnect the
heater’s components to obtain access to other components if interference exists.
vi
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
CHAPTER 1
INTRODUCTION
1-1. SCOPE.
a. This manual contains instructions for the performance of maintenance of CUCV Series
trucks at the unit level. Models inciuded are:
(1) M1008, Truck, Cargo, Tactical, 1¼ Ton, 4x4
(2) M1008A1 , Truck, Cargo, Tactical, 1¼ Ton, 4x4
(3) M1009, Truck, Utility, Tactical, ¾ Ton, 4x4
(4) M1010, Truck, Ambulance, Tactical, 1¼ Ton, 4x4
(5) M1028, Truck, Shelter Carrier, Tactical, 1¼ Ton, 4x4
(6) M1028A1, Truck, Shelter Carrier w/PTO, Tactical, 1¼ Ton, 4x4
(7) M1028A2, Truck, Shelter Carrier w/PTO, Tactical, 1¼ Ton, 4x4
(8) M1028A3, Truck, Sheller Carrier, Tactical, 1¼ Ton, 4x4
(9) M1031, Truck, Chassis, Tactical, 1¼ Ton, 4x4
b. Other manuals which may be referred to should be considered a part of this manual.
Department of the Army forms and procedures used for equipment maintenance will be
those prescribed by DA Pam 738-750, The Army Maintenance Management System (TAMMS).
The nomenclature, names, and designations used in this manual are consistent with official
usage. All hardware, assemblies, and subassemblies are named according to the nomenclature used
in TM 9-2320-289-20P.
If your CUCV Series truck needs improvement, let us know. Send us an EIR. You, the user,
are the only one who can tell us what you don’t like about your equipment. Let us know why you don’t
Change 2 1-1
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
like the design or performance. Put it on an SF 368 (Quality Deficiency Report). Mail it to us at:
Commander, U.S. Army Tank-Automotive Command, ATTN: AMSTA-QRD, Warren, MI 48397-5000.
We’ll send you a reply.
The equipment described herein contains metric components and requires the use of metric
tools; therefore, metric units, in addition to standard units, will be used throughout this manual.
Standard units will be given first with the equivalent metric unit in parentheses, for instance: 7000 lb.
(3178 kg). A metric conversion chart is located on the inside back cover of this manual.
a. For authorized common tools, refer to the Common Table of Allowance (CTA) and the
Modified Table of Organization and Equipment (MTOE) applicable to your unit.
b. For special tools, and Test, Measurement, and Diagnostic Equipment (TMDE), refer to
the Repair Parts and Special Took List (RPSTL) manual, TM 9-2320-289-20P, and the Maintenance
Allocation Chart (MAC) in Appendix B of this manual.
c. Repair parts are listed and illustrated in the Repair Parts and Special Tools List (RPSTL)
manual, TM 9-2320-289-20P.
d. Torque wrenches are normally marked with a measurement term ft. -lb. or in. -lb. T h e
terms used within this manual are lb. -ft. or lb. -in., unless otherwise noted in the text.
1-2 Change 1
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
a, These trucks are commercial vehicles suitable for use on all types of roads and limited
off-road operations.
b. They are capable of occasional hardbottom fording to a depth of 16 in. (41 cm) at 5 mi/h
(8 km/h) for not more than 3 minutes, without stalling the engine, causing permanent damage to
components, or requiring immediate maintenance.
c. Commercial Utility Cargo Vehicle features include:
(1) 379 cu in. (6.2 I) diesel V-8 engine
(2) automatic transmission (Hydra-matic 400) with 3 forward and 1 reverse speeds
(3) manually activated transfer case for four-wheel drive operations
(4) hydraulically activated, power-assisted front disc and rear drum service brakes
(5) 12/24 volt electrical system
(6) NATO slave cable receptacle
(7) winterization kit available for each model
(8) multi-purpose tow hooks on front and rear bumpers and swivel-type pintles on rear
bumper to permit tie-down of vehicle or towing
d. Cargo Truck. The M1008, M1008A1, M10028, M1028A1, M1028A2, and M1028A3 1¼
ton, 4x4, cargo trucks are light commercial trucks designed to provide standard tactical mobility and
to carry cargo or passengers. The M1008 and M1008A1 can be equipped with troop seats to
accommodate eight personnel. The M1008A1 includes a 100 amp/24 v communications kit. The M1028
has a 100 amp/24 v electrical system, and will accept an S250 communications shelter and a
communications kit. The M1028A1 is equipped with a New Process Model 205 transfer case which
allows for the addition of a power take-off (PTO) unit. Some M1028s have been equipped with
heavy-duty electrical systems that incorporate the M1010 200 amp/24 v electrical system and air
conditioner fixtures. These M1028s have not been provided with a different designation. The M1028A2
is an M1028A1 which has been converted to rear dual wheel configuration. The M1028A3 is an M1028
which has been converted to a rear dual wheel shelter carrier configuration and is equipped with a New
Process 208 Transfer Case.
Change 2 1-3
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
e. Utility Truck. The M1009 is a ¾ ton truck that has an enclosed body and can be used for
command and control purposes.
f. Ambulance. The M1010 is designed to carry a maximum of four litter or eight ambulatory
patients with both upper litters in place. It is equipped with a 200 amp/24 v electrical system, which
supports a gas-particulate filter unit (GPFU) system, a patient compartment air conditioner, and a
fuel-fired compartment heater. It has mounting provisions inside the cab for the AN-GRC-60 radio. The
AS-1729/GRC antenna is mounted outside on the front of the patient compartment.
TA49618
1-4
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
g. Chassis Truck. The M1031 is a chassis and cab combination, which is designed for the
mounting of special bodies as required. It is equipped with a New Process Model 205 transfer case,
which allows for the addition of a power take-off (PTO) unit.
1-5
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
For information on the operation of the major components outlined below, see the
Operator’s Manual, TM 9-2320-289-10.
1-6
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
* TR&3e Iteme are not etandard equipment, but the Indicated trucks may be equipped as shown.
@ * se~oted M 1028 trucks only.
See TM 9-2320-289-10 for the location and contents of warning, caution, and data plates.
1-7
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
Vehicle performance data for the CUCV Series trucks is listed in the table below.
DATA MODEL
M1OO8 M1028
M1008A1 Ml 009 M100 M1028A1 M1031
Weights:
Curb 5900 lb 5200 lb 7370 lb 5800 lb 5250 lb
(2679 kg) (2361 kg) (3346 kg) (2633 kg) (2384 kg)
Payload/ 2900 lb 1200 lb 2080 lb 3600 lb 3950 lb
Passengers (1317 kg) (545 kg) (944 kg) (1634 kg) (1793 kg)
GVWR 8800 lb 6400 lb 9450 lb 9400 lb 9200 lb max
(3995 kg) (2906 kg) (4290 kg) (4268 kg) (4177 kg)
GAWR (front) 4500 lb 3600 lb 4500 lb 4500 lb 4500 lb
(2043 kg) (1634 kg) (2043 kg) (2043 kg) (2043 kg)
GAWR (rear) 7500 lb 3750 lb 7500 lb 7500 lb 7500 lb
(3405 kg) (1703 kg) (3405 kg) (3405 kg) (3405 kg)
Engine:
Type 90-degree 90-degree 90-degree 90-degree 90-degree
V8 Diesel V8 Diesel V8 Diesel V8 Diesel V8 Diesel
Piston 379 cu in 379 cu in 379 cu In 379 cu in 379 cu in
Displacement (6.2 I) (6.2 I) (6.2 I) (6.2 I) (6.2 I)
SAE Net 135 hp @ 135 hp @ 135 hp @ 135 hp @ 135 hp @
Horsepower 3600 rpm 3600 rpm 3600 rpm 3600 rpm 3600 rpm
1-8
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
DATA MODEL
M1008 M1028
M1008A1 M1009 M1010 M1028A1 M1031
Fuel System:
Low-pressure Mechanical Mechanical Mechianical Mechanical Mechanical
Lift Pump Lift Pump Lift Pump Lift Pump Lift Pump
High-pressure Stanadyne Stanadyne Stanadyne Stanadyne Stanadyne
Model DB2 Model DB2 Model DB2 Model DB2 Model DB2
Injection Nozzle Bosch Bosch Bosch Bosch Bosch
Fuel Tank 20 gal 27 gal 20 gal 20 gal 20 gal
Capacity (75.7 I) (102.2 I) (75.7 I) (75.7 I) (75.7 I)
Electrical System 12/24 volt 12/24 volt 1 2/24 volt 12/24 Volt 12/24 volt
Charging System 100 amp/ 100 amp/ 200 amp/ 100 amp/ 100 amp/
28 volt 28 volt 28 volt 28 volt 28 volt
Transmission:
Type Automatic Automatic Automatic Automatic Automatic
GM THM 400 GM THM 400 GM THM 400 GM THM 400 GM THM 400
Lubrication 19 pt 19 pt 19pt 19pt 19 pt
Capacity (9 I) (9 I) (9 I) (9 I) (9 I)
Transfer Case:
Model New Process New Process New Process New Process New Process
Model 208 Model 208 Model 208 Model 208 or Model 205
Model 205
Speed 2-speed 2-speed 2-speed 2-speed 2-speed
Ratios 2.61 & 1.00 2.61 & 1.00 2.61 & 1.00 2.61 & 1.00 1.96 & 1.00
or 1.96 &
1.00
Lubrication 5 qt 5 qt 5 qt 5 qt (4.8 I) 2 qt
Capacity (4.8 I) (4.8 I) (4.8 I) or 2 qt (2.5 I) (2.5 I)
Front Axle:
Type Full-floating Semi-floating Full-floatlng Full-floating Full-floating
Differential Type Two-pinion Two-pinion Two-pinion Two-pinIon Two-pinion
Lubrication 4.5 pt 4.5 pt 4.5 pt 4.5 pt 4.5 pt
Capacity (2.13 1) (2.13 I) (2.13 I) (2.13 I) (2.13 I)
Rear Axle:
Type Full-floating Semi-floatlng Full-floating Full-floatlng Full-floating
Differential Type Four-pinIon Two-pinion Four-pinion Four-pinion Four-pinion
No-spin Locking No-spin No-spin No-spin
Lubrication 5.4 pt 5.4 pt 5.4 pt 5.4 pt 5.4 pt
Capacity (2.1 I) (2.1 I) (2.1 I) (2.1 I) (2.1 I)
Service Brake:
Front Disc Disc Disc Disc Disc
Rear Drum Drum Drum Drum Drum
1-9
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
DATA DATA
M1028A2 M1028A3 M1028A2 M1028A3
Weights: Rear Axle @ GVWR 7.7 in 7.7 in
(19.6 cm) (19,6 cm)
Curb 6120 lb 6120 lb
(2778 kg) (2778 kg)
Front Axle @ GVWR 8.6 in 8.6 in
Payload/ 3940 lb 3940 lb (21,8 cm) (21.8 cm)
Passengers (1789 kg) (1789 kg)
Height (overall) 107,1 in * 107.1 in *
GVWR 10,120 lb max 10,120 lb rmax
@ Curb (272 cm) (272 cm)
(4594 kg) (4594 kg)
GAWR (front) 3900 lb 3900 lb Length (overall) 220.7 in 220.7 in
(1770 kg) (1770 kg) (560.6 cm) (560.6 cm)
GAWR (rear) 6220 lb 6220 lb
Width (overall) 95.8 in 95,8 in
(2824 kg) (2824 kg)
(243.3 cm) (243.3 cm)
Wheelbase 131,5 in 131.5 in
Engine:
(334 cm) (334 cm)
Type 90-degree 90-degree
Track (front) 67.8 in 67.8 in V8 Diesel V8 Diesel
(172 cm) (172 cm)
Piston 379 cu in 379 cu in
Displacement (6.2 I) (6.2 I)
Track (rear) 75,8 in 75,8 in
(193 cm) (193 cm) SAE Net 135 bhp @ 135 bhp @
Horsepower 3600 rpm 3600 rpm
Ground Clearance 10.7 in 10.7 in
(to T/C skid plate (27.2 cm) (27.2 cm)
@ GVWR)
1-10 Change 2
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
DATA DATA
M1028A2 M1028A3 M1028A2 M1028A3
Fuel System: Transfer Case
(Con’t):
Low-pressure Mechanical Mechanical
Lift Pump Lift Pump Ratios 1.96 & 1.00 2.61 & 1.00
High-pressure Stanadyne Stanadyne Lubrication 2 qt 5 qt
Model DB2 Model DB2 Capacity (2.5 1) (4.6 I)
Injection Nozzle Bosch Bosch Front Axle:
Fuel Tank 20 gal 20 gal Type Full Floating Full Floating
Capacity (75.7 I) (75.7 I)
Differential Type Two-pinion Two-pinion
Electrical System 12124 volt 12124 volt Lubrication 4.5 pt 4,5 pt
Capacity (2.1 I) (2.1 I)
Charging System 100 amp/ 100 amp/
28 volt 28 volt Rear Axle:
Transmission: Type Full Floating Full Floating
Type Automatic Automatic Differential Type Four-pinion Four-pinion
GM THM 400 GM THM 400 No-spin No-spin
Lubrication 19 pt 19 pt Lubrication 5.4 pt 5.4 pt
Capacity (9I) (9 I) Capacity (2.1 1) (2.1 I)
TM 9-2320-289-20
Paragraph Page
Number System Number
Change 1 1-11
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
a. Functions to convert horsepower frorn engine into mechanical force needed to move
truck.
(1) Engine:
(2) Transmission:
(a) GM Hydra-matic 400 automatic with neutral, reverse, and 3 forward gears.
(b) Provides operator with a selection of gear ranges while holding engine
speeds within effective torque range.
(c) Includes a 3-element torque converter and a compound planetary gear set
with clutches and bands controlled by hydraulic system.
(a) All trucks, except M1028A1 , M1028A2, and Ml 031, are equipped with a New
Process Model 238 transfer case.
(b) M1028A1 , M1028A2, and M1031 are equipped with a New Process Model
205 transfer case, which is designed to accommodate installation of a power
take-off (PTO) unit (uses engine power to run auxiliary equipment).
(c) Directs engine-to-transmission power to rear wheels for two-wheel drive or
to front and rear wheels for four-wheel drive.
(d) Manually locking hubs must be set by hand to “LOCK” position before
shifting from two-wheel to four-wheel drive operation.
(e) Bolted directly to an adapter plate behind transmission. No intermediate
propeller shaft needed.
(a) Transmit driving force from transer case to front and rear axle differentials.
(b) Slip joints are installed to compensate for varying lengths of propeller shafts.
(c) Universal joints compensate for changes in drive angle of propeller shafts.
1-12 Change 1
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
(a) Stanadyne Model DB2 Fuel Injector Pump. Delivers high-pressure fuel
from injector pump to nozzles.
(b) Nozzles. Provide high-pressure fuel to each cylinder.
b. Fuel return system delivers excess fuel from the injector pump and injector nozzles
back to the truck’s fuel tank. Fuel lines provide fuel to and from the fuel tank and injector pump.
1-13
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
a. Cooling System. Engine is liquid-cooled by means of coolant flow through radiator and
hoses.
d. Coolant Flow. The following illustration shows flow of coolant from radiator to engine.
b. Standard System. 100 amp, 12/24 v electrical system. includes two 12 v batteries
(Delco 1200 or military-type 6TN) in series and two 100 amp alternators (Delco 27-S1).
c. M1010 Ambulance and Selected M1028 System. 200 amp, 12/24 v system, using 2
batteries (Delco 1200 or military-type 6TN) and 2 Leece/Neville alternators,
d. Starting Motor. Heavy-duty 24 v 27MT starting motor, with increased strength pinion
and ring gear teeth.
TA49622
1-14
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
e. Glow Plugs. Operate as part of electrical system and assist in engine starting in cold
weather. Temperature self-regulating AC 13G glow plugs preheat air in precombustion chambers
prior to combustion. Glow plugs are energized prior to engine cranking for a “pre-glow” period and
remain on shortly after engine startup for an “after glow” period.
(1) Service Lights. Standard vehicle lights, including headlights, taillights, turn
indicators, and hazard warning.
(2) Blackout Lights. A military adaptation of the CUCV truck provides for driving
during hours of limited visibility when service lights are not appropriate.
(3) Toggle Switch. Lights are controlled by 2 toggle switches on the instrument
panel. When switches are in blackout mode, all exterior service lights, horn,
taillights, stoplights, seat belt buzzer, and hazard warning flashers are inoperable
while instrument panel warning signals remain functional.
(4) M1010 Ambulance Lighting. In addition to standard service and blackout lights:
Standard Heater/Defroster System. Consists of blower and air inlet assembly, heater and
defroster distributor assembly, and heater control assembly. Used to clear windshield of fog or ice
and maintain a comfortable temperature level inside cab of truck. The system will maintain a
temperature of 60°F (15°C) at floor level, at a -10°F (-23°C) ambient.
1-15
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
(1) Parking Brake. Able to hold truck, loaded to specified Gross Vehicle Weight
Rating (GVWR), motionless on a 30% grade that is dry, hard, and free of loose
material.
(2) Service Brakes. Hydraulically activated, power-assisted front disc and rear drum
brakes.
(1) Power Steering Pump. Supplies hydraulic power to the power booster.
(2) Power Booster. Transmits hydraulic power to the brake master cylinder.
(3) Master Cylinder. Sends hydraulic power to both front and rear brakes, from 1 of
2 chambers.
(4) Brake Lines. Carry hydraulic fluid from master cylinder to brake mechanisms at
wheels.
TA49623
1-16
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
(a) Limits pressure to front disc brakes until a predetermined front input
pressure is reached, which allows for the overcoming of the rear shoe
retractor spring pressure.
(b) Proportions outlet pressure to rear brakes after a predetermined rear input
pressure has been reached.
(c) A bypass feature assuring full system pressure to rear brakes in the event
of front brake malfunction.
(6) Height Sensing, Brake Proportioning Valve (All Except M1009). Provides
optimum brake balance and efficiency by distributing braking force to front and
rear wheels as determined by payload.
b. The following illustration shows, in simplified form, how the steering system works.
TA49624
1-17
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
a. Suspension System. Composed of springs, torsion bars, shock absorbers, axles, and
wheels.
(1) 3-stage Multileaf and Auxiliary Spring. M1028, M1028A1, and M1031 trucks.
(2) 2-stage Multileaf Springs. All other models.
(3) Heavy-duty Shock Absorbers.
d. Differentials. Provide equal traction to each wheel and, at the same time, permit each
of them to run ahead or lag behind the other, as may be required, in rounding curves or riding over
obstructions.
(1) All Except M1009. One-piece design, 16 in. x 6.50 in. wheels and
LT235/85R-16E steel-belted radial blackwall tires.
(2) M1009. One-piece design, 15 in. x 8 in. wheels and 10.00R-15C steel-belted
radial blackwall tires.
a. Winterization Kit Heaters. Available for CUCV Series trucks for severe cold weather
areas. Three heaters are available for installation:
b. Heater Control Panel. Located on right side of instrument panel and controls both
underhood heaters.
a. Air Conditioner. Provides cooling for the patient compartment allowing for a
temperature of 77°F (25°C) to be maintained with full patient load plus attendant [at 30 mi/h and
125°F (52°C) outside ambient temperature after 1 hour).
1-18
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
b. Air Conditioner Blower. Provides ventilation using outside air when conditions do not
warrant the use of the air conditioner.
c. Air Conditioner Control Panel. Located inside patient compartment above patient
compartment front door. Allows attendant to vary the temperature and function of the air conditioner.
d. Personnel Heater. Provides heated air to patient compartment during periods of cold
temperatures. Basic heater is the same heater used for warm air function in a winterized truck. After 1
hour of operation, 70°F can be maintained in ambient temperatures down to -50 o F (-46°C).
e. Personnel Heater Control Panel. Located under lower right side litter berth and controls
the functioning of the heater,
f. Gas-Particulate Filter Unit (GPFU) System. In an NBC environment, provides each crew
and patient station with clean, filtered, breathable air that is heated (if needed) to a comfortable
temperature and free of toxic agents. The protective mask and filter will NOT protect against carbon
monoxide.
a. M1028A2 and M1028A3 are shelter carriers converted to dual rear wheels. This provides
greater load carrying capability and increased stability,
b. Axles are heavier and dual wheels spread loads more evenly.
TM 9-2320-289-20
CHAPTER 2
SERVICE AND TROUBLESHOOTING INSTRUCTIONS
2-1. GENERAL.
Upon receipt of a new truck, it must be determined whether the truck has been properly
prepared for service. Follow the inspection instructions found in paragraph 2-2. Read the servicing
instructions found in paragraph 2-3 and follow any that apply to the truck to be serviced. See
TM 9-2320-289-10 when checking equipment for proper operation. Before conducting the inspections
and services listed below, perform the following preliminary servicing:
WARNING
a. Use dry cleaning solvent (Item 15, Appendix C) to clean all exterior surfaces coated
with rust-preventive compounds. Remove all protective materials used on the truck during shipment,
b. Remove all tape and wrappings from the engine, crankcase breathers, intake and
exhaust openings, transmission, alternator, and brakes.
a. Perform the semiannual preventive maintenance checks and services listed in Section II
of this chapter.
b. Make a complete visual inspection of the truck to see that the required publications,
Basic Issue Items (Bll), and accessories are present.
a. If any truck system does not operate properly, refer to the troubleshooting instructions
found in Section Ill of this chapter.
2-1
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
d. Lubricate the truck and change/adjust fluids in accordance with LO 9-2320-289-12 and
PMCS in Section II of this chapter.
2-2
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
CHAPTER 2
SERVICE AND TROUBLESHOOTING INSTRUCTIONS
Section l. REPAIR PARTS, SPECIALTOOLS, TEST, MEASUREMENT,AND
DIAGNOSTIC EQUIPMENT (TMDE), AND SUPPORT EQUIPMENT
2-4. GENERAL
a. Upon receipt of a new, used, or reconditioned vehicle, you must determine if the vehicle has been prop-
erly prepared for service. The following steps should be followed:
(1) Inspect all assemblies, subassemblies, and accessories to be sure they are in proper working or-
der.
(2) Secure, clean, lubricate, or adjust as needed.
(3) Check all Basic Issue Items (TM 9-2320 -289-10) to be sure every item is present, in good condi-
tion, and properly mounted, or stowed.
(4) Follow general procedures for all services and inspections given in TM 9-2320-289-10.
b. The operator will assist when performing service upon receipt inspections.
c. See TM 9-2320-289-10 when checking equipment for proper operation.
d. Refer to TM 9-2320-289-10 for information concerning brake-in procedures.
Drycleaning solvent is flammable and will not be used near an open flame. A fire extinguisher
will be kept nearby when the solvent is used. Use only in well-ventilated places. Failure to do
this may result in injury to personnel and/or damage to equipment.
(2) Clean all exterior surfaces coated with rust-preventive compounds. Use drycleaning solvent (Ap-
pendix C, Item 15).
2-3
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
(3) Clean fittings before lubrication. Clean parts with drycleaning solvent (SD), Type II, or equivalent.
Dry before lubricating. Dotted arrow points indicate lubrication on both sides of equipment. A dotted circle
indicates a drain below. Relubricate all items found contaminated after fording.
(4) Read “Processing and Reprocessing Record of Shipping, Storage, and Issue of Vehicles and
Spare Engines,” tag (DD Form 1397) and follow all precautions listed. This tag should be attached to steering
wheel, steering column, or rotary switch.
The following steps should be taken while performing specific inspections and services:
(1) Do the Semiannual (S) preventive maintenance checks and services listed in Section Ill in this
chapter.
(2) Lubricate the vehicle. Do not lubricate gear cases and engine unless processing tab states that the
oil is unsuitable for 500 miles (805 km) operation. If oil is suitable, just check level.
(3) Schedule semiannual service on DD Form 314 (Preventive Maintenance Schedule and Record
Card).
(4) If vehicle is delivered with a dry charged battery, activate it according to TM 9-6140-200-14.
(5) Check vehicle coolant level and determine if solution is proper for climate (refer to TB 750-651 for
preparation of antifreeze solutions).
2-7. GENERAL
The best way to maintain vehicles covered by this manual is to inspect them on a regular basis so minor faults
can be discovered and corrected before they result in serious damage, failure, or injury. All intervals are
based on normal operation. Hard time intervals maybe shortened if your lubricants are contaminated or if you
are operating the equipment under adverse conditions, including longer-than-usual operating hours. Hard
time intervals may be extended during periods of low activity, though adequate preservation precautions must
be taken. This section contains systematic instructions of inspection, adjustment, lubrication, and correction
of vehicle components to avoid costly repairs or major breakdowns. This is Preventive Maintenance Checks
and Services (PMCS).
2-8. INTERVALS
a. Unit maintenance, assisted by operator/crew, will perform checks and services contained in Table 2-1
at the following intervals:
(1) Semiannually (S). Every 6 months or 6,000 miles (9,654 km), whichever comes first.
(2) Annually (A). Every 12 months or 12,000 miles (19,308 km), whichever comes first.
(3) Biennially (B). Every 24 months or 24,000 miles (38,615 km), whichever comes first.
b. Refer to the following steps when performing lubrication checks and services:
(1) Intervals. Lubrication services coincide with the vehicle’s Semiannual (S) Preventive Mainte-
nance Service. For this purpose, a 10% tolerance (variation) in specified lubrication point mileage is permissi-
ble. Those vehicles not accumulating 1,000 miles (1 ,609 km) in a 6-month period will be lubricated at the time
of (S) Preventive Maintenance Service.
(2) Army Oil Analysis Program (AOAP). AOAP does not apply to CUCV series vehicles.
2-4
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
(3) For Operation of Equipment in Protracted Cold Temperatures Below -15 0F. (-260C). Remove lu-
bricants prescribed in lubrication table for temperatures above -15°F(-26°C). Relubricate with lubricants
specified in lubrication table for temperatures below -15°F (-26°C). If OEA lubricant is required to meet the
temperature ranges prescribed in the lubrication table. OEA lubricant is to be used in place of OE/HDO 10
lubricant for all temperature ranges where OE/HDO 10 is specified in the lubrication table.
c. Perform all (S) inspections in addition to(A) inspections at the time of the annual inspection. Perform all
(A) and (S) inspections in addition to (B) inspections at the time of the biennial inspection.
WARNING
Drycleaning solvent is inflammable and will not be used near an open flame. A fire extinguisher
will be kept nearby when the solvent is used. Use only in well-ventilated places. Failure to do
this may result in injury to personnel, and/or damage to equipment.
c. Where the instruction “clean” appears in a procedure, you must use drycleaning solvent (Appendix C,
Item 15) to clean grease or oil from metal parts. After the item is cleaned, rinsed, and dried, apply a light grade
of oil to unprotected surfaces to prevent rusting.
d. Clean rubber and plastic materials with soap and water. Refer to TM 9-2320-289-10 for general vehicle
cleaning instructions.
2-5
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
NOTE
Always do your preventive maintenance checks and services in the order prepared. Once it
gets to be a habit, you will be able to spot anything wrong in a hurry.
(5) Not Fully Mission Capable. If vehicle meets criteria in this column, vehicle is not mission capable
(NMC).
2-6
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
Table 2-1. Unit Level Preventive Maintenance Checks and Services for CUCV
NOTE
Fuse box is located on driver’s side of
cab under instrument panel.
1 Semi- PreService
Annual Checks a. Check fuses, flashers, and switches
for looseness and damage. If loose or
damaged, tighten or replace as re-
quired.
ROAD TEST
Maintenance personnel will be with vehi-
cle operator to verify pre-service checks.
d. Starter inoperative
d. Notice if starter engages smoothly or makes excessive
and turns the engine at normal cranking grinding sound.
speed.
e. Engine knocks,
e. Listen for unusual engine noise at rattles, smokes ex-
idle, at operating speeds, and under ac- cessively, or any ex-
celeration. Be alert for excessive vibra- haust noise.
tion, the smell of oil, fuel, or any exhaust
noises.
2-7
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
Table 2-1. Unit Level Preventive Maintenance Checks And Services for CUCV
NOTE
Lock front wheel hubs before checking
transfer (see TM 9-2320-289-10).
2-8
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
Table 2-1. Unit Level Preventive Maintenance Checks and Services for CUCV
ENGINE COMPARTMENT
1 Semi- Cooling a. Any Class Ill water
Annual System a. Inspect all hoses and fittings for dete- leak. Hoses cracked
rioration. Inspect radiator probe and or dry rotted.
draincock for security of mounting.
2-9
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
2-10
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
Table 2-1. Unit Level Preventive Maintenance Checks and Services for CUCV
2-11
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
Table 2-1. Unit Level Preventive Maintenance Checks And Services for CUCV
b. Check power steering hoses for Ieak- b. Any Class Ill leak
age and loose clamps and brackets. or loose clamp.
5 Semi- Alterna- Inspect alternators for security for secu- Mounting bolts loose
Annual tor rity of mounting. or missing.
6 Semi- Fuel Sys- a. Inspect fuel pump and fittings for a. Any Class Ill fuel
Annual tem leaks. leak.
c. Inspect inlet and outlet Iines for leaks, c. Any Class Ill fuel
connections, cracks, splits, or wear. leak.
2-12 Change 3
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
Table 2-1. Unit Level Preventive Maintenance Checks and Services for CUCV
7 Semi- Air Intake a. Inspect air cleaner, hoses, and tub- a. Any damage that
Annual System ing for improper installation, cracks, would allow unfiltered
breaks, and connections that could allow air to enter engine.
unfiltered air to enter engine. Inspect air
filter element for restrictions.
8 Semi- Electrical a. Disconnect each glow plug lead and a. Replace any failed
Annual Wiring check for resistance between glow plug glow plug.
terminal and ground. Resistance should
be 1-3 ohms. Check glow plugs for
looseness or damage. Tighten glow
plugs to 10 ft-lbs (14 N.m).
2-13
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
Table 2-1. Unit Level Preventive Maintenance Checks And Services for CUCV
2-14 Change 3
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
Table 2-1. Unit Level Preventive Maintenance Checks and Services for CUCV
13 Semi- Trans-
Annual mission DO NOT remove transmission dip-
Fluid and stick before cleaning dirt away from
Fill Tube fill tube and transmission dipstick.
Dirt could enter and damage trans-
mission.
NOTE
Foamy or milky oil or rust on transmis-
sion dipstick are evidence of contami-
nation.
a. Inspect transmission dipstick and
fluid for evidence of contamination. If
there is contamination, notify your su-
pervisor and service transmission (see
paragraph 5-2).
Change 3 2-15
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
Table 2-1. Unit Level Preventive Maintenance Checks and Services for CUCV
10-23A.)
2-16 Change 4
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
Table 2-1. Unit Level Preventive Maintenance Checks and Services for CUCV
NOTE
In case of unusual tire wear, the tire
manufacturer recommends 2 optional
methods for all except M1028A2 and
M1028A3: 5 tire rotation and cross ro-
tation. Before performing either of the
optional methods, notify your supervi-
sor.
a. Rotate tires as follows for all except
M1028A2 and M1028A3:
2-17
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
Table 2-1. Unit Level Preventive Maintenance Checks And Services for CUCV
M1028A2
2-18
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
Table 2-1. Unit Level Preventive Maintenance Checks and Services for CUCV
2-19
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
Table 2-1. U n i t Level Preventive Maintenance Checks And Services for CUCV
24 Semi- Steering a. Inspect tie-rod shock absorber for a. Any damage that
Annual System worn bushings, loose nuts, or leaks. will prevent opera-
tion.
26 Semi- Transfer a. Inspect transfer case for loose bolts a. Class Ill leak.
Annual and leaks. If mounting bolts are loose, Loose bolts.
tighten to 30 ft-lb (41 N.m).
2-20
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
Table 2-1. Unit Level Preventive Maintenance Checks and Services for CUCV
28 Semi- Axles a. Inspect axle housings for security of a. Class Ill leak,
Annual and Dif- mounting, cracks, and leaks. Cracks and loose
mounting bolts.
ferentials
b. Ensure that axle breather vents are b. Vent plugged.
free of debris and are operative. Ensure
that fill plugs are present and secure.
2-21
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
Table 2-1. Unit Level Preventive Maintenance Checks And Services for CUCV
29 Semi- Fuel Sys- a. Inspect fuel tank for leaks. Inspect all a. Any Class Ill fuel
Annual tem attaching hoses for wear, cracks, and leak.
splits.
b. Inspect all fuel lines for leaks, loose b. Any Class Ill fuel
connections, and crimps. leak.
2-22 Change 3
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
Table 2-1. Unit Level Preventive Maintenance Checks and Services for CUCV
NOTE
Perform all checks in Table 2-1 Pre-
ventive Maintenance Checks and
Services, Semiannual Schedule, then
perform the following inspections in
the order given.
ENGINE COMPARTMENT
1. Annual Cooling a. Check radiator for damage or leaks. a. Any Class Ill fuel
System leaks.
3 Annual Fuel Sys- Replace fuel filter (see paragraph 3-1 7).
tern
2-23
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
Table 2-1. Unit Level Preventive Maintenance Checks And Services for CUCV
UNDERSIDE OF TRUCK
WARNING
DO NOT use a dry brush or com-
5 Annual Brakes
pressed air to clean brake shoes,
brake pads, or brake components.
There may be asbestos dust on
brake shoes, brake pads, and brake
components which can be danger-
ous to you if you breathe it. Brake
shoes, brake pads, and brake com-
ponents must be wet, and a soft
brush must be used. Failure to fol-
low this warning may result in seri-
ouS illness or death to personnel.
NOTE
M1009 brake shoes are factory in-
stalled with bonded linings instead of
riveted linings. Lining should not be
less than 0.031” (0.80 mm) thick at any
point.
a. Check brake shoes and brake pads a. Worn or damaged
for damage or wear. Lining should not drum or rotor.
be less than 0.031” (0.80 mm) between
rivets and lining.
2-24
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
Table 2-1. Unit Level Preventive Maintenance Checks and Services for CUCV’
6 Annual Front a. Remove locking hubs (see para- a. Any damage that
Wheel graph 8-3). Clean and inspect for dam- will prevent opera-
age. tion.
Bearings
and Hubs
b. Remove, clean, dry, and inspect front
Continued wheel bearings.
NOTE
The rear wheel bearings cm all except
M1009 do not require routine repack-
ing of the rear wheel bearings. They
are Iubricated by the rear differential
fluid.
2-24.1
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
Table 2-1. Unit Level Preventive Maintenance Checks And Services for CUCV
2-24.2
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
Table 2-1. Unit Level Preventive Maintenance Checks and Services for CUCV
—
NOTE
Casting marks in torque converter
cover have the appearance of small
cracks and are considered normal.
a. Inspect torque converter cover
where transmission is connected to en-
gine flywheel, for missing or loose
mounting bolts. If bolts are loose,
tighten 60 in-lb (27 N.m).
2-24.3
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
Table 2-1. Unit Level Preventive Maintenance Checks And Services for CUCV
14 Annual Axles Annually or every 12,000 miles, check Class Ill leaks. Miss-
and Dif - and fill front and rear differentials with ing bolts.
ferentials GO lubricating oil. Fill to level of filler
plug hole. Ensure that differential cover
bolts are tight and that none are missing.
If bolts are loose, tighten to 35 ft-lbs (47
N.m).
16 Annual Suspen- a. Check front wheel toe alignment (see a. Improper align-
sion paragraph 8-6). ment.
NOTE
Only M1028A2 and M1028A3 have
rear stabilizer bars.
b. Inspect front and rear stabilizer bars b. Any damage that
for loose mounting bolts or damage. ln- will prevent damage.
spect bushings for wear. If bolts are
loose, tighten to 55 ft-lbs (75 N.m).
2-24.4
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
Table 2-1. Unit Level Preventive Maintenance Checks and Services for CUCV
2-24.5
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
PARTS LIST
The following is a list of parts required when performing semi-annual, annual or biennial PMCS. The semi-an-
nual parts list contains the mandatory replacement parts for one semi-annual PMCS. The annual parts list
contains the mandatory replacement parts for one semi-annual PMCS and the peculiar replacement parts for
one annual PMCS.
PART
NUMBER NSN NOMENCLATURE QTY
PF-35 2940-00-082-6034 Element, Engine Oil Filter 1
PART
NUMBER NSN NOMENCLATURE QTY
PF-35 2940-00-082-6034 Element, Engine Oil Filter 1
14075347 2910-01-156-8361 Element, Fuel Filter 1
A644C 2940-01-155-3190 Element, Air Filter 1
27467 5330-01-106-7938 Seal, Plain, Front Hub (all except M1009) 2
6273948 5330-01-086-3506 Seal, Plain, Front Hub (M1009 only) 2
469694 5330-01-085-0918 Seal Assy, Rear Hub (all except M1009) 2
327739 5330-01-076-3009 Gasket, Axle Shaft (all except M1009) 2
15528 2530-01-163-0800 Parts Kit, Four Wheel (all except M1009) 2
13446 5330-01-331-7230 Packing, Preformed, Locking Hub (M1009) 2
PART
NUMBER NSN NOMENCLATURE QTY
6273951 5330-01-150-4022 Gasket, Front Diff Cover (all except Ml 009) 1
458860 5330-07-155-4399 Gasket, Front Diff Cover (Ml 009 only) 1
3977387 5330-01-020-9319 Gasket, Rear Diff Cover (all except Ml 009) 1
26016662 5330-01-084-2410 Gasket, Rear Diff Cover (Ml 009 only) 1
9150-01-198-3829 Additive, Oil, Diff 1
8655625 5330-01-148-7492 Gasket, Trans Pan 1
6259423 2940-01-121-6350 Parts Kit, Fluid Pre 1
2-24.6
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
2-24.7
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
2-24.8 Change 3
*lJS c,o~~&fEJ.Jrp~~lNGomcE 1993. 746. 017 !301cB
PIN: 053627-003
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
2-9. GENERAL.
a. This section provides information for identifying malfunctions which may develop in the
CUCV. Because of the complexity of the CUCV, troubleshooting has been divided into two major
areas: mechanical troubleshooting (Table 2-3) and electrical troubleshooting (Table 2-4). The
troubleshooting symptom index (paragraph 2-11) provides a list of possible malfunctions, grouped
alphabetically by major truck system, with the location of steps that can be taken to correct the
malfunction.
(2) Question the operator to obtain any information that might help determine the
cause of the problem. Also ensure that all applicable operator troubleshooting was performed before
beginning troubleshooting procedures in this manual.
(3) Locate the symptom or symptoms in paragraph 2-11 that describe the
malfunction. Check both mechanical and electrical symptoms. If a symptom of a truck malfunction is
not listed, notify your supervisor.
(4) Turn to the page in the troubleshooting table where the troubleshooting
procedures are listed. Headings at the top of each page show how each troubleshooting task is
organized: MALFUNCTION, TEST OR INSPECTION (in step number order), and CORRECTIVE
ACTION.
(5) Perform each step in the order listed until the malfunction is corrected.
2-25
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
WARNING
CAUTION
Do not leave key in “RUN” position for more than 2 minutes for any
electrical system test. Failure to follow this caution may result in damage
to glow plugs.
(1) Abbreviations. The following abbreviations of wire colors are used throughout
Appendix F:
BLK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Black
BLK/LT BLU . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Black with one light blue stripe
BLK/WHT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Black with one white stripe
BLK/YEL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Black with one yellow stripe
BLU . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Blue
BRN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Brown
BRN/RED . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Brown with one red stripe
BRN/WHT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Brown with one white stripe
DK BLU . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dark blue
DKGRN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dark green
DK GRN/WHT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dark Greenwich one white stripe
LT BLU . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Light blue
LT BLU/RED . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Light blue with one red stripe
LT GRN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Light green
GRA . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Gray
GRN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Green
ORN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Orange
ORN/BLK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Orange with one black stripe
PNK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Pink
PNK/BLK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Pink with one black stripe
PPL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Purple
PPL/WHT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Purple with one white stripe
RED/WHT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Red with one white stripe
TAN/WHT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tan with one white stripe
WET . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . White
WHT/BLK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . White with one black stripe
YEL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Yellow
YEL/BLK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Yellow with one black stripe
2-26
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
(2) Lead Descriptions. Each lead on a wiring diagram is designated according to wire
size, wire color, and circuit. For example, lead 3 RED-2J (SXL) is designated as follows:
(a) Wire size is the diameter of the wire in millimeters. Use the following table
to convert wire size into wire gage:
.5 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ...20
.8 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18
1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16
2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14
3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12
5 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10
8 ................... 8
13 ...... . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6
19 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4
32 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2
NOTE
2-27
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
(3) Symbols. Major items appearing in wiring diagrams and schematics are labeled.
Other items that may require explanation are defined below:
A. Wiring Harness Terminals, Will be found In “mirror image” locations on the wiring harness
male/female connector (F), The circuit through lead 3 RED-2J (SXL) is shown at points marked
“(A).” Note that only terminals for the applicable circuit wiII be shown on the wiring diagram.
Terminals shown on other wiring diagrams will be represented by empty blocks on the wiring
harness connectors.
B. Splice. Indicates where a lead Is soldered or otherwise connected to 1 or more other leads,
Repair any broken soldered splice using soldering gun.
c . Wiring Harness, Can be Identified on a wiring diagram by a large number of leads going In the
same direction. Wiring harnesses can be identified on the truck by a conduit (plastic sleeve) or a
loom (string mesh) that wraps around the leads. The leads of each wiring harness are exposed
at the base of the connectors.
D. Leads and Connectors, Transmit electricity to major components, When disconnecting more
than one lead and connector from a major component, tag leads and connectors for installation.
E. Ground Lead. Connects to frame or body to complete electrical circuit, A disconnected or
damaged ground lead can make a major component inoperative, or operative at lower
efficiency.
F. Wiring Harness Male/Female Connectors, Are shown on the wiring diagram according to
their actual shape. Anywhere that a female connector appears, the “mirror image” shown
opposite It will be its male connector.
TA49631
2-28
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
(1) Any components that have been removed for testing must be installed again if
they are not defective.
5 amps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tan
10 amps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Red
15 amps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Light Blue
20 amps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Yellow
25 amps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ... White
30 amps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Light Green
(3) Many electrical troubleshooting tasks will require that you check for voltage or
continuity through a lead or connector terminal. Leads will be identified by wire color if their location
is unclear. Connector terminals will usually be identified by the leads that connect to the back of
them.
2-29
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
MECHANICAL TROUBLESHOOTING
Troubleshooting
Procedure
Page
BRAKE SYSTEM
Service Brakes:
Drag . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-35
Grab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-36
Pull . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. 2-35
Sensitive braking action . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-35
Squeak, high-pitched . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-36
Uneven braking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-36
Parking Brake Does Not Hold Truck . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-36
Pedal:
Excessive effort . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-36
Returns slowly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-37
Rough during normal application . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-38
Spongy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-38
Travel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-37
Vibrates (booster chatters) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-38
ENGINE
Accelerator:
Full throttle cannot be obtained . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-40
Loss of power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-45
Pedal sticks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-40
Will not shut off using key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-47
Engine Assembly:
Exhaust smoke during operation (excessive) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-46
Heavy knock with engine torque applied . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-46
Vibration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-43
Will not shut off using key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-47
Idle:
Knocks when hot . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-42
Rough on cold-starts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-41
Rough when hot . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-42
Will not continue to run, hard restarting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-41
Will not return to idle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-41
Lubrication System:
Oil loss . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-44
Oil pressure light on . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-44
Radiator:
Coolant loss . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-44
Overheats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-45
Starting:
Cranks but will not start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-39
High-pitched whine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-40
Slow cranking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-39
Unusual noise during cranking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-39
Will not crank . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-39
2-30
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
MECHANICAL TROUBLESHOOTING
Troubleshooting
Prooedure
Page
EXHAUST SYSTEM
PROPELLER SHAFT
STEERING
SUSPENSION
Noisy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-53
TRANSFER CASE
2-31
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
MECHANICAL TROUBLESHOOTING
Troubleshooting
Procedure
Page
TRANSMISSION
“Clunks’’ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-55
Noisy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-55
Oil Loss . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-54
Whines . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-55
Will Not Shift Properly.... . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-55
2-32
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
ELECTRICAL TROUBLESHOOTING
Troubleshooting
Procedure
Page
AIR CONDITIONER
BATTERIES/CHARGING SYSTEM
Change 2 2-33
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
ELECTRICAL TROUBLESHOOTING
Troubleshooting
Procedure
Page
HORN
Inoperative . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-68
Will Not Shut off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-69
INSTRUMENT PANEL
Fuel Gage Inaccurate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-70
Light Flickering or Will Not Turn Off:
Brake warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-69
Coolant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-69
Four-wheel drive (transfer case not in four-wheel drive) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-70
Light Inoperative:
Four-wheel drive (transfer case in four-wheel drive) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-70
Oil pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-71
LIGHTING SYSTEM
Inoperative:
Back-up . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-71
Blackout .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-72
Blackout drive..... . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-73
Hazard warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-73
Head, . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-72
Marker/parking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-72
Stop . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-73
Turn signals.... . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-74
Turn Signals Light But Do Not Flash . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-74
Will Not Turn Off:
Back-up . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-71
Stop . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-74
STARTING SYSTEM
Engine Will Not Crank (No Audible Solenoid Clicks) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-74
Slow Cranking (Solenoid Clicks) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-76
No Cranking (Solenoid Clicks) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-76
Starter Stays Engaged . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-75
2-34 Change 2
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
MALFUNCTION
TEST OR INSPECTION
CORRECTIVE ACTION
BRAKE SYSTEM
1. BRAKES DRAG
Step 3. Inspect brake shoes, brake pads, and all components for proper operation and
installation. (See paragraphs 7-7 and 7-11)
Step 4. Have assistant press brake pedal and check for movement of caliper piston.
Step 1. Check to ensure that the correct power booster has been installed (M1009 only).
(See paragraph 7-8)
If correct power booster is on truck and condition still exists, replace power
booster. (See paragraph 7-8)
2-35
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
MALFUNCTION
TEST OR INSPECTION
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Step 2. Inspect proportioning valve (all except M1009) and lines for obvious damage.
5. HIGH-PITCHED SQUEAK
Step 1. Inspect brake shoes and brake pads for incorrect installation, distortion, and
excessive wear; thickness of lining or distance from rivet head must exceed
0.031 in. (0.80 mm).
Step 1. Check parking brake adjustment and ensure that linkage operates properly.
Adjust parking brake (see paragraph 7-2) or replace damaged parts (see
paragraphs 7-3 and 7-4).
Step 3. Check to ensure that the correct power booster has been installed (all except
M1009). (See paragraph 7-8)
2-36
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
MALFUNCTION
TEST OR INSPECTION
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Step 6. Inspect brake shoes and brake pads for incorrect installation, distortion, and
excessive wear; thickness of lining or distance from rivet head must exceed
0.031 in. (0.80 mm).
Repair if required. (See paragraphs 7-7 and 7-11)
Step 7. Have assistant press brake pedal; check for movement of caliper piston.
NOTE
Pedal should travel 1-1½ in. (2.54-3.81 cm) before brakes take hold. After
brakes take hold, pedal may exceed 1-1½ in. (2.54-3.81 cm) travel; this is
normal.
Step 1. Inspect power steering pump belt.
Tighten if loose or replace if worn. (See paragraph 8-15)
WARNING
Compressed air used to check for restrictions should never exceed 30 psi
(207 kPa). Use only effective chip guarding and personnel protective
equipment (goggles/shield, gloves, etc.). Failure to follow this warning may
result in serious injury to personnel.
Step 2. Check for restrictions in lines from power booster to power steering pump with low
pressure air.
Clear restrictions or replace. (See paragraph 8-14)
Step 3. Check power booster input rod end at brake pedal for wear or damage.
Replace if worn or damaged. (See paragraph 7-8)
Step 1. Check master cylinder reservoirs for low brake fluid. (See LO 9-2320-289-12)
Change 2 2-37
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
MALFUNCTION
TEST OR INSPECTION
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Step 3. Check rear brake adjustment and inspect auto adjusters for damage,
Adjust rear brakes and repair auto adjusters if damaged. (See paragraph 7-7)
Step 4. Check power booster operation. Depress brake pedal several times to exhaust
accumulator pressure. Start engine. Brake pedal should return to normal position.
Replace power booster if not operating properly. (See paragraph 7-8)
Step 5. Check wheel bearing adjustment. (See paragraphs 8-4 and 8-5)
NOTE
Pedal should travel 1-1½ in. (2.54-3.81 cm) before brakes take hold. After
brakes take hold, pedal may exceed 1-1½ in. (2.54-3.81 cm) travel; this is
normal.
Step 1. Bleed brakes. (See paragraph 7-6)
Step 2. Check power steering pump reservoir for low power steering fluid. Inspect power
steering pump and lines for leakage.
Tighten hoses if leaking. If still leaking, replace pump and/or hoses. (See
paragraphs 8-15 and 8-14)
Fill reservoir if low. (See LO 9-2320-289-12)
WARNING
DO NOT use a dry brush or compressed air to clean brake shoes, brake
pads, or brake components. There may be asbestos dust on brake shoes,
brake pads, or brake components which can be dangerous to you if you
breathe it. Brake shoes, brake pads, and brake components must be wet,
and a soft brush must be used. Failure to follow this warning may result in
serious illness or death to personnel.
Step 1. Inspect brake shoes and brake pads for incorrect installation, foreign material,
distortion, and excessive wear; thickness of lining or distance from rivet head must
exceed 0.031 in. (0.80 mm).
Repair or replace if necessary. (See paragraphs 7-7 and 7-11)
2-38 Change 2
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
MALFUNCTION
TEST OR INSPECTION
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Step 2. Check drums and rotors for heat spotting, glazing, or heavy scoring.
ENGINE
Step 2. Check clearance between starter pinion tooth and flywheel. (See paragraph 4-5,
INSTALLATION)
Step 3. Inspect flywheel ring gear for chipped or damaged teeth. (See paragraph 4-5,
INSTALLATION)
Step 2. Check fuel supply and return lines for restrictions, looseness, or damage.
Step 3. Inspect fuel filter, fuel pump, and injector pump for leakage.
Step 4. Check for inoperative glow plugs and glow plug system. (See Electrical
Troubleshooting malfunction #19)
2-39
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
MALFUNCTION
TEST OR INSPECTION
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Step 5. Check for contaminated fuel by draining fuel from fuel filter draincock into suitable
container. Check color of fuel to determine if the correct fuel is in fuel system.
WARNING
Diesel fuel is flammable. When disconnecting fuel lines to test fuel flow,
direct fuel spray away from source of ignition. A fire extinguisher must be
on hand in work area. Failure to follow this warning may result in serious
injury or death to personnel.
Step 6. Check fuel pump operation. Disconnect input fuel line at the fuel filter. Disconnect
pink lead from fuel injector pump. Use a quart capacity container, and crank
engine for 15 seconds. Container should be at least ¼ full or contain ½ pt (0.231)
of fuel. Install low pressure gage in fuel line. Crank engine for 15 more seconds.
Fuel pressure should be 5.5-6.5 psi (38-45 kPa). Reconnect fuel inlet line to fuel
filter, and reconnect pink lead to fuel injector pump.
Step 2. Check clearance between starter pinion tooth and flywheel. (See paragraph 4-5,
INSTALLATION)
Step 1. Inspect accelerator pedal components for binding or damage that would limit pedal
travel.
Step 2. Inspect accelerator cable and control spring on left side of injection pump for
damage that would restrict cable movement.
2-40
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
MALFUNCTION
TEST OR INSPECTION
CORRECTIVE ACTION
19. IDLES ROUGH ON COLD-STARTS WITH BLACK SMOKE BUT CLEARS UP AFTER WARM-UP
WARNING
Diesel fuel is flammable. When disconnecting fuel lines to test fuel flow,
direct fuel spray away from source of ignition. A fire extinguisher must be
on hand in work area. Failure to follow this warning may result in serious
injury or death to personnel.
Step 4. Check for contaminated fuel by draining fuel from fuel filter draincock into suitable
container. Check color of fuel to determine if the correct fuel is in fuel system.
Drain fuel and replace if contaminated or incorrect fuel is in fuel system.
Step 5. Check seals on vent plug and draincock on fuel filter for damage. (See paragraph
3-17)
Replace damaged seals. (See paragraph 3-17)
Change 2 2-41
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
MALFUNCTION
TEST OR INSPECTION
CORRECTIVE ACTION
WARNING
Diesel fuel is flammable. When disconnecting fuel lines to test fuel flow,
direct fuel spray away from source of ignition. A fire extinguisher must be
on hand in work area. Failure to follow this warning may result in serious
injury or death to personnel.
Step 6. Check fuel pump operation. Disconnect input fuel line at the fuel filter. Disconnect
pink lead from fuel injector pump. Use a quart capacity container and crank engine
for 15 seconds. Container should be at least ¼ full or contain ½ pt (0.23 1) of fuel,
Install low pressure gage in fuel line. Crank engine for 15 more seconds. Fuel
pressure should be 5.5-6.5 psi (38-45 kPa). Connect fuel inlet line to fuel filter and
connect pink lead to fuel injector pump.
WARNING
Diesel fuel is flammable. When disconnecting fuel lines to test fuel flow,
direct fuel spray away from source of ignition. A fire extinguisher must be
on hand in work area. Failure to follow this warning may result in serious
injury or death to personnel.
lf no leaks or crimps are obvious, bleed fuel filter. (See paragraph 3-17)
Step 2. Check for contaminated fuel by draining fuel from fuel filter draincock into suitable
container. Check color of fuel to determine if the correct fuel is in fuel system.
Step 1. Check oil level indicator for proper reading. (See TM 9-2320-289-10)
2-42 Change 2
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
MALFUNCTION
TEST OR INSPECTION
CORRECTIVE ACTION
WARNING
Step 3. Check tailpipe, muffler, and exhaust pipe for improper positioning and damage.
Step 4. Check. engine mounts and insulators for looseness and damage.
Step 6. Check for contaminated fuel by draining fuel from fuel filter draincock into suitable
container. Check color of fuel to determine if the correct fuel is in fuel system.
WARNING
Diesel fuel is flammable. When disconnecting fuel lines to test fuel flow,
direct fuel spray away from source of ignition. A fire extinguisher must be
on hand in work area. Failure to follow this warning may result in serious
injury or death to personnel.
Step 7. Check fuel pump operation. Disconnect input fuel line at the fuel filter. Disconnect
pink lead from fuel injector pump. Use a quart capacity container and crank engine
for 15 seconds. Container should be at least ¼ full or contain ½ pt (0.23 I) of fuel.
Install low pressure gage in fuel line. Crank engine for 15 more seconds. Fuel
pressure should be 5.5-6.5 psi (38-45 kPa). Connect fuel inlet line to fuel filter
and connect pink lead to fuel injector pump.
Step 1. Check engine mounts, insulators, and components for looseness and damage.
2-43
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
MALFUNCTION
TEST OR INSPECTION
C0RRECTIVE ACTION
Step 1. Check oil level indicator for proper reading. (See TM 9-2320-289-10)
Step 2. Inspect oil filler cap vent for buildup of sand, dirt, and other foreign material that may
keep oil filler cap vent valve in an open position. If condition exists, remove oil filler
cap, clean, and shake to listen for rattling sound.
Step 3. Remove crankcase depression regulator valve (CDRV) assembly and CDRV hoses.
Clean with a rag and inspect for cracks. Test CDRV for proper operation.
Step 4. Clean excess oil from exterior of valve cover, oil level indicator tube, oil pan and
plug, oil filter, fuel pump, engine oil cooler lines, and oil pressure sending unit;
check for looseness, damage, and leakage.
Step 1. Check oil level indicator for proper reading. (See TM 9-2320-289-10)
Step 3. Check oil pressure sending unit for looseness, damage, or leakage.
Repair as necessary.
Step 4. If light remains on, replace oil pressure sending unit. (See paragraph 4-14)
Step 1. Pressurize cooling system and check for leakage on all hoses and components.
(See TM 750-254)
Step 2. Check radiator cap for proper relief pressure. (See TM 750-254) Relief pressure
should be 15 psi (103 kPa).
Replace if defective.
2-44 Change 2
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
MALFUNCTION
TEST OR INSPECTION
CORRECTIVE ACTION
27. OVERHEATS
Step 2. Pressurize cooling system and check for leakage on all hoses and components.
(See TM 750-254)
Tighten loose clamps, fasteners, or fittings. Replace leaking hoses and
components. (See paragraphs 3-6, 3-32, 3-33, and 3-34)
Step 3. If engine continues to overheat, replace thermostat. (See paragraph 3-34)
Step 4. Check fan clutch.
Replace fan clutch. (See paragraph 3-35)
28. NOTICEABLE LOSS OF POWER
WARNING
Diesel fuel is flammable. When disconnecting fuel lines to test fuel flow,
direct fuel spray away from source of ignition. A fire extinguisher must be
on hand in work area. Failure to follow this warning may result in serious
injury or death to personnel.
Step 2. Check for restricted fuel filter. Bleed air from fuel system. (See paragraph 3-17)
If fuel flow is insufficient, replace fuel filter. (See paragraph 3-17)
WARNING
Step 4. Check tailpipe, muffler, and exhaust pipe for improper positioning and damage.
Reposition and tighten mounting hardware.
Replace any damaged components. (See paragraph 3-27)
Change 2 2-45
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
MALFUNCTION
TEST OR INSPECTION
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Step 2. Check for contaminated fuel by draining fuel from fuel filter draincock into suitable
container. Check color of fuel to determine if the correct fuel is in fuel system.
WARNING
Diesel fuel is flammable. When disconnecting fuel lines to test fuel flow,
direct fuel spray away from source of ignition. A fire extinguisher must be
on hand in work area. Failure to follow this warning may result in serious
injury or death to personnel.
Step 3. Check fuel pump operation. Disconnect input fuel line at the fuel filter. Disconnect
pink lead from fuel injector pump. Use a quart capacity container and crank engine
for 15 seconds. Container should be at least ¼ full or contain ½ pt (0.23 I) of fuel.
Install low pressure gage in fuel line. Crank engine for 15 more seconds. Fuel
pressure should be 5.5-6.5 psi (38-45 kPa). Connect fuel inlet line to fuel filter and
connect pink lead to fuel injector pump.
If fuel flow is insufficient, replace fuel pump. (See paragraph 3-10)
Step 5. Check crankcase depression regulator valve (CDRV) and hose for restrictions.
Inspect hose and air intake manifold for evidence of oil.
Clean off all traces of oil and clear restrictions or replace CDRV and hose as
required. (See paragraph 3-5)
WARNING
2-46 Change 2
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
MALFUNCTION
TEST OR INSPECTION
CORRECTIVE ACTION
NOTE
Knocking and rattling will result if air cleaner wingnut is loose.
Step 1. Check tailpipe, muffler, and exhaust pipe for improper positioning and damage.
Step 2. Check engine mounts and insulators for looseness and damage.
NOTE
Ground wire for ignition switch goes to top of parking brake bracket. If
ground wire is broke, engine will not shut off if light switch is on.
Step 1. With engine at idle, pinch flexible part of the fuel return line at fuel injector pump to
stop engine. Notify your supervisor.
EXHAUST SYSTEM
WARNING
Step 1. Check tailpipe, muffler, exhaust manifolds, and exhaust pipe for looseness,
damage, or restrictions.
Change 2 2-47
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
MALFUNCTION
TEST OR INSPECTION
CORRECTIVE ACTION
WARNING
Step 1. Ensure that truck fuel tank is at least ¼ full. Add fuel if low.
WARNING
Diesel fuel is flammable. When disconnecting fuel lines to test fuel flow,
direct fuel spray away from source of ignition. A fire extinguisher must be
on hand in work area. Failure to follow this warning may result in serious
injury or death to personnel.
Step 3. Remove side panel from heater compartment. Disconnect fuel line from inlet side
of heater. Place suitable container under inlet line. Check for fuel flow to heater
while holding run-start switch in the “START” position.
2-48
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
MALFUNCTION
TEST OR INSPECTION
CORRECTIVE ACTION
WARNING
2-49
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
MALFUNCTION
TEST OR INSPECTION
CORRECTIVE ACTION
WARNING
Diesel fuel is flammable. When disconnecting fuel lines to test fuel flow,
direct fuel spray away from source of ignition. A fire extinguisher must be
on hand in work area. Failure to follow this warning may result in serious
injury or death to personnel.
38. FAN RUNS CONTINUALLY WITH SWITCH OFF; RUN LAMP STAYS ON; NO HEAT PRODUCED
2-50
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
MALFUNCTION
TEST OR INSPECTION
CORRECTIVE ACTION
WARNING
Diesel fuel is flammable, When disconnecting fuel lines to test fuel flow,
direct fuel spray away from source of ignition. A fire extinguisher must be
on hand in work area. Failure to follow this warning may result in serious
injury or death to personnel.
Step 2. Disconnect fuel line from inlet side of heater. Place a suitable container under inlet
line. Check for fuel flow to heater while holding cm-off switch in “ON” position.
PROPELLER SHAFT
Step 1. Inspect propeller shaft universal joints for play. Attempt to move propeller shaft
forward and back to detect play on yoke.
42. VIBRATES
Step 2. Inspect propeller shaft for damage, buildup of foreign material, and missing weights.
Step 3. Inspect propeller shaft universal joints for play and binding. Attempt to move
propeller shaft ends forward and back to detect play or binding on yoke.
Replace universal joint if there is play or binding. (See paragraphs 6-3 and 6-5)
Change 2 2-51
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
MALFUNCTION
TEST OR INSPECTION
CORRECTIVE ACTION
STEERING
NOTE
If there is Loctite on bolts, DO NOT tighten without reapplying Loctite
(Item 30, Appendix C).
Step 4. Inspect steering gear.
If loose, tighten mounting bolts 75 Ib.-ft. (102 N-m).
Step 5. Clean, inspect, and adjust wheel bearings. (See paragraphs 8-4 and 8-5)
Replace if required.
2-52 Change 2
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
MALFUNCTION
TEST OR INSPECTION
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Step 1. Inspect power steering belt and pump pulley for looseness or damage.
Tighten if loose and replace if damaged. (See paragraph 8-15)
Step 2. Check power steering pump fluid level (see LO 9-2320-289-12)
Step 3. Inspect power steering pump reservoir for air in power steering fluid. Power steering
fluid will have milky appearance if it contains air. If there is air in system, inspect
pump and hoses for leakage.
Tighten hoses if leaking. If still leaking, replace pump and/or hoses (see
paragraphs 8-15 and 8-14) and bleed steering system (see paragraph 8-8).
NOTE
If there is Loctite on bolts, DO NOT tighten without reapplying Loctite
(Item 30, Appendix C).
SUSPENSION
Step 1. Inspect shock absorber and components mounting for looseness or damage.
Tighten or replace as required. (see paragraphs 6-10 and 6-11)
Change 2 2-53
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
MALFUNCTION
TEST OR INSPECTION
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Step 2. Inspect shock absorber for leakage. A slight trace of fluid is normal.
Step 3. Inspect front and rear springs for loose or damaged “U“ bolts and mounting bolts
where it mounts to axle and frame. Inspect springs for damaged mounting
brackets.
Tighten any loose “U“ bolt nuts to 40 Ib.-ft. (54 N•m) in an “X” pattern;
tighten again in same pattern to 150 Ib.-ft. (203 NŽm) for front springs and to
145 Ib.-ft. (197 N•m) for rear springs. Tighten front spring forward mounting
bolts to 90 Ib.-ft. (122 N•m) and rearward mounting bolts to 50 Ib.-ft.
(68 N•m). Tighten all rear spring mounting bolts to 110 Ib.-ft. (149 N•m).
Notify your supervisor if any components are damaged.
TRANSFER CASE
Step 2. Check transfer case shift linkage for improper adjustment or damage which would
interfere with operation.
TRANSMISSION
Step 1. Check transmission fluid indicator for proper reading. (See TM 9-2320-289-10)
Step 2. Inspect vacuum modulator (right side of transmission near base of transmission fill
tube) for leakage and damage.
2-54
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
MALFUNCTION
TEST OR INSPECTION
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Step 4. Inspect transmission oil cooler lines for leakage and damage.
Step 5. Inspect speedometer cable adapter and seal for oil leakage from transfer case.
Step 1. Check transmission fluid indicator for proper reading. (See TM 9-2320-289-10)
Tighten any loose retaining screws to 80 lb.-ft. (108 N•m). Notify your
supervisor if there is any damage.
Step 1. Check transmission fluid indicator for proper reading. (See TM 9-2320-289-10)
Step 2. Inspect vacuum hoses, vacuum pump, and vacuum regulator valve for improper
connection, leakage, or damage.
Step 3. Inspect vacuum modulator (right side of transmission near base of transmission fill
tube) for leakage and damage.
Tighten mounting bolt to 20 Ib.-ft. (27 N•m). Notify your supervisor if damaged
or still leaking.
Change 2 2-55
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
MALFUNCTION
TEST OR INSPECTION
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Step 3. Inspect shock absorber for leakage. A slight trace of fluid is normal.
Step 3. Check for binding in steering linkage at tie-rod ends, connecting rod, and kingpins.
Tighten lugnuts on M1009 wheels to 90 Ib. -ft. (122 NŽm); tighten Iugnuts on
all other truck wheels to 140 Ib. -ft. (190 NŽm).
Step 3. Inspect tires for cuts, gouges, cracks, and sidewall damage. Inspect wheels for
bends and other damage.
Step 5. Check for front axle spindle end play. Raise and support truck on jack stands.
Grasp tire at outer edges and attempt to move up and down.
Step 7. Inspect tie-rod shock absorber for leakage. A slight trace of fluid is normal.
2-56
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
MALFUNCTION
TEST OR INSPECTION
CORRECTIVE ACTION
AIR CONDITIONER
Adjust if loose.
Step 4. Unplug connector from 24 volt air conditioner relay. (See paragraph 4-13) Check
to see that there are 12.0 volts at orange lead terminal and 24.0 volts at light blue
lead terminal,
Step 5. Unplug Connector from 12 volt air conditioner relay. (See paragraph 4-13) Check
for 12.0 volts at tan lead terminal and 24.0 volts at gray lead terminal.
If voltage is not correct at both leads, check 25 amp air conditioner fuse.
(See paragraph 4-13) Replace fuse if burned out.
Step 1. Check 20 amp in-line air conditioner blower fuse. (See paragraph 4-13)
Step 2. Remove air conditioner condenser cover assembly. (See paragraph 10-33) Check
for voltage through each lead from fan switch to resistor. Voltage should be 24.0.
If voltage is not correct through any lead, trace circuit through lead back to
20 amp in-line air conditioner fuse. (See wiring diagram F-26)
2-57
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
MALFUNCTION
TEST OR INSPECTION
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Step 3. Check resistance through lead from resistor to evaporator motor. Resistance
should be 0 ohms with switch in high position, 1.4 ohms with switch in medium
position, and 4.5 ohms with switch in low position.
Step 1. Remove access cover from ambulance body fuse panel. (See paragraph 4-13)
Check applicable 15 amp fuse.
NOTE
Circuit breaker cannot be manually reset. After 2-3 minutes cool down
time, it will reset itself.
Step 1. Remove access cover from ambulance body fuse panel. (See paragraph 4-13)
Allow circuit breaker to reset, Check for voltage from circuit breaker.
If there is no voltage, check for voltage from circuit breaker back to positive
terminal board.
2-58
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
MALFUNCTION
TEST OR INSPECTION
CORRECTIVE ACTION
BATTERIES/CHARGING/SYSTEM
Step 1. Check batteries for proper charge and electrolyte level. (See paragraph 4-39)
Voltage between ground and positive (+) terminal of rear battery should be 24.0.
Step 4. Remove and clean all battery cable and clamp connections.
Replace worn or damaged battery cables and clamps. (See paragraph 4-38)
Step 5 Check voltage between positive and negative terminal boards where battery cables
connect. Voltage should be 24.0.
If voltage is not correct, trace circuit to batteries. (See wiring diagram F-1 or
F-2)
5.1. GENERATOR LIGHT DOES NOT COME ON WITH KEY IN “ON” POSITION BEFORE ENGINE IS
STARTED (ALL MODELS EXCEPT M1010)
Step 1. Trace all circits from generator to generator light in instrument panel (including
fuse, bulb, arm relay}. (See wiring diagram F-11)
Step 2. Disconnect connector from left alternator (if “GEN 1“ light is on) or right alternator (if
“GEN 2“ light is on). Turn key to “RUN” position.
If generator light is not on, trace circuit from alternator connector to generator
Iight in instrument panel. (See wiring diagram F-11) If circuit is good, replace
alternator. (See paragraph 4-2)
If generator light is on, trace circuit from alternator connector to generator light
if instrument panel. (See wiring diagram F-9)
Change 2 2-59
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
MALFUNCTION
TEST OR INSPECTION
CORRECTIVE ACTION
7. “GEN 2“ LIGHT REMAINS ON WITH KEY IN “OFF” POSITION (ALL EXCEPT M1010)
If light remains on, trace circuit through brown/red lead to “GEN 2“ light in
instrument panel. (See wiring diagram F-9)
Step 1. Check alternator belts for looseness or damage. (See paragraph 4-2)
Step 2. Check 20 amp ignition fuse and 10 amp/28 v (voltmeter) fuse. (See
paragraph 4-1 2)
Step 3. Remove voltmeter relay. (See paragraph 4-9) Start engine. Using jumper wire,
connect white lead terminal and black lead terminal.
If voltmeter does not read in green zone, trace circuit from bus bar ground to
fuse block. (See wiring diagram F-4) If circuit is good, replace voltmeter, (See
paragraph 4-9)
Step 1. Start engine. Check voltage at left and right alternators at positive (+) terminals.
Voltage should not exceed 16.0 at left alternator or 31.8 at right alternator.
(All except M1010) If voltmeter still operates, trace circuit from white lead at
relay connector to voltmeter. (See wiring diagram F-4)
(M1000) If voltmeter Still operares, trace circuit between pink blacK lead and
brown/red lead. (See wiring diagram F-6)
2-60 Change 2
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
MALFUNCTION
TEST OR INSPECTION
CORRECTIVE ACTION
11. VOLTMETER INOPERATIVE (Ml 010 AND M1028 WITH 200 amp SYSTEM)
Step 1. Check 20 amp ignition fuse and 10 amp/28 v (voltmeter) fuse. (See
paragraph 4-12)
Step 2. Remove voltmeter relay. (See paragraph 4-9) Start engine. Using jumper wire,
connect brown lead terminal and brown/red lead terminal.
If voltmeter reads in green zone, replace relay.
If voltmeter does not read in green zone, trace circuit from bus bar ground to
fuse block. (See wiring diagram F-6) If circuit is good, replace voltmeter. (See
paragraph 4-9)
12. VOLTMETER IN RED (OVERCHARGE) ZONE AT ALL TIMES (M1010 AND M1028 WITH 200 amp
SYSTEM)
Step 1. Start engine, bring to full operating temperature, then shut off. Remove 20 amp
engine control fuse. (See paragraph 4-12) Start engine and check voltage at lower
alternator positive (+) terminal.
If voltage is over 29.1, replace lower alternator voltage regulator. (See
paragraph 4-4)
If voltage is between 28.5 and 29.1, replace voltmeter. (See paragraph 4-9)
13. VOLTMETER IN YELLOW (UNDERCHARGE) ZONE (Ml 010 AND Ml 028 WITH 200 amp
SYSTEM)
Step 1. Check alternator belts for looseness or damage. (See paragraph 4-3)
Step 2. Start engine, bring to full operating temperature, then shut off. Remove 20 amp
engine control fuse. (See paragraph 4-12) Start engine and check voltage at lower
alternator positive (+) terminal.
If voltage is below 28.5, trace circuit from lower alternator “IGN” terminal to
bulkhead connector. (See wiring diagram F-10) If voltage is still below 28.5,
perform step 3.
If voltage is between 28.5 and 29.1, replace voltmeter. (See paragraph 4-9)
Step 3. Install 20 amp engine control fuse. Check voltage at lower alternator positive (+)
terminal.
Change 2 2-61
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
MALFUNCTION
TEST OR INSPECTION
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Step 1. Check battery and cables. (See Electrical Troubleshooting malfunction #5)
Step 2. Inspect slave receptacle and cables for corrosion or damage. Check for loose
connections at positive terminal board terminal, negative terminal board terminal,
and at receptacle. Check for continuity through receptacle and receptacle cables.
CAUTION
If there is continuity, install; replace any cables that do not have continuity.
(See paragraph 4-40)
NOTE
Glow plug system cycling can be detected by Iistening for clicking at glow
plug relay or by observing voltmeter. Indicator should be to the left of the
normal range during cycling and return to normal range after cycling.
NOTE
The only way to determine if your glow plug module is operating properly is
through testing. The glow plug module should not be replaced until the
following tests are performed.
Step 1. Disconnect pink wire from fuel injector pump. Remove printed circuit board from
glow plug module. Check each circuit to the glow plug module as described. Trace
any circuit that does not operate properly. (See wiring diagram F-7 or F-8) If all
circuits operate properly, replace glow plug module. (See paragraph 4-8)
2-62 Change 2
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
MALFUNCTION
TEST OR INSPECTION
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Dark blue "RUN“ Jump wire to ground; “WAIT” light turns on.
If “WAIT” light does not turn on, replace
bulb. (See paragraph 4-7) If “WAIT” light
still does not turn on, trace circuit.
Step 1. Check 20 amp engine control fuse and 20 amp ignition fuse. (See
paragraph 4-12)
2-63
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-28$20
MALFUNCTION
TEST OR INSPECTION
CORRECTIVE ACTION
CAUTION
Do not leave key in "RUN” position for more than 2 minutes. Failure to
follow this caution may resuit in damage to glow plugs.
Step 2. Remove glow plug modu!e. (See paragraph 4-8) Turn key to “RUN” position. Using
jumper wire, ground dark blue lead.
If “WAIT” light turns on, turn key to “OFF” position, reinstall glow plug module,
and perform step 3.
If “WAll-” light does not turn on, replace bulb. If “WAIT” light still does not turn
cm, trace circuit. (See wiring diagram F-7 or F-8)
Step 3. Turn key to “RUN” position. Disconnect connector from glow plug switch on upper
left rear of cylinder head.
If “WAIT” light turns on, replace glow plug switch. (See paragraph 3-20)
If “WAIT” light does not turn on, perform Electrical Troubleshooting malfunction
#15
If “WAIT” light stays on, trace circuit through dark blue lead to “WAIT” light.
(See wiring diagram F-7 or F-8)
Step 1. Check connections at glow plug switch on upper left rear of cylinder head and glow
plug module.
19. ENGINE CRANKS BUT WILL NOT START; ENGINE COLD; “WAIT” LIGHT OPERATES
Step 1. Ensure that key is in “OFF” position. Check for voltage between glow plug relay
terminal where orange lead connects and ground.
If there IS voltage, replace glow plug relay (see paragraph 4-8) and perform
step 3.
2-64 Change 2
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
MALFUNCTlON
TEST OR INSPECTlON
CORRECTIVE ACTlON
CAUTION
DO NOT leave key in “RUN” position for more than 2 minutes. Failure to
follow this caution may result in damage to glow plugs.
Step 2. Turn key to “RUN” position. Check for voltage between glow plug relay terminal
where orange lead connects and ground.
NOTE
If there are 10.0-15.0 volts, ensure that engine is mechanically sound and fuel
system is operating properly,
Step 3. Disconnect each glow plug lead and check for resistance between glow plug terminal
and ground. Resistance should be 1-3 ohms. Check glow plugs for looseness or
damage.
If any glow plug does not have correct resistance or is damaged, replace, (See
paragraph 3-20) Tighten any loose glow plugs.
Step 4. Tag and disconnect all glow plug leads from glow plugs. Check for voltage between
glow plug relay terminal where red lead connects and ground.
If voltage is 10.0-15.0 volts, connect glow plug leads and start engine.
If there is no voltage, trace circuit back to positive terminal board. (See wiring
diagram F-7 or F-8)
Change 2 2-65
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
MALFUNCTION
TEST OR INSPECTION
CORRECTIVE ACTION
WARNING
Resistor may be hot. Use care when performing this step or injury to
personnel may occur.
Step 5. Disconnect batteries, pull out bracket and resistor assembly (see paragraph 4-44,
REMOVAL, step 4), disconnect output (red wire) from relay, disconnect input (blue
wire) from input to resistors. Connect positive lead of multimeter to blue wire;
connect negative lead to red wire. Check resistance between resistors and ground.
Resistance should be 0.28 ohms.
If resistance is not correct, replace resistor, connect glow plug leads and
perform step 6.
Step 6. Check for voltage between glow plug relay terminal where pink/black lead connects
and ground.
Step 7. Check for voltage between glow plug relay terminal where light blue lead connects
and ground.
Step 8. Check for voltage at light blue lead on glow plug module.
TM 9-2320-289-20
MALFUNCTION
TEST OR INSPECTION
CORRECTIVE ACTION
NOTE
Disconnecting wiring harness will shut off heater.
Step 2. Set all controls for normal starting of heater. (See TM 9-2320-289-10) Disconnect
wiring harness from heater control box. Check for voltage at terminal “A” of heater
control box.
If there is voltage, replace switch (cab heater or engine coolant heater) (see
paragraph 11-3) or heater control box (ambulance heater or cargo
compartment heater) (see paragraph 10-35 or 11-20).
Open if closed.
2-66
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
MALFUNCTION
TEST OR INSPECTION
CORRECTIVE ACTION
NOTE
Step 2. Remove access cover from ambulance body fuse panel. (See paragraph 4-13)
Check 30 amp heater fuses.
Step 3. Ensure that truck fuel tank is at least ¼ full. Add fuel if low.
If heater fuel pump does not run, trace circuit. (See wiring diagram F-22 or
F-28)
Step 6. Set run-start switch to “OFF” position. Remove side panel from heater
compartment (ambulance heater only). Disconnect wiring harness from heater and
heater control box. Check continuity through all wiring harness terminals.
Step 7. Connect wiring harness to heater. Check voltage between terminal “D“ of heater
control box connector and ground. Voltage should be 24.0.
If voltage is not correct, check voltage at gray lead into heater control box
(ambulance heater) or red lead into heater control box (all except ambulance
heater). If there is still no voltage, trace circuit. (See wiring diagram F-22,
F-29, or F-30) If there is voltage, replace heater control box. (See
paragraph 10-35, 11-3, or 11-20)
Step 8. Hold run-start switch in “START” position or on-off switch in “ON” position. Check
voltage between terminal “C” of heater control box connector and ground. Voltage
should be 24.0.
If voltage is not correct, replace heater control box. (See paragraph 10-35,
11-3, or 11-20)
2-67
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
MALFUNCTION
TEST OR INSPECTION
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Step 9. Hold run-start switch in “START” position or on-off switch in “ON” position. Check
voltage between terminal “D“ of heater wiring harness connector and ground.
Voltage should be 24.0.
If voltage is not correct, replace heater control box. (See paragraph 10-35,
11-3, or 11-20)
Step 10. Hold run-start switch in “START” position or on-off switch in “ON” position. Check
voltage between terminal “B“ of heater wiring harness connector and ground.
Voltage should be 24.0.
If voltage is not correct, replace heater control box, (See paragraph 10-35,
11-3, or 11-20)
HORN
23. INOPERATIVE
Step 2. Disconnect lead from horn. Check for voltage while pressing horn button,
Step 3. Remove horn relay. (See paragraph 4-22) Turn key to “RUN” position. Using
jumper wire, connect lead terminals. Depress horn button.
If horn does not sound, trace circuit back to fuse box. (See wiring diagram
F-20 or F-21)
2-68
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
MALFUNCTION
TEST OR INSPECTION
CORRECTIVE ACTION
If horn does not shut off, trace circuit. (See wiring diagram F-20 or F-21)
INSTRUMENT PANEL
NOTE
Step 1. Check that parking brake is fully released. If light stays on, disconnect lead from
parking brake switch. (See paragraph 4-17, REMOVAL, step 1)
If brake warning light goes out, replace parking brake switch. (See
paragraph 4-17)
Step 2. Disconnect lead at combination valve. (See paragraph 7-9, REMOVAL, step 5)
If brake warning light stays on, trace circuit. (See wiring diagram F-4 or F-5)
If brake warning light goes out, bleed brakes. (See paragraph 7-6) If brake
warning light still does not go out, replace combination valve. (See
paragraph 7-9)
Step 2. Turn key to “RUN” position. Disconnect black/yelIow lead from low coolant sensor
on radiator and touch to any ground.
If light goes out, replace low engine coolant sensor. (See paragraph 3-31)
2-69
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
MALFUNCTION
TEST OR INSPECTION
CORRECTIVE ACTION
If light does not go out, trace circuit. (See wiring diagram F-4 or F-6)
Step 2. Turn key to “RUN” position. Disconnect lead from four-wheel drive switch on
transfer case and touch lead to any ground.
If four-wheel drive light does not turn on, replace bulb. (See paragraph 4-7) If
light still does not turn on, trace circuit. (See wiring diagram F-4 or F-6)
28. FOUR-WHEEL DRIVE LIGHT TURNS ON (TRANSFER CASE NOT IN FOUR-WHEEL DRIVE)
Step 1. Turn key to “RUN” position. Disconnect lead from four-wheel drive switch on
transfer case.
If four-wheel drive light stays on, trace circuit. (See wiring diagram F-4 or
F-6)
CAUTION
DO NOT leave key in “RUN” position for more than 2 minutes. Failure to
follow this caution may result in damage to glow plugs.
Step 2. Disconnect fuel tank sending unit ground from frame. Turn key to “RUN” position.
If fuel gage does not read “F” (Full), replace fuel gage. (See paragraph 4-7)
2-70
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
MALFUNCTION
TEST OR INSPECTION
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Step 3. Disconnect pink fuel tank sending unit lead and touch lead to any ground.
If fuel gage reads “E“ (Empty), replace fuel tank sending unit, (See
paragraph 3-11 or 3-12)
If fuel gage does not read “E” (Empty), replace fuel gage. (See
paragraph 4-7)
Step 1. Turn key to “RUN” position. Disconnect lead from oil pressure sending unit and
touch lead to any ground.
If light goes on, replace oil pressure sending unit. (See paragraph 4-14)
If light does not go on, replace bulb. (See paragraph 4-7) If light still does not
go on, trace circuit. (See wiring diagram F-4 or F-6)
LIGHTING SYSTEM
If lights do not go out, trace circuit. (See wiring diagram F-14, F-15, or F-17)
Step 2. Ensure that all lead connectors are secure at back-up light switch and at back-up
lights. Inspect connections for corrosion or damage.
If all connections are secure and there is no damage, check bulbs. (See
paragraph 4-28 or 4-29)
2-71
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
MALFUNCTION
TEST OR INSPECTION
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Step 3. Disconnect lead from back-up light switch. Using jumper wire, connect terminals of
wiring harness lead.
If lights do not turn on, trace circuit. (See wiring diagram F-14, F-15, or F-17)
33. HEADLIGHTS INOPERATIVE IN HIGH AND LOW BEAM (ALL OTHER LIGHTS OPERATE)
NOTE
It may be necessary to remove headlights to perform this step.
Step 2. Trace circuit from marker light connectors. (See wiring diagram F-13 or F-16)
Step 1. Ensure that blackout toggle switch is in “ON” position and blackout drive light
switch is in “ON” position.
Step 2. Check 5 amp blackout marker fuse and 10 amp stoplight fuse. (See
paragraph 4-12)
Step 3. Turn key to “RUN” position. Check for voltage at orange lead on blackout toggle
switch connector.
2-72
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
MALFUNCTION
TEST OR INSPECTION
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Step 2. Remove and check blackout drive light bulb. (See paragraph 4-25)
If bulb is good, trace circuit to switch. (See wiring diagram F-18 or F-19)
Step 1. Remove hazard warning flasher. (See paragraph 4-12) Using jumper wire, connect
fuse box terminals where flasher was installed. Lights should turn on, but not flash.
If lights do not turn on, trace circuit. (See wiring diagram F-13 or F-16)
Step 2. Remove and check stoplight bulbs. (See paragraph 4-28 or 4-29)
If there is no voltage, trace circuit. (See wiring diagram F-14, F-15, or F-17)
Step 4. With brake pedal depressed, check for voltage at white/black lead on stoplight
switch.
2-73
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
MALFUNCTION
TEST OR INSPECTION
CORRECTIVE ACTION
If lights go out, reconnect connector and adjust stoplight switch for proper
contact with brake pedal. (See paragraph 4-16, INSTALLATION) If lights
remain on, replace switch (See paragraph 4-16)
Step 1. Remove turn signal flasher. (See paragraph 4-12) Using jumper wire, connect fuse
box terminals where flasher was installed. Lights should turn on, but not flash.
If lights do not turn on, trace circuit. (See wiring diagram F-13 or F-16)
Step 1. Check appropriate marker light or parking light bulb. (See paragraph 4-26 or 4-27)
Step 2. Remove turn signal flasher. (See paragraph 4-12) Using jumper wire, connect fuse
box terminals where flasher was installed. Lights should turn on, but not flash.
If lights do not turn on, trace circuit. (See wiring diagram F-13 or F-16)
STARTING SYSTEM
42. ENGINE WILL NOT CRANK (NO AUDIBLE CLICK FROM STARTER SOLENOID)
2-74
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
MALFUNCTION
TEST OR INSPECTION
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Step 3. Inspect lead connections at starter solenoid for corrosion and damage. Check
starter mounting bolts for looseness.
Clean any corroded connections. Tighten any loose connections. Replace any
damaged connections. Tighten starter mounting bolts to 33 Ib.-ft. (45 N•m).
Step 4. Have assistant hold key in “START” position. Check for voltage at purple lead on
starter solenoid.
Step 5. Remove starter relay. (See paragraph 4-13) Turn key to “START” position. Check for
voltage at purple/white lead terminal on starter relay connector.
Step 6. Check for voltage at purple/white lead terminal on starter relay connector.
Step 7. Check for voltage at red lead terminal or starter relay connector.
NOTE
Perform Electrical Troubleshooting malfunction #42. (See wiring diagram F-1 or F-2)
Replace relay.
Change 2 2-75
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
MALFUNCTION
TEST OR INSPECTION
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Step 2. Disconnect pink lead from fuel injector pump. Have assistant hold key in “START”
position. Check voltage between front battery negative terminal and rear battery
positive terminal.
Step 2. Turn key to “RUN” position. Turn wiper switch on. Check for voltage at windshield
wiper motor.
2-76 Change 2
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
MALFUNCTION
TEST OR INSPECTION
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Step 3. Turn key to “RUN” position. Have assistant hold control lever in “WASHER” position.
Check for voltage to windshield washer solenoid.
Simplified Test Equipment for Internal Combustion Engines (STE/lCE) for use with the CUCV
Series trucks is in the process of being developed. When development is complete, STE/lCE
troubleshooting procedures will be added to this manual.
TM 9-2320-289-20
CHAPTER 3
ENGINE SYSTEMS MAINTENANCE
Paragraph Page
Number Procedures Number
Change 2 3-1
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
Equipment Condition
Alternator belts removed. (See paragraph 4-2 or 4-3)
Power steering belt removed. (See paragraph 8-15)
Air conditioner belt removed (M1010) See paragraph 3-35)
1. Remove 4 bolts (1) and crankshaft pulley assembly (2) from torsional damper assembly (3).
1. Position crankshaft pulley assembly (2) against torsional damper assembly (3).
2. Install 4 bolts (1) and tighten.
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
Install air conditioner belt (M1010). (See paragraph 3-35)
Install power steering belt. (See paragraph 8-15)
Install alternator belts. (See paragraph 4-2 or 4-3)
TA49770
3-2
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
a. REMOVAL
b. INSTALLATION
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
TA49771
3-3
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
a. REMOVAL
b. INSTALLATION
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
TA49772
3-4
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
Equipment Condition
Air cleaner removed. (See paragraph 3-9)
NOTE
TA49773
3-5
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
6. Loosen 2 clamps (14) and disconnect 2 tubes (8 and 9) from crankcase depression connector
(15).
7, Loosen 2 clamps (11) and remove left crankcase depression connector elbow (12).
TA49774
3-6
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
8. Loosen 2 clamps (7) and remove right crankcase depression connector elbow (6).
1. Inspect tubes (8 and 9) and hose (5) for cracks, splits, or breaks. Replace as required.
2. Inspect bracket (17) and all clamps (3, 7, 10, 11, 14, and 16) to ensure that they are not bent
or broken. Replace as required.
NOTE
2. Install longer tube (9) and clamp (11) to left crankcase depression connector elbow (12).
Install left crankcase depression connector elbow at left side of intake manifold with clamp.
3. Install shorter tube (8) and clamp (7) to right crankcase depression connector elbow (6).
Install right crankcase depression connector elbow at right side of intake manifold with clamp.
4. Install 2 clamps (14) and other ends of 2 tubes (8 and 9) to crankcase depression connector
(15).
5. Install CDRV assembly (2) through bracket (17) and connect to crankcase depression
connector (15) with clamp (16).
6. Connect crankcase depression hose (5) to CDRV assembly (2) with clamp (3).
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
3-7
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
3-6. ENGINE OIL COOLER SUPPLY AND RETURN PIPES AND HOSES
REPLACEMENT.
INITIAL SETUP:
NOTE
All connection points have seals (9). DO NOT lose these seals. If not
damaged, they can be reused for installation of replacement pipes (14
and 15) and hoses (2 and 11).
If removing engine oil cooler pipes (14 and 15), perform steps 1-3.
If removing engine oil cooler hoses (2 and 11), perform steps 2 and
4 through 6.
1. Disconnect engine oil cooler pipes (14 and 15) from right side of radiator (1).
NOTE
Some trucks have an engine oil sampling valve (13) which taps into
engine oil cooler system at connection between hose (2) and pipe (14).
Tag pipes (14 and 15) and hoses (2 and 11) for installation.
2. Disconnect engine oil cooler pipes (14 and 15) from engine oil cooler hoses (2 and 11) at left
side of radiator (1). If present, disconnect engine oil sampling valve (13) at square connector
(16).
5. At engine block, remove bolt (8), insulation washer (6), Iockwasher (7), and clip (10) from
bracket (5). Discard Iockwasher.
NOTE
On trucks with winterization kits, engine oil cooler hoses (2 and 11) run
under engine coolant heater. To remove hoses, pull them out from under
this heater.
6. Remove nut (3), hose clamp (12), and engine oil cooler hoses (2 and 11).
3-8
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
3-6. ENGINE OIL COOLER SUPPLY AND RETURN PIPES AND HOSES
REPLACEMENT (Con’t).
1. Inspect all hoses (2 and 11) and pipes (14 and 15) for signs of cracks, splits, and punctures.
Replace as required.
2. Replace any damaged seals (9).
TA49775
3-9
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
3-6. ENGINE OIL COOLER SUPPLY AND RETURN PIPES AND HOSES
REPLACEMENT (Con’t).
c. INSTALLATION
NOTE
If installing engine oil cooler hoses (2 and 11), perform steps 1-5.
If installing engine oil cooler pipes (14 and 15), perform steps 5-8.
3-10
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
3-6. ENGINE OIL COOLER SUPPLY AND RETURN PIPES AND HOSES
REPLACEMENT (Con’t).
2. Secure engine oil cooler hoses (2 and 11) to bracket (5) at engine block with clip (10), new
Iockwasher (7), insulation washer (6), and bolt (8).
NOTE
3. Feed engine oil cooler hoses (2 and 11) under engine coolant heater brackets.
4. Secure engine oil cooler hoses (2 and 11) to wheelwell with hose clamp (12) and nut (3).
5. Connect engine oil cooler hose 11) to engine oil cooler pipe (15) at left side of radiator (1).
NOTE
Step 6 only applies to trucks equipped with engine oil sampling valve.
If truck is equipped with engine oil sampling valve (13), perform steps
6 and 8.
6. Connect engine oil cooler hose (2) to engine oil sampling valve (13) at square connector (16).
Connect square connector to engine oil cooler pipe (14).
7. Connect engine oil cooler hose (2) to engine oil cooler pipe (14).
8. Connect engine oil cooler pipes (14 and 15) to radiator (1) at right side.
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
3-11
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
Equipment Condition Materials/Parts
Both battery negative cables disconnected. One gasket
(See paragraph 4-38)
Air cleaner removed. (See paragraph 3-9)
Tools/Test Equipment
Torque wrench
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
Install air cleaner. (See paragraph 3-9)
Connect both battery negative cables. (See paragraph 4-38)
TA49777
3-12
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
NOTE
TA701823
Change 2 3-12.1
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
NOTE
TA701824
3-12.2 Change 2
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
NOTE
Ensure that location of engine oil pan stud (13) is noted for installation.
NOTE
Early 1984 model trucks have engine oil pan (5) with a ridged lip which
requires an engine oil pan gasket. Late 1984-87 model truck engine oil pans
and replacement engine oil pans have a flat lip which requires RTV sealant.
5. Remove engine oil pan (5) and engine oil pan seal (10). Remove and discard engine oil pan
gasket if present. Discard engine oil pan seal.
WARNING
Dry cleaning solvent P-D-680 is toxic and flammable. Always wear protective
goggles and gloves and use only in a well-ventilated area. Avoid contact with
skin, eyes, and clothes and DO NOT breathe vapors. DO NOT use near open
flame or excessive heat. The solvent’s flash point is 100°F-138°F
(38°C-59°C). If you become dizzy while using cleaning solvent,
immediately get fresh air and medical help. If solvent contacts eyes,
immediately wash your eyes with water and get medical aid.
1. Clean oil and all RTV sealant or gasket material from mating surfaces of engine oil pan (5) and
engine (9) block with dry cleaning solvent.
TA701825
Change 2 3-12.3
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
NOTE
If installing new engine oil pan gasket with engine oil pan (5), perform
step 2.
If applying RTV sealant or installing new engine oil pan (5). Perform step
3.
2. Install new engine oil pan gasket on lip
of engine oil pan (5) and aline with bolt
holes.
3. Apply a 0.19 in. (5 mm) bead of RTV
sealant (16) along engine oil pan (5)
sealing surface as shown.
TA701826
3-12.4 Change 2
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
TA701827
Change 2 3-12.5
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
NOTE
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
TA701828
3-12.6 Change 2
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
Paragraph Page
Number Procedures Number
Change 2 3-13
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
CAUTION
When servicing air cleaner assembly (6), place a screen or a clean rag
over air intake opening to guard against objects falling inside. Failure to
follow this caution may result in equipment damage.
b. INSTALLATION
NOTE
Remove screen or rag from air
intake opening.
TA49778
3-14
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
CAUTION
DO NOT install nuts (2) without a washer (1) under each nut. Washers
prevent dust and dirt from entering intake manifold (9) and causing
premature engine failure.
3-15
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
WARNING
1. Disconnect fuel inlet hose (9) and fuel injector pump pipe assembly line (1) from fuel pump
(3) .
2. Remove 2 bolts (2), fuel pump (3), and gasket (4). Discard gasket.
NOTE
Perform step 3 only if removing pushrod (7).
3. Use metric socket to remove 2 bolts (8), mounting plate (5), gasket (6), and pushrod (7).
Discard gasket.
3-16
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
NOTE
Alternately and evenly tighten bolts (8) to guarantee a tight fit and to
avoid a possible oil leak.
Ensure that all gasket material has been removed from surfaces and
that surfaces are clean.
2. If removed, install push rod (7), new gasket (6), and mounting plate (5). Use metric socket to
install 2 bolts (8).
3. Install new gasket (4), fuel pump (3), and 2 bolts (2).
4. Install fuel injection pump pipe assembly line (1) and fuel inlet hose (9) to fuel pump (3).
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
Install alternators, alternator brackets, and mounting hardware (M1010). (See paragraph 4-3)
Connect both battery negative cables. (See paragraph 4-38)
Check for leaks. If engine fails to start, bleed air from fuel system. (See paragraph 3-17)
TA49779
3-17
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
WARNING
NOTE
When removing fuel tank shield assembly (25), 2 bolts (23) remain in
support assemblies (4) as a guide when installing fuel tank shield
assembly.
1. Remove 5 nuts (11), Iockwashers (10), and 3 bolts (7), and remove fuel tank shield assembly
(25). Discard Iockwashers.
2. Remove 2 bolts (5), nuts (9), Iockwashers (8), and brackets (6). Discard Iockwashers.
4. Loosen clamp (13) and remove fuel tank fill vent hose (12) from fuel tank (19).
5. Loosen clamp (15) and remove fuel tank fill hose (14) from fuel tank (19).
3-18
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
3-11. FUEL TANK AND SHIELD MAINTENANCE (ALL EXCEPT M1009) (Con’t).
3-19
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
3-11. FUEL TANK AND SHIELD MAINTENANCE (ALL EXCEPT M1009) (Con’t).
10. Remove 2 nuts (2) and Iockwashers (3), and pull back 2 flexible strap assemblies (18) from
fuel tank (19).
11. Remove 2 strap insulators (17) and remove fuel tank (19).
12. Remove 2 screws (20), support (21), and front shield (22).
3-20
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
3-11. FUEL TANK AND SHIELD MAINTENANCE (ALL EXCEPT M1009) (Con’t).
CAUTION
Thoroughly clean area before removing fuel tank sending unit (31) from
fuel tank (19). Failure to follow this caution may result in dirt falling into
fuel tank.
3. Inspect 2 strap assemblies (18), 2 support assemblies (4), and 3 brackets (6 and 26) for
dents, cracks, or corrosion.
NOTE
If installing fuel tank shield assembly (25), perform steps 18 and 19.
1. Install new gasket (36) over fuel tank (19) opening. Install fuel tank sending unit (31) and fuel
sending unit cam (35).
3. Position 2 strap assemblies (18) with 2 attached support assemblies (4) around fuel tank (19).
4. Install 2 new Iockwashers (3) and nuts (2) to ends of 2 strap assemblies (18). DO NOT fully
tighten nuts.
3-21
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
3-11. FUEL TANK AND SHIELD MAINTENANCE (ALL EXCEPT M1009) (Con’t).
NOTE
Use an assistant and suitable support when performing steps 7-11.
NOTE
Ensure that starwasher is installed between ground wire (34) terminal and
truck frame (28).
13. Install ground wire (34) to truck frame (28) using new starwasher.
14. Install fuel tank fill hose (14) and clamp (15) at fuel tank (19).
15. Install fuel tank fill vent hose (12) and clamp (13) at fuel tank (19).
16. Install bracket (26) with 2 bolts (24) and nuts (27).
17. Install 2 brackets (6) with 2 bolts (5), new Iockwashers (8), and nuts (9). DO NOT fully tighten.
18. Guide shield (25) onto 2 guide bolts (23) and install 2 new Iockwashers (10) and nuts (11). DO
NOT fully tighten.
19. Install 3 bolts (7) through 2 brackets (6) and bracket (26) using 3 new Iockwashers (10) and
nuts (11). DO NOT fully tighten.
20. Tighten 2 nuts (2) which secure 2 strap assemblies (18) to 2 support assemblies (4).
21. Tighten 2 nuts (9) and 5 nuts (11).
TA49783
3-22
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
3-11. FUEL TANK AND SHIELD MAINTENANCE (ALL EXCEPT M1009) (Con’t).
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
3-23
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
a. REMOVAL
WARNING
NOTE
Access to bolts (12) and washers (11) in step 1, bolts in step 5, and
nuts and washers in step 7, is easier with endgate down.
1. Remove 2 bolts (12) and washers (11) at tow hook bracket (10).
NOTE
At center of rear bumper brace (1), 2 bolts (5) are installed into
weldnuts (2).
2. Remove 6 bolts (5), 10 washers (4), and 4 nuts (3), and remove rear bumper brace (1).
3. Remove 4 bolts (9), nuts (6), Iockwashers (7), and washers (8) which secure tow hook
bracket (10) to rear bumper. Discard Iockwashers.
3-24
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
TA49785
3-25
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
5. Remove 6 bolts (28) from fuel tank shield (25). Remove fuel tank shield.
6. Disconnect ground wire (17) from top of frame on left of truck. Discard starwasher.
NOTE
2 nuts (20) function as spacers for 2 strap assemblies (24) and should
not be removed from strap assemblies.
NOTE
3-26
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
19. Loosen 3 clamps (36) and remove 2 sending unit hoses (37) and sending unit drain hose (45)
from sending unit (15).
22. Loosen clamp (46) at fuel tank elbow and remove fill hose (47).
23. Loosen clamp (44) and remove drain pipe (40) from sending unit drain hose (45).
24. Remove clamp (43) and cap (42) from end of drain pipe (40).
TA49787
3-27
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
CAUTION
Before removing sending unit (15) from fuel tank (26), thoroughly clean
area. Failure to follow this caution may result in dirt falling into fuel tank.
25. Remove sending unit cam (14), sending unit (15), and gasket (16). Discard gasket.
NOTE
If installing fuel tank shield (25), perform steps 26-30.
3-28
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
15. Install fill hose (47) to fill pipe assembly (30) with clamp (48).
16. Install vent hose (32) to fill pipe assembly (30) with clamp (31).
17. Position sending unit drain hose (45) and drain pipe (40) along frame. DO NOT install at this
time.
18. Connect 2 sending unit hoses (37) to ends of pipes and secure with 2 clamps (38).
20. Position ground wire (17) over top of frame. DO NOT connect at this time.
23. Secure 2 strap assemblies (24) and 2 wiring harness tabs with washers (19) and nuts (18).
TA49789
3-29
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
NOTE
An assistant is needed to perform
step 27.
TA49790
3-30
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
Refill fuel tank.
Connect both battery negative cables. (See paragraph 4-38)
Bleed air from fuel system. (See paragraph 3-17)
Check for leaks.
TA49791
3-31
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
3-13. FUEL TANK SUPPLY AND RETURN HOSES AND PIPES REPLACEMENT (ALL
EXCEPT M1009).
INITIAL SETUP:
WARNING
NOTE
Fuel tank must be removed to perform steps 1-7. (See paragraph 3-11)
1. Remove 3 clamps (21) and remove 3 sending unit hoses (22) from drain pipe (17), feed pipe
(23), and return pipe (20).
3. Remove bolt (30), nut (35), washer (34), and clip (33).
5. Remove nut (26), bolt (29), and washer (28). Remove 2 screws (27) and remove shield (25).
6. Loosen clamp (13) and disconnect feed hose (14) from feed pipe (23). Remove feed pipe.
3-32
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
3-13. FUEL TANK SUPPLY AND RETURN HOSES AND PIPES REPLACEMENT (ALL
EXCEPT M1009) (Con’t).
TA49792
3-33
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
3-13. FUEL TANK SUPPLY AND RETURN HOSES AND PIPES REPLACEMENT (ALL
EXCEPT M1009) (Con’t).
TA49793
3-34
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
3-13. FUEL TANK SUPPLY AND RETURN HOSES AND PIPES REPLACEMENT (ALL
EXCEPT M1009) (Con’t).
7. Loosen clamp (15) and disconnect return hose (16) from return pipe (38). Remove return
pipe.
8. Remove clamp (13) and feed hose (14) from feed pipe (12).
9. Remove clamp (15) and return hose (16) from return pipe (38).
10. Remove 6 screws (10) and clips (11) securing feed pipe (12) to frame.
NOTE
If truck is not equipped with
winterization kits, perform
steps 11 and 13 through 19.
If truck is equipped with
winterization kits, perform
steps 12-19.
NOTE
M1010 and trucks equipped with winterization kits DO NOT have a plug (9)
in fitting (8).
TA49794
3-35
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
3-13. FUEL TANK SUPPLY AND RETURN HOSES AND PIPES REPLACEMENT (ALL
EXCEPT M1009) (Con’t).
NOTE
If installing feed pipe (12), perform steps 7-10.
1. Install front return pipe (38) with 4 clips (37) and screws (36).
4. Install bolt (2), clip (3), and battery cable bracket (1).
NOTE
M1010 and trucks equipped with winterization kits DO NOT have a plug (9)
in fitting (8).
6. Install plug (9) into fitting (8) and install fitting to feed pipe (5).
NOTE
Step 8 only applies to trucks
equipped with winterization kits.
10. Install feed hose (14) to feed pipe (12) with clamp (13).
11. Install return hose (16) to return pipe (38) with clamp (15).
TA49795
3-36
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
3-13. FUEL TANK SUPPLY AND RETURN HOSES AND PIPES REPLACEMENT (ALL
EXCEPT M1009) (Con’t).
TA49796
3-37
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
3-13. FUEL TANK SUPPLY AND RETURN HOSES AND PIPES REPLACEMENT (ALL
EXCEPT M1009) (Con’t).
TA49797
3-38
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
3-13. FUEL TANK SUPPLY AND RETURN HOSES AND PIPES REPLACEMENT (ALL
EXCEPT M1009) (Con’t).
13. Install bolt (29), washer (28), and nut (26) to shield (25).
14. Install ends of feed pipe (23) and return pipe (20) over support (31) and over left side of
frame.
15. Connect feed hose (14) to feed pipe (23) and secure with clamp (13).
16. Connect return hose (16) to return pipe (20) with clamp (15).
17. Install pipes with clip (19) and screw (18) so that feed pipe (23) is to front, drain pipe 17) is in
middle, and return pipe (20) is to back.
18. Install cap (24) and clamp (32) to drain pipe (17).
19. Install feed pipe (23) and return pipe (20) to support (31) with clip (33), bolt (30), washer
(34), and nut (35).
20. Install 3 hoses (22) to pipes (17, 20 and 23) with clamps (21).
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
3-39
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
3-14. FUEL TANK SUPPLY AND RETURN HOSES AND PIPES REPLACEMENT
(M1009).
INITIAL SETUP:
a. REMOVAL
WARNING
NOTE
Access to feed hose (8) and clamp (7) is difficult. It may be necessary to
lower fuel tank to make step 1 easier to perform. (See paragraph 3-12)
1. Remove clamp (7) and feed hose (8) from feed pipe (11).
3. Loosen clamp (22) and remove feed hose (23) from feed pipe (11).
NOTE
4. Remove 3 screws (2) and clips (1). Remove feed pipe (11). Discard feed pipe.
6. Remove 3 screws (19), 3 clips (20), and remove feed pipe (21) from fitting (25).
3-40
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
3-14. FUEL TANK SUPPLY AND RETURN HOSES AND PIPES REPLACEMENT
(M1009) (Con’t).
TA49798
3-41
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
3-14. FUEL TANK SUPPLY AND RETURN HOSES AND PIPES REPLACEMENT
(M1009) (Con’t).
NOTE
Step 7 only applies to trucks
equipped with winterization kits.
NOTE
Trucks equipped with winterization kits DO NOT have a plug (18) in fitting
(25).
8. Remove plug (18) and fitting (25) from feed pipe (13).
9. Loosen 2 clamps (14) and remove feed hose (15).
TA49799
3-42
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
3-14. FUEL TANK SUPPLY AND RETURN HOSES AND PIPES REPLACEMENT
(M1009) (Con’t).
10. Remove 3 screws (16) and clips (17), and remove feed pipe (13).
11. Remove clamp (10) and return hose (9) from return pipe (4).
12. Remove clamp (32) and return hose (33) from return pipe (4).
TA49800
3-43
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
3-14. FUEL TANK SUPPLY AND RETURN HOSES AND PIPES REPLACEMENT
(M1009) (Con’t).
NOTE
Rear return pipe (4) must be cut before it can be removed.
13. Remove 3 screws (12) and clips (3), and remove return pipe (4). Discard return pipe.
TA49801
3-44
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
3-14. FUEL TANK SUPPLY AND RETURN HOSES AND PIPES REPLACEMENT
(M1009) (Con’t).
16. Remove 3 screws (35) and clips (31), and remove return pipe (34).
b. INSTALLATION
1. Install return pipe (34) with 3 clips (31) and screws (35).
3. Install return hose (33) to return pipe (34) with clamp (32).
4. Install new return pipe (4), bending it into position, to return hose (33) with clamp (32).
5. Install return pipe (4) to frame with 3 clips (3) and screws (12).
6. Install new return hose (9) to return pipe (4) with clamp (10).
7. If fuel tank was lowered, raise at this time. (See paragraph 3-12)
8. Install feed pipe (13) to frame with 3 clips (17) and screws (16).
9. Install feed hose (15) to fuel pump and feed pipe (13) with 2 clamps (14).
TA49802
3-45
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
3-14. FUEL TANK SUPPLY AND RETURN HOSES AND PIPES REPLACEMENT
(M1009) (Con’t).
NOTE
Trucks equipped with winterization kits DO NOT have a plug (18) in fitting
(25).
10. Install plug (18) into fitting (25) and install fitting to feed pipe (13).
11. Install feed pipe (21) to fitting (25) and to frame with 3 clips (20) and screws (19).
NOTE
Step 12 only applies to trucks
equipped with winterization kits.
TA49803
3-46
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
3-14. FUEL TANK SUPPLY AND RETURN HOSES AND PIPES REPLACEMENT
(M1009) (Con’t).
14. Install new feed pipe (11), bending it into position. Install 3 clips (1) and screws (2). Install
feed pipe to feed hose (23) with camp (22).
15. Install feed hose (8) to feed pipe (11) with clamp (7) .
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
TA49804
3-47
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
3-15. FUEL TANK FILLER DOOR, FILL PIPE ASSEMBLY, AND FILL/VENT HOSES
REPLACEMENT (ALL EXCEPT M1009 AND M1010).
INITIAL SETUP:
a. REMOVAL
WARNING
1. Loosen clamps (10 and 11), and disconnect fill hose (9) and vent hose (12) from fuel tank.
2. Remove 3 screws (4), and remove housing (6), fill pipe assembly (7), and attached fill hose
(9) and vent hose (12).
b. INSPECTION
2. Inspect fill hose (9) and vent hose (12) for cracks, punctures, or soft spots .
3. Remove 2 clamps (8 and 13) and 3 screws (5), and disassemble housing (6), fill pipe
assembly (7), fill hose (9), and vent hose (12) only as required to replace damaged
components. Note position of hoses for assembly.
c. INSTALLATION
3-48
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
3-15. FUEL TANK FILLER DOOR, FILL PIPE ASSEMBLY, AND FILL/VENT HOSES
REPLACEMENT (ALL EXCEPT M1009 AND M1010) (Con’t).
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
Refill fuel tank.
Connect both battery negative cables. (See paragraph 4-38)
Bleed air from fuel system if required. (See paragraph 3-17)
Check for leaks.
TA49805
3-49
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
3-16. FUEL TANK FILLER DOOR, CAP, AND FILL PIPE ASSEMBLY REPLACEMENT
(M1009).
INITIAL SETUP:
WARNING
2. Remove clamp (9) and remove vent hose (10) from fill pipe assembly (8).
3. Remove clamp (12) and remove fill hose (11) from fill pipe assembly (8).
4. Remove 3 screws (2) and screws (14). Remove clamp (13), fill pipe assembly (8), and
housing (1).
5. Remove fuel cap chain clip (6) and fuel cap assembly (7) from housing (1).
b. INSTALLATION
3. Install chain clip (11) with attached fuel cap assembly (7) to housing (1).
3-50
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
3-16. FUEL TANK FILLER DOOR, CAP, AND FILL PIPE ASSEMBLY REPLACEMENT
(M1009) (Con’t).
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
Connect both battery negative cables. (See paragraph 4-38)
Check for leaks.
TA49806
3-51
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
WARNING
Diesel fuel is flammable. DO NOT perform this procedure near fire, flames,
or sparks. A fire extinguisher must be on hand in work area. Failure to follow
this warning may result in serious injury or death.
4. Remove vent plug (5), loosen drainplug (17), and allow all fuel to drain from fuel filter assembly
(1). Remove drainplug, and 2 seals (4). Discard seals.
5. Disengage 2 filter clamps (7) and remove fuel filter assembly (1).
6. Remove clamp (13), fuel filter inlet hose (12), clamp (15), and fuel filter outlet hose (14).
7. Remove 3 bolts (10), washers (9), and filter mounting bracket (8).
8. Remove 4 screws (11) and base assembly (2) from filter mounting bracket (8).
b. INSTALLATION
2. Install filter base assembly (2) to filter mounting bracket (8) with 4 screws (11).
3. Install filter mounting bracket (8) with 3 washers (9) and bolts (10).
4. Install fuel filter inlet hose (12) at point marked “IN” on base assembly (2) with clamp (13).
5. Install fuel filter outlet hose (14) at point marked “OUT” on base assembly (2) with clamp (15).
3-52 Change 2
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
7. Install 2 new seals (4), vent plug (5), and drainplug (17).
Change 2 3-53
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
c. BLEEDING
WARNING
NOTE
An assistant is needed to perform steps 3-6.
3-54
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
WARNING
NOTE
Engine should not be running at this time.
TA49809
3-55
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
a. REMOVAL
WARNING
NOTE
Perform step 1 only if visual inspection shows fuel leaking from either rear
injector nozzle (4).
1. Remove 2 clamps (2) and caps (1) from 2 rear injector nozzles (4).
NOTE
When working on M1010, the right drainback hose (5) in step 3 cannot be
removed unless alternators, alternator brackets, and mounting hardware
are removed. (See paragraph 4-3)
b . INSTALLATION
1. Install 2 caps (1) and clamps (2) at 2 rear injector nozzles (4) if removed.
3-56
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
NOTE
Step 4 only applies to M1010.
4. Install alternator, alternator brackets, and mounting hardware. (See paragraph 4-3)
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
TA4980O
3-57
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
a. REMOVAL
WARNING
Allow engine to cool before replacing drainback pipe assembly (5) and
drainback hose (1). Failure to follow-this warning may result in serious
burns.
2. Remove clamp (2) and disconnect fuel injector pump drainback hose (1).
3. Remove nut (7) and clip (6). Remove bolt (10) and clip (11). Remove bolt (4), clip (3), and
drainback pipe assembly (5).
b. INSTALLATION
1. Install drainback pipe assembly (5) with bolt (4) and clip (3), bolt (10) and clip (11), and nut
(7) and clip (6).
3. Install fuel injector pump drainback hose (1) with clamp (2).
3-58
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
Install alternators, alternator brackets, and mounting hardware (M1010). (See paragraph 4-3)
Check for leaks.
TA49811
3-59
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
a. REMOVAL
NOTE
If removing glow plug switch (4), perform steps 1 and 2.
1. At top rear of left cylinder head, disconnect connector wire (3) from glow plug switch (4).
2. Remove glow plug switch (4). Remove bushing (5). Discard bushing if threads appear
damaged.
NOTE
Notify supervisor if glow plug (1) does not come out in one piece.
Removal of glow plug fragments is not authorized at this maintenance
level.
3. Disconnect glow plug connector wire (2) from each glow plug (1) to be removed. Remove
glow plug.
b. INSPECTION
1. Inspect glow plug (1) threads to ensure that they are not stripped. If glow plug threads are
stripped, notify your supervisor.
c. INSTALLATION
NOTE
1. Install each removed glow plug (1). Tighten to 10 Ib.-ft. (14 N•m).
2. Install glow plug connector wire (2) to each glow plug (1).
3-60
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
TA49812
3-61
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
Equipment Condition
Air cleaner removed. (See paragraph 3-9)
2. Remove vacuum pump hose assembly (5) from connector (4) and remove connector (6).
3. Remove connector (4) and hose (3) from vacuum pump (2).
4. Remove 2 connectors (7) from vacuum pump hose assembly (5) and vacuum hose (1).
b. INSTALLATION
6. Install 2 connectors (7) to vacuum pump hose assembly (5) and vacuum hose (1).
NOTE
7. Install 2 connectors (7) with attached vacuum hoses (1 and 5) to connector (8).
3-62
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
TA49813
3-63
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
a. REMOVAL
NOTE
If only adjusting transmission vacuum valve (5), perform REMOVAL, step 1
and INSTALLATION, steps 2-7.
1. Disconnect vacuum hose connector (2) from transmission vacuum valve (5).
2. Remove 2 screws (6) and transmission vacuum valve from fuel injector pump (1).
TA701829
3-64 Change 2
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
b. INSTALLATION
NOTE
1. Install transmission vacuum valve (5) on fuel injector pump (1) with 2 screws (6). DO NOT fully
tighten screws. Transmission vacuum valve must be free to rotate on fuel injector pump.
2. Attach vacuum source to lower vacuum nipple (4). Attach vacuum gage to upper vacuum nipple
(3). Bring vacuum down to 20 in. Hg.
3. Insert valve gage block (9) between
gage boss (10) and wide-open stop
screw (8) on throttle lever (7). Rotate
and hold throttle lever against valve
gage block.
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
TM 9-2320-289-20
Paragraph Page
Number Procedures Number
3-65
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
Equipment Condition
Both battery negative cables disconnected. (See paragraph 4-38)
a. REMOVAL
NOTE
If removing accelerator cable assembly (1), perform steps 1-5.
If removing support (6) and fast idle solenoid assembly (5), perform
steps 1 and 6 through 9.
1. In engine compartment, remove accelerator cable retainer (9) and accelerator cable
assembly (1) from support (6).
2. Remove accelerator cable assembly (1) from clip (2).
3. In driver’s compartment, remove retainer (3) securing accelerator cable assembly (1) to
accelerator pedal lever assembly (4).
4. In driver’s compartment, depress tangs on accelerator cable assembly (1) and push
accelerator cable assembly through bulkhead into engine compartment.
5. From engine compartment, pull accelerator cable assembly (1) through bulkhead. Remove
accelerator cable assembly.
6. Disconnect connector from fast idle solenoid assembly (5).
7. Remove 2 screws (10) and fast idle solenoid assembly (5) from support (6).
8. Remove spring assembly (7) from support (6).
9. Remove 2 screws (8) and support (6).
b. INSTALLATION
CAUTION
3-66
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
3. Install accelerator cable assembly (1) to support (6) with accelerator cable retainer (9).
4. Install fast idle solenoid assembly (5) to support (6) with 2 screws (10). Install connector to
fast idle solenoid assembly.
5. Install accelerator cable assembly (1) into clip (2) on air cleaner.
TA49814
3-67
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
6. Carefully push accelerator cable assembly (1) through bulkhead into driver’s compartment.
7. In driver’s compartment, install accelerator cable assembly (1) into forked end of accelerator
pedal lever assembly (4). Install retainer (3) to end of accelerator cable assembly until it is
seated.
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
TA49815
3-68
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
NOTE
If removing accelerator pedal (1), perform steps 1 and 2.
2. Remove spring (3) from lever assembly (2). Remove retainer (8), accelerator pedal (1), and
spring. Remove spring from accelerator pedal. Discard retainer.
TA49816
3-69
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
b. INSTALLATION
NOTE
1. Install support (4) and lever assembly (2) into grooves of support.
4. Install spring (3) to accelerator pedal (1). Install spring and accelerator pedal to lever
assembly (2).
NOTE
Retainer (8) must be tight against pedal (1) rib.
5. Install new retainer (8) to secure accelerator pedal (1) to lever assembly (2).
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
3-70
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
WARNING
Use extreme caution to ensure that clothing, tools, and insulated jumper
wires DO NOT get caught in truck’s operating drivebelts. Failure to follow
this warning may result in serious injury to personnel and equipment
damage.
a. ADJUSTMENT
2. Connect STE/lCE tester to STE/lCE DCA connector under dash. (See TM 9-4910-571-12&P)
CAUTION
3-71
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
TA49819
3-72
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
Paragraph Page
Number Procedures Number
3-73
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
a. REMOVAL
WARNING
NOTE
Removal of left side exhaust system for all except M1009 is described
in this paragraph.
Right side exhaust system for all except M1009 and both sides of M1009
exhaust system are removed the same way except for minor
differences which will be described as they occur.
1. Remove 2 bolts (1), nuts (2), Iockwashers (3), and 2 clamps (4) from tailpipe (5). Discard
Iockwashers.
NOTE
Factory-installed muffler (7) and tailpipe (5) are welded to form a 1-piece
assembly. If original muffler or tailpipe require replacement, both muffler
and tailpipe must be replaced. Clamp kits will be required for installation.
3-74
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
NOTE
3-75
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
NOTE
Perform step 5 only if working on truck equipped with winterization kits.
5. Remove clamp kits (18) and separate exhaust pipe (17) and winterization kit exhaust flex pipe
(19). Discard clamp kit locknuts.
TA49821
3-76
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
NOTE
NOTE
NOTE
Perform step 8 for left side exhaust systems for all except M1009.
8. Remove clamp kit (29) and exhaust pipe (17). Discard 2 Iockwashers.
9. Remove 3 nuts (28), washers (27), springs (26), and exhaust pipe (17) from exhaust
manifold. Remove seal (25) and discard.
TA49822
3-77
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
NOTE
b. INSTALLATION
NOTE
Right side exhaust systems for all except M1009 and both sides of
M1009 exhaust system are installed the same way except for minor
differences which will be described as they occur.
2. Install new seal (25) at exhaust manifold. Install exhaust pipe (17) with 3 springs (26), washers
(27), and nuts (28). Tighten nuts to 180 lb.-in. (20 N•m).
NOTE
Perform step 3 for all except M1009 left side exhaust systems.
3. Install rear portion of exhaust pipe (17) to front portion with clamp kit (29) using 2 new
Iockwashers.
3-78
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
NOTE
TA49823
3-79
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
NOTE
Perform step 5 for all except M1009.
5. Install exhaust pipe (17) to frame with clamp (15), bolt (12), new Iockwasher (14), and nut
(13).
NOTE
Perform step 6 only if working on truck equipped with winterization kits.
6. Install winterization kit exhaust flex pipe (19) to exhaust pipe (17) with clamp kits (18) using
new locknuts.
TA49824
3-80
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
7. Install muffler (7) to exhaust pipe (17) with clamp kit (16) using 2 new Iockwashers.
NOTE
Perform step 8 only if working on M1009.
TA49825
3-81
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
a. REMOVAL
WARNING
NOTE
If removing right side exhaust manifold (16), perform steps 1-3.
2. Remove 3 nuts (5), Iockwashers (4), and springs (3), and disconnect exhaust pipe (2) from
right or left side exhaust manifold (6 or 16). Remove exhaust pipe seal (1) and discard.
3. Remove 8 bolts (13) and remove right side exhaust manifold (16). Remove 3 studs (15) from
right side exhaust manifold as required.
4. At oil cooler hose bracket (11) remove 3 nuts (7), bolt (9), Iockwasher (8), and insulator (10).
Remove oil cooler hose bracket from left side exhaust manifold (6).
5. Remove nut and washer securing engine oil level indicator tube mounting bracket to stud (14).
3-82
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
NOTE
Perform step 6 only if working on
left side of M1010.
3-83
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
9. Remove left side exhaust manifold (6). Remove 3 studs (15) as required.
b. INSTALLATION
NOTE
If installing left side exhaust manifold (6), perform steps 1-6, 8, and 9.
1. Position left side exhaust manifold (6) over bolt holes in engine cylinder block and install 2
studs (12) and stud (14). DO NOT fully tighten studs.
2. Install nut and washer securing oil level indicator tube mounting bracket to stud (14).
TA49827
3-84
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
NOTE
NOTE
6. Install oil cooler hose bracket (11) to left side exhaust manifold (6) with insulator (10), new
Iockwasher (8), bolt (9), and 3 nuts (7).
NOTE
7. Install right side exhaust manifold (16) with 8 bolts (13). Tighten bolts to 25 Ib.-ft. (34 N•m).
8. Install new exhaust pipe seal (1) and secure exhaust pipe (2) to right or left side exhaust
manifold (6 or 16) with 3 studs (15), springs (3), 3 new Iockwashers (4), and nuts (5). Tighten
nuts to 15 Ib.-ft. (20 N•m).
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
Install alternators and alternator brackets if removed (M1010). (See paragraph 4-3)
Install rear battery if removed (M1010). (See paragraph 4-39)
Connect both battery negative cables. (See paragraph 4-38)
TA49828
3-85/(3-86 blank)
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
Paragraph Page
Number Procedures Number
3-87
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
a. DRAINING
WARNING
Never remove radiator cap when engine is hot. Pressurized steam or hot
water will cause serious burns.
2. Open radiator petcock (3) and drain coolant into a suitable container placed under radiator
(1).
TA49829
3-88
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
1. Close radiator petcock (3) and refill cooling system. (See L0 9-2320-289-12 and TB 750-651)
NOTE
Ensure that arrows on radiator cap (2) line up with coolant overflow hose
nipple.
3-89
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
Equipment Condition MaterialslParts
Fan and clutch assembly removed. Antiseize tape (Item 46, Appendix C)
(See paragraph 3-35)
Cooling system drained (if removing
radiator). (See paragraph 3-30)
General Safety Instructions
Servicing of engine cooling system should only be performed on a cool engine.
Compressed air used for cleaning purposes should never exceed 30 psi (207 kPa).
NOTE
Removal of top left screw (3) releases radiator overflow vent tube (5)
from its attachment to fan shroud (2).
If removing fan shroud (2), perform steps 1-7.
1. Remove 2 bolts (4) and 4 screws (3) securing fan shroud (2) to radiator (1).
2. If installed, remove bolt (7) and clip (6) at left side of fan shroud (2).
TA49830
3-90
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
3. Unsnap radiator overflow vent tube (5) from top middle of fan shroud (2).
4. At top left of fan shroud (2), remove bolt from hose support and front axle vent hose.
NOTE
Perform step 5 only if fan shroud (2) is being replaced.
NOTE
Step 6 only applies to trucks equipped with winterization kits.
6. Remove engine coolant heater hose (9) from attachment at top middle of fan shroud (2).
NOTE
Step 11 only applies to trucks
equipped with winterization kits.
TA49831
3-91
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
13. Remove terminal wire and low engine coolant sensor assembly (16).
14. Remove 4 bolts (12) from top and front of upper mounting panel (13).
15. Remove 4 bolts (18) and upper radiator mounting brackets (15 and 17) from frame.
16. Remove radiator (1) and upper and lower radiator insulators (14).
WARNING
Compressed air used for cleaning purposes should never exceed 30 psi
(207 kPa). Use only effective chip guarding and personnel protective
equipment (goggles/shield, gloves, etc.). Failure to follow this warning
may result in serious injury to personnel.
NOTE
1. Use compressed air and water to remove dirt and debris embedded in radiator (1).
TA49832
3-92
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
2. Inspect radiator (1) and soldered seams for breaks, punctures, and splits. Notify your
supervisor if any of these conditions exist.
3. Inspect fan shroud (2) for cracks, splits, or breaks. Notify your supervisor if any of these
conditions exist.
c. INSTALLATION
NOTE
1. install 2 lower radiator mounting insulators (14), radiator (1), and 2 upper radiator mounting
insulators (14).
2. Install 2 upper radiator mounting brackets (15 and 17) with 4 bolts (18).
4. Apply antiseize tape to low engine coolant sensor assembly (16) threads. Install low engine
coolant sensor assembly and install terminal wire to sensor assembly.
TA49833
3-93
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
NOTE
11. Install fan shroud (2) with 2 bolts (4) and 4 screws (3).
12. If removed, install clip (6) and bolt (7) at left side of fan shroud (2).
13. Install radiator overflow vent tube (5) to top middle of fan shroud (2).
NOTE
14. Connect engine coolant heater hose (9) to top middle of fan shroud (2).
15. Install front axle vent tube and hose support to top left of fan shroud (2) with bolt.
TA49834
3-94
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
TA49835
3-95
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
a. REMOVAL
WARNING
1. Position drain pan under coolant reservoir (5). Remove coolant reservoir hose (6) and clamp
(7) from coolant reservoir. Allow coolant to drain from coolant reservoir and coolant reservoir
hose.
TA49836
3-96
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
NOTE
When bolt (4) securing coolant reservoir (5) to mounting bracket (10) is
removed, engine oil sampling valve bracket (3) is also removed. Save it
for installation.
3. Remove bolt (4), engine oil sampling valve bracket (3), and nut (2).
5. Remove forward lamp harness ground wire (1), starwasher, mounting bracket (10), and
coolant reservoir (5). Discard starwasher.
1. Empty coolant reservoir (5) and ensure that it is clean and free of contamination. If required,
wash with soap and water. Rinse thoroughly.
2. Inspect coolant reservoir (5) for cracks, punctures, or splits. If any of these conditions exist,
install new coolant reservoir.
3. Inspect all coolant reservoir (5) mounting hardware. Replace if bent or broken.
c. INSTALLATION
2. Install mounting bracket (10), new starwasher, forward lamp harness ground wire (1), and 2
bolts (9) .
3. Install engine oil sampling valve bracket (3) with bolt (4) and nut (2) through mounting bracket
(10).
3-97
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
a. REMOVAL
WARNING
NOTE
Hose support (1) secures both radiator inlet hose (4) and front axle vent
hose (7) to fan shroud.
1. Remove bolt (3), front axle vent hose (7), and hose support (1).
2. Inspect radiator inlet hose (4) and radiator outlet hose (6) for cracks, punctures, or splits.
Replace if any of these conditions exist.
3. Inspect all clamps (2 and 5) and hose support (1) for signs of damage, wear, or corrosion.
Replace if any of these conditions exist.
c. INSTALLATION
CAUTION
Ensure that extra large tab (hose protector) on clamp (5) is positioned at
bottom when clamp is fully installed to prevent radiator hose damage from
air conditioner or alternator belt.
3-98
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
3. Install front axle vent hose (7) and hose support (1) at fan shroud with bolt (3).
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
TA49837
3-99
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
NOTE
There are 2 types of crossover pipes: standard crossover pipe (15)
which has seatings for 2 nipples (5 and 7) and crossover pipe (6) on
trucks equipped with winterization kits which has a third nipple (12)
seated at a 90° angle.
1. Remove clamp (20) and radiator inlet hose (19) from water outlet (10).
2. Remove 2 bolts (9) at water outlet (10). Remove water outlet and gasket (8). Remove
thermostat assembly (11). Discard gasket.
4.
5.
3-100
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
NOTE
Step 8 only applies to trucks
equipped with winterization kits.
TA49839
3-101
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
NOTE
11. Remove 2 studs (16) and 2 bolts (13) from crossover pipe (6 or 15) at attachments to left and
right cylinder head. Remove crossover pipe and 2 gaskets (14). Discard gaskets.
b. INSTALLATION
NOTE
Ensure that all gaskets and mating surfaces are clean.
NOTE
3-102
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
NOTE
Step 4 only applies to trucks equipped with winterization kits.
4. Apply antiseize tape to threads of nipple (12). Install nipple to crossover pipe (6). Connect
heater hose to nipple.
5. Apply antiseize tape to threads of nipple (5). Install nipple to crossover pipe (6 or 15) and
connect nipple to heater hose.
6. Apply antiseize tape to threads of nipple (7). Install nipple to crossover pipe (6 or 15).
7. Install thermal bypass hose (18) to nipple (7) and to water pump with 2 clamps (17).
TA49841
3-103
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
CAUTION
Ensure that clamp (20) is installed with hose protector tab at bottom. This
tab prevents damage to radiator inlet hose (19) from alternator belt.
12. Install radiator inlet hose (19) at water outlet (10) with clamp (20).
TA49842
3-104
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
TA49843
3-105
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
a. REMOVAL
NOTE
If removing air conditioner belt (4), perform steps 1 and 2.
1. Loosen 3 adjusting bolts (1) and pivot nut (3), and move compressor (2) to right.
3. Loosen 4 nuts (9) securing fan (7) and clutch assembly (8) to studs (10).
4. Remove alternator belts (see paragraph 4-2 or 4-3) and power steering pump belt (see
paragraph 8-15).
TA49844
3-106
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
6. Remove 4 screws (6) and remove fan (7) from clutch assembly (8).
b. INSPECTION
1. Inspect air conditioner belt (4) for cracks, splits, or frayed surfaces.
2. Inspect fan (7) and clutch assembly (8) to ensure that they are not cracked or bent.
4. Inspect all mounting nuts (3 and 9), bolts (1), studs (10), and screws (6) for signs of wear.
5. Inspect all mating surfaces on pulley assembly (5), fan (7), and clutch assembly (8) for
smoothness.
3-107
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
c. INSTALLATION
NOTE
2. Install power steering belt (see paragraph 8-15) and alternator belts (see paragraph 4-2 or
4-3). DO NOT tighten belts at this time.
WARNING
DO NOT repair and reuse a fan (7) with a bent or damaged blade. Replace
fan as an assembly. A damaged fan is out of balance and may fall apart
during use causing serious injury or death to personnel.
3-108
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
10. Move compressor (2) to left until air conditioner belt (4) appears tight.
11. Tighten 3 adjusting bolts (1) and pivot nut (3).
12. Connect both battery negative cables. (See paragraph 4-38)
13. Using a belt tensioning gage, check air conditioner belt (4) tension. (See Appendix E)
TA49847
3-109/(3-110 blank)
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
CHAPTER 4
ELECTRICAL SYSTEMS MAINTENANCE
Paragraph Page
Number Procedures Number
4-1
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
NOTE
If removing belt (11 or 20), perform step 1.
1. Loosen pivot bolt (22) or bolts (10) and adjusting bolt (5 or 19). Rotate alternator (9 or 15) to
loosen belt (11 or 20), then remove belt. Discard belt if worn or damaged.
2. Remove 2 pivot bolts (10), adjusting bolt (5), and washer (4).
3. Remove pivot bolt (22), spacer (26), and adjusting bolt (19).
NOTE
Tag plugs and leads for installation.
4. Disconnect terminal plugs and alternator electrical leads. Remove alternator (9 or 15).
5. Remove 2 nuts (23), washers (24), and support bracket (25). Remove bolt (18), nut (16), and
adjusting bracket (17).
6. Remove bolt (3), nut (7), and brace (6). Remove 3 bolts (2) and adjusting bracket (1).
Remove 2 nuts (14) and bolt (12). Move power steering pump as necessary, and remove
support bracket (13).
4-2
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
TA49848
4-3
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
I b. INSTALLATION I
NOTE
1. Position support bracket (13) on studs (8). Move power steering pump as required and install
support bracket with 2 nuts (14) and bolt (12). Install adjusting bracket (1) with 3 bolts (2).
Install brace (6) with nut (7) and bolt (3).
2. Install adjusting bracket (17) with nut (16) and bolt (18). Position support bracket (25) on studs
(21) and install with 2 washers (24) and nuts (23).
3. Position alternator (9) on brackets (1 and 13) and install with washer (4), adjusting bolt (5),
and 2 pivot bolts (10). DO NOT fully tighten bolts.
4. Position alternator (15) on brackets (17 and 25) and install with spacer (26), pivot bolt (22),
and adjusting bolt (19). DO NOT fully tighten bolts.
CAUTION
Ensure that belt (11 or 20) tension is correct. A belt too loose or too tight
can cause damage to alternator (9 or 15) and belt.
7. Rotate alternator (9 or 15) until belt (11 or 20) appears tight. Tighten adjusting bolt (5 or 19)
and pivot bolt (22) or pivot bolts (10).
9. Using belt tensioning gage, check belt (11 or 20) tension. (See Appendix E)
4-4
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
TA49849
4-5
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
ToolslTest Equipment
Belt tensioning gage
15 mm socket
Torque wrench
NOTE
1. Loosen pivot bolts (1 or 16) and adjusting bolt (6 or 11). Rotate alternator (2 or 17) to loosen
belt (4 or 14). Remove belt. Discard belt if worn or damaged.
2. Remove 2 pivot bolts (1), adjusting bolt (6), and washer (7).
3. Remove adjusting bracket mounting nuts (9), adjusting bolt (11), washer (10), and adjusting
bracket (8). Remove two pivot bolts (16).
NOTE
5. Place alternator (2 or 17) in soft-jawed vise. Remove pulley retaining nut (5 or 15) and remove
alternator pulley (3 or 13).
6. With metric socket, remove studs (12), nut (18), mounting bracket (19), and stud (20) as
required.
4-6
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
TA49850
4-7
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
b. INSTALLATION
NOTE
1. Using metric socket, install stud (20) on engine block through fuel line clamps (21). Position
mounting bracket (19) on stud and install with nut (18) and two studs (12) if removed.
2. Place alternator (2 or 17) in soft-jawed vise. Install alternator pulley (3 or 13) with retaining nut
(5 or 15). Tighten retaining nut to 25-30 Ib.-ft. (34-41 N•m), and remove alternator from vise.
3. Position lower alternator (17) on mounting bracket (19) and install with two pivot bolts (16). DO
NOT tighten bolts. Position adjusting bracket (8) on studs (12) and install with two adjusting
bracket mounting nuts (9). Place washer (10) and adjusting bolt (11) through adjusting
bracket, and install on lower alternator. DO NOT tighten bolt.
4. Install upper alternator (2) on mounting bracket (19) with two pivot bolts (1). DO NOT tighten
bolts. Install upper alternator on adjusting bracket (8) with washer (7) and adjusting bolt (6).
DO NOT tighten bolt.
CAUTION
Ensure that belt (4 or 14) tension is correct. A belt too loose or too tight
can cause damage to alternator (2 or 17) and belt.
7. Rotate alternator (2 or 17) until belt (4 or 14) appears tight. Tighten adjusting bolt (6 or 11) and
pivot bolts (1 or 16).
8. Connect both battery negative cables. (See paragraph 4-38) Connect heater hose to
crossover pipe. (See paragraph 3-34)
4-8
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
4-9
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
a. REMOVAL
CAUTION
b. INSTALLATION
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
TA49852
4-10
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
Equipment Condition MaterialslParts
Both battery negative cables disconnected. One locknut
(See paragraph 4-38) One Iockwasher
a. REMOVAL
NOTE
If removing starter (7), perform steps 1-3.
If removing starter relay, perform step 4.
1. Remove locknut (5), washer (6), bolt
(3), and bracket (4). Discard locknut.
TA49853
4-11
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
NOTE
Note position of battery terminal and solenoid terminal leads (12 and 14)
before removing from solenoid (11).
WARNING
NOTE
1985-87 model starters (7) may
not have shims (10).
b. INSTALLATION
NOTE
If installing starter relay (21),
perform step 1.
4-12
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
WARNING
Support starter (7) during installation. Failure to support starter may cause
it to fall, resulting in injury to personnel.
2. Install starter shield (2) with screw (1) if removed. Support starter (7) and install with inner
screw (9). DO NOT tighten screw (9). Install outer screw (9) through starter. Tighten screws to
33 Ib.-ft. (45 N•m).
NOTE
Ensure that battery terminal lead (12) tab is positioned in slot on solenoid
(11).
3. Install new Iockwasher (13), solenoid terminal lead (14), and battery terminal lead (12) with 2
nuts (15) on solenoid (11).
TA49855
4-13
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
NOTE
Starter pinion tooth-to-flywheel clearance may be measured using a wire
gage.
4. Remove 6 bolts (25) and access
cover (27) from transmission housing
(26) . Measure clearance between
starter pinion (24) tooth and flywheel
(23). Clearance should be 0.02 in. to
0.06 in. (0.50 mm to 1.50 mm). Add
shims (10) as required. Install access
cover (27) with 6 bolts.
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
4-14
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
Paragraph Page
Number Procedures Number
Change 2 4-15
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
a. REMOVAL
NOTE
If removing instrument cluster
plate (10), perform steps 1 and
3.
NOTE
4-16
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
5. Remove 4 screws (8) from white instrument cluster (7) bezel and pull out instrument cluster.
NOTE
If removing any gages, filters,
or gaskets, perform steps 1-8
as required.
If removing instrument cluster
bulbs and sockets, perform
steps 9 and 10.
If removing printed circuit,
perform steps 9-11.
TA49858
4-17
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
2. Remove generator 1 filter (23), generator 2 filter (22), and 4-wheel drive and oil pressure filter
(24) from retainer (25) as required.
4. Remove mounting screw (16) and speedometer (13). Retain gasket on back of speedometer
for installation.
5. Remove seatbelt and brake light filter (27), and remove gasket (26).
TA49859
4-18
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
NOTE
Remove all socket (35) assemblies only if removing printed circuit
(33).
If removing socket (35) assemblies without removing instrument
cluster, reach under instrument panel to gain access to socket
assemblies.
NOTE
If installing printed circuit (33), perform steps 1-3.
4-19
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
NOTE
7. Install gasket (26) and seatbelt and brake light filter (27).
8. Position gasket on back of speedometer (13) if removed. Install speedometer with mounting
screw (16).
10. Install generator 1 filter (23), generator 2 filter (22), and 4-wheel drive and oil pressure filter
(24) by pressing into locking tabs on retainer (25).
11. Install retainer (25) and instrument cluster lens (19) with 6 screws (20).
TA49861
4-20
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
d. INSTALLATION
NOTE
If installing instrument cluster
plate, perform steps 4 and 6.
TA49862
4-21
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
3. Install transmission position indicator (17) with 2 screws (18). Connect cable clip (21) to
steering column. Check indicator needle for proper position and adjust as required.
4. Connect plugs to back of instrument cluster plate (10). Position instrument cluster plate and
loosely install with 5 screws (11) and 3 screws (12). Tighten screws.
5. Connect speedometer cable (6) to back of speedometer (13) by pressing into retaining clip.
4-22
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
TA49864
4-23
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
Equipment Condition Materials/Parts
Both battery negative cables disconnected Two Iockwashers
(if replacing relay). (See paragraph 4-38)
NOTE
If removing module (2), perform steps 1 and 2 .
If removing relay (7), perform steps 3-5.
1. Remove glow plug module housing (1) from bracket under instrument panel to left of steering
column.
2. Remove end cap (3) and remove glow plug module (2).
NOTE
Tag leads for installation.
3. Remove 2 nuts (12), lead (11), 2 washers (10), and 2 leads (9).
TA49865
4-24
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
5. Remove 2 bolts (5) and Iockwashers (6). Remove glow plug relay (7). Discard Iockwashers.
NOTE
If installing relay (7), perform steps 1-3.
1. Install glow plug relay (7) with 2 new Iockwashers (6) and bolts (5).
3. Install 2 leads (9), 2 washers (10), lead (11), and 2 nuts (12).
4. Install glow plug module (2) inside glow plug module housing (1) and install end cap (3).
5. Install glow plug module housing (1) to bracket under instrument panel to left of steering
column.
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
4-25
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
Equipment Condition
Instrument cluster plate removed (if removing voltmeter or door ajar housing). (See
paragraph 4-7)
NOTE
If removing voltmeter (6), perform step 1.
NOTE
If installing generator 2 relay (7) or voltmeter relay (8) for all except
M1010, perform step 1.
1. Install generator 2 relay (7) or voltmeter relay (8) on bracket (10) beside steering column (9).
Connect lead (12) to generator 2 relay or lead (11) to voltmeter relay.
4-26
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
3. Install voltmeter (6) on instrument cluster plate (2). Install retaining bracket (1) with 2 washers
(4) and nuts (5).
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
TA49868
4-27
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
a. REMOVAL
NOTE
1. Depress lock (3) and disconnect speedometer cable (2) from back of speedometer (4).
2. Pull speedometer cable (2) through engine compartment bulkhead (1). Remove grommet (11)
from engine compartment bulkhead if damaged.
4. Loosen nut (8) and disconnect speedometer cable (2) from speedometer adapter assembly
(6) or transfer case.
b. INSTALLATION
NOTE
3. Connect speedometer cable (2) to speedometer adapter assembly (6) or transfer case by
tightening nut (8).
4. Place clip (10) on speedometer cable (2) and install with nut (9).
4-28
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
CAUTION
Use extreme caution when pushing speedometer cable (2) through engine
compartment bulkhead (1) to prevent damage to speedometer cable.
6. Carefully push speedometer cable (2) through engine compartment bulkhead (1).
7. Install speedometer cable (2) on back of speedometer (4) by pushing until it engages on lock
(3) .
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
Connect both battery negative cables. (See paragraph 4-38)
Check operation of speedometer.
TA49869
4-29
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
Equipment Condition Materials/Parts
Speedometer cable and adapter removed. One seal
(See paragraph 4-10)
a. REMOVAL
1. Remove bolt (1) and retainer (2) from transfer case housing (6).
2. Remove sleeve (4) and speedometer gear (5).
3. Remove seal (3) from sleeve (4) and discard.
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
Install speedometer cable and adapter. (See paragraph 4-10)
TA701831
4-29.0 Change 2
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
Equipment Condition
Speedometer cable and adapter removed. (See paragraph 4-10)
1. Remove sleeve (3) and speedometer gear (2) from transfer case retainer (1).
2. Remove speedometer gear (2) from sleeve (3).
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
Install adapter and speedometer cable. (See paragraph 4-10)
TA701832
Change 2 4-29.1
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
Equipment Condition
Both battery negative cables disconnected. (See paragraph 4-38)
a. REMOVAL
NOTE
Tag wiring harness connectors for installation.
NOTE
Step 2 only applies to M1010.
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
TA49870
4-30
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
Materials/Parts
Fuses (as required) (Items 19-24, Appendix C)
CAUTION
4-31
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
a. REMOVAL
NOTE
If removing fuses (19 and 25-28), relays (3, 4, 6, 7, and 17), electrical
studs (15 and 22), circuit breaker (10), and jumper cable (8), perform
step 1 and 2-9 as required.
Relay panel (5) is located in M1010 body left side stowage box.
NOTE
There are four 15 amp receptacle fuses. All are in upper fuse block (23).
2. Remove 15 amp receptacle fuses (28) from upper fuse block (23) if burned out.
3. Remove 25 amp air conditioner fuse (26), 30 amp heater and blackout light fuse (25), and 30
amp heater fuse (27) from lower fuse block (24) if burned out.
5. Disconnect relay plug (18) from 24 v air conditioner relay (17). Remove 2 screws (16) and
remove 24 v air conditioner relay. Repeat as required for gas-particulate filter unit relays (3
and 4), 12 v air conditioner relay (6), and blackout light relay (7).
6. Remove 2 nuts (9). Disconnect service outlet positive lead (20). Remove jumper cable (8)
from circuit breaker (10) and positive electrical stud (22).
7. Remove nut (14) and disconnect service outlet negative lead (13).
8. Disconnect remaining leads from positive electrical stud (22). Remove 2 screws (21) and
positive electrical stud. Repeat as required for negative electrical stud (15).
.
9. Remove nut (11) and disconnect accessory wiring terminal board lead (12). Disconnect
remaining leads from circuit breaker (10). Remove 2 nuts (11) and circuit breaker.
4-32
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
I b. INSTALLATION
CAUTION
NOTE
Perform steps 1-8 as required and step 9 to install fuses (19 and 25-28),
relays (3, 4, 6, 7, and 17), electrical studs (15 and 22), circuit breaker
(10), and jumper cable (8).
1. Install circuit breaker (10) with 2 nuts (11). Connect disconnected leads. Install accessory
wiring terminal board lead (12) with nut (11).
2. Install positive electrical stud (22) with 2 screws (21). Connect disconnected leads. Repeat as
required for negative electrical stud (15).
TA49872
4-33
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
5. Install 24 v air conditioner relay (17) with 2 screws (16). Connect relay plug (18) to 24 v air
conditioner relay. Repeat as required for gas-particulate filter unit relays (3 and 4), 12 v air
conditioner relay (6), and blackout light relay (7).
6. Install 25 amp air conditioner fuse (26), 30 amp heater and blackout light fuse (25), and 30
amp heater fuse (27) on lower fuse block (24) if removed.
7. Install 20 amp in-line air conditioner fuse (19) if removed.
8. Install 15 amp receptacle fuses (28) on upper fuse block (23) if removed.
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
Connect both battery negative cables. (See paragraph 4-38)
Check operation of applicable circuit.
TA49873
4-34
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
NOTE
If removing oil pressure sending unit (2), perform step 1.
If removing coolant temperature sending unit (4), perform step 2.
NOTE
If installing coolant temperature
sending unit (4), perform step
1.
If installing oil pressure sending
unit (2), perform step 2.
4-35
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
TA49875
4-36
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
NOTE
If removing headlight control (3), perform step 1.
1. Pull out headlight control (3) and depress release button (4) on side of switch assembly (1) to
remove headlight control.
NOTE
2. Unscrew bezel (2) to disengage switch assembly (1). Disconnect leads at switch assembly
and remove.
NOTE
If installing headlight control (3), perform step 2.
1. Connect leads to switch assembly (1). Hold switch assembly in place and screw on bezel (2)
to install.
2. Push headlight control (3) through bezel (2) to engage switch assembly (1).
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
4-37
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
Equipment Condition Materials/Parts
Both battery negative cables disconnected. One Iockwasher
(See paragraph 4-38)
a. REMOVAL
NOTE
If removing stoplight switch (2), perform step 1.
Tag lead for installation.
b. INSTALLATION
NOTE
If installing stoplight switch (2),
perform steps 3 and 4.
NOTE
Clicking sound will be heard as stoplight switch (2) is installed in
retainer (8).
4. Install stoplight switch (2) in retainer (8). Pull brake pedal (4) back until pedal stops making
clicking sound.
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
Connect both battery negative cables. (See paragraph 4-38)
Check operation of stoplight.
TA49877
4-38
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
Equipment Condition
Both battery negative cables disconnected. (See paragraph 4-38)
Hazard flasher removed from fuse box. (See paragraph 4-12)
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
Install hazard flasher on fuse box. (See paragraph 4-12)
Connect both battery negative cables. (See paragraph 4-38)
Check operation of parking brake indicator light.
TA49878
4-39
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
Equipment Condition
Both battery negative cables disconnected. (See paragraph 4-38)
Instrument cluster plate removed. (See paragraph 4-7)
a. REMOVAL
1. Remove nut (3) and washer (4). Remove switch (2) and washer (5). Disconnect lead (1) from
switch.
1. Connect lead (1) to switch (2). Install washer (5) on switch and place switch through mounting
plate (6). Install washer (4) and nut (3) on switch.
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
TA49879
4-40
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
Equipment Condition
Both battery negative cables disconnected. (See paragraph 4-38)
1. Set parking brake and place transmission gearshift lever in “N” (Neutral).
2. Unsnap back-up light switch (2) at tangs (5) to remove from steering column jacket (1).
3. Disconnect lead from back-up light switch (2). Remove back-up light switch.
b. INSTALLATION
2. Aline actuator (3) on back-up light switch (2) with hole in shift tube (4).
3. Position back-up light switch (2) on cutout in lower part of steering column jacket (1).
TA49880
4-41
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
4. Push down on front of back-up light switch (2). Snap 2 tangs (5) on back-up light switch into
place on steering column jacket (1).
5. Adjust back-up light switch (2) by moving transmission gearshift lever to “P“ (Park). Main
back-up light switch housing and back-up light switch housing back should make a clicking
noise, providing proper adjustment.
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
TA49881
4-42
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
Equipment Condition
Both battery negative cables disconnected. (See paragraph 4-38)
b. INSTALLATION
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
TA49882
4-43
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
Equipment Condition
Instrument cluster plate removed. (See paragraph 4-7)
1. Remove screw (7) and retainer (6) from back of instrument panel (1). Remove switch cover
(3) and switch plate (2). Remove 1 or both floodlight switches (5) and GPFU switch (4) as
required.
1. Install 1 or both floodlight switches (5) and GPFU switch (4) on switch cover (3) if removed.
Position switch plate (2) and switch cover on instrument panel (1). Install retainer (6) on back
of instrument panel and on back of switch plate with screw (7).
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
Install instrument cluster plate. (See paragraph 4-7)
Check operation of floodlight and gas-particulate filter unit.
TA49883
4-44
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
Equipment Condition
Both battery negative cables disconnected. (See paragraph 4-38)
Radiator grille removed. (See paragraph 10-2)
NOTE
If removing horn (8), perform steps 1 and 2.
If removing capacitor (6), perform steps 1 and 3.
If removing horn relay (2), perform step 4.
TA49884
4-45
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
b. INSTALLATION
NOTE
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
Install radiator grille. (See paragraph 10-2)
Connect both battery negative cables. (See paragraph 4-38)
Check operation of horn.
TA49885
4-46
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
Equipment Condition
Both battery negative cables disconnected. (See paragraph 4-38)
b. INSTALLATION
3. Connect combination valve connector (3) to brake indicator light bracket (1).
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
TA702217
TM 9-2320-289-20
Paragraph Page
Number Procedures Number
Change 2 4-47
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
a. REMOVAL
NOTE
DO NOT tamper with headlight adjusting screws (6).
2. Unhook spring (4) from radiator support (3) and remove mounting ring (2).
3. Pull out headlight (1) and disconnect from wiring harness connector.
4. Remove 4 screws (8) and retaining ring (7). Remove headlight (1).
TA49886
4-48 Change 2
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
b. INSTALLATION
1. Position headlight (1) in mounting ring (2). Install retaining ring (7) on mounting ring with 4
screws (8).
c. ADJUSTMENT
3. Subtract 3 in. from measurement obtained in step 1 and mark it on a vertical surface.
4. Mark centerline of vehicle on vertical surface and intersect it with line obtained in step 2.
5. Measure distance between centers of headlights. Divide that distance equally on both sides of
centerline of vehicle line and mark along line in step 2.
NOTE
Adjust 1 headlight at a time while covering the other.
7. Turn adjusting screws (6) in or out until center of beam intersects with crossed line in step 4.
Change 2 4-49
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
a. REMOVAL
NOTE
If removing lamp (3), perform step 1.
1. Remove cover (1), “O” ring (2), and gasket (13). Remove lamp (3).
TA49887
4-50
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
2. Remove nut (11) and Iockwasher (10). Pull out blackout light housing (4) from mounting
bracket (6) and remove 2 washers (12). Disconnect lead (5) and remove housing. Discard
Iockwasher.
3. Remove 4 bolts (9), mounting bracket (6), and 4 retaining nuts (7) from radiator support (8).
b. INSTALLATION
NOTE
If installing mounting bracket (6), perform steps 1 and 2.
1. Install 4 retaining nuts (7) on radiator support (8). Install mounting bracket (6) with 4 bolts (9).
2. Connect lead (5). Install 2 washers (12) on blackout light housing (4). Install blackout light
housing on mounting bracket (6) with new Iockwasher (10) and nut (11).
3. Install lamp (3). Install gasket (13), “O” ring (2), and cover (1).
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
4-51
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
b. INSTALLATION
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
Check operation of parking light.
TA49888
4-52
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
NOTE
TA49889
4-53
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
b. INSTALLATION
NOTE
If installing blackout marker light bracket (9), perform steps 1 and 2.
1. Install mounting bracket (9) on bumper (14) with bolt (7) and nut (12).
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
4-54
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
4-28. TAILLIGHT AND LAMP REPLACEMENT (ALL EXCEPT M1010 AND M1031).
INITIAL SETUP:
a. REMOVAL
1. Remove 4 screws (11), taillight lens (1), and gasket (3). Remove turn signal lamp (5),
back-up lamp (8), and stop lamp (10) as required.
NOTE
3. Remove turn signal lamp socket (6), back-up lamp socket (7), and stop lamp socket (9) as
required.
b. INSTALLATION
1. Install turn signal lamp socket (6), back-up lamp socket (7), and stop lamp socket (9) on
wiring harness if removed.
TA49891
4-55
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
4-28. TAILLIGHT AND LAMP REPLACEMENT (ALL EXCEPT M1010 AND M1031)
(Con’t).
3. Install turn signal lamp (5), back-up lamp (8), and stop lamp (10) as required. Install gasket
(3) and taillight lens (1) with 4 screws (11).
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
4-56
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
a. REMOVAL
NOTE
1. Remove 4 screws (10) and taillight lens (9). Retain taillight lens gasket for installation.
NOTE
Tag sockets for installation.
2. Remove stoplight lamp (12) and back-up light lamp (11) as required.
TA49893
4-57
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
NOTE
3. Remove 2 nuts (16), Iockwashers (15), and ground (14). Discard Iockwashers.
NOTE
4. Remove nut (5) and Iockwasher (6). Remove and discard plastic ties if present. Unplug wiring
harness leads from wiring harness connector. Remove taillight housing (8) from taillight
mounting bracket (7) and blackout light mounting bracket (13). Discard Iockwasher.
5. Remove 2 nuts (4), screws (1), and Iockwashers (2). Remove taillight mounting bracket (7).
Discard Iockwashers.
TA49894
4-58
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
b. INSTALLATION
NOTE
If installing taillight housing (8), perform steps 2-6. Install both lamps
(11 and 12) in step 5.
1. Install taillight mounting bracket (7) on frame rail (3) with 2 new Iockwashers (2), screws (1),
and nuts (4).
2. Plug wiring harness leads into wiring harness connector and install taillight housing (8) on
taillight mounting bracket (7) with new Iockwasher (6) and nut (5). Install plastic ties as
required.
NOTE
3. Position blackout light mounting bracket (13) on taillight housing (8) studs.
NOTE
5. Install stoplight lamp (12) and back-up light lamp (11) as required.
6. Install taillight lens (9) gasket and taillight lens with 4 screws (10).
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
4-59
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
4-30. REAR BLACKOUT LIGHT REPLACEMENT (ALL EXCEPT M1010 AND M1031).
INITIAL SETUP:
Equipment Condition Materials/Parts
Both battery negative cables disconnected. Plastic ties (as required)
(See paragraph 4-38)
NOTE
If removing rear blackout light (6) only, perform steps 1-3.
b. INSTALLATION
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
Connect both battery negative cables. (See paragraph 4-38)
Check operation of rear blackout light.
TA49895
4-60
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
Equipment Condition
Both battery negative cables disconnected.(See paragraph 4-38)
a. REMOVAL
NOTE
NOTE
1. Install blackout light (2) on mounting bracket (3) with 2 nuts (1).
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
4-61
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
Equipment Condition
Both battery negative cables disconnected. (See paragraph 4-38)
NOTE
Fluorescent tube (2) is spring-
Ioaded at rear socket (3).
b. INSTALLATION
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
Connect both battery negative cables. (See paragraph 4-38)
Check operation of surgical light.
TA49897
4-62
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
Equipment Condition
Both battery negative cables disconnected, (See paragraph 4-38)
a. REMOVAL
b. INSTALLATION
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
TA49898
4-63
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
NOTE
On 1984 model trucks, leads are attached to floodlight housing (3) by
rivets, and to floodlight lamp (1) by screws.
1. Pry floodlight lamp (1) away from floodlight housing (3). Disconnect leads (2) from floodlight
lamp and remove floodlight lamp.
2. Remove nut (8), Iockwasher (6), and bolt (4). Disconnect electrical plug from ambulance
body connector. Remove floodlight housing (3).
4-64
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
NOTE
3. From back of floodlight housing (3), press retainer clip together and remove 2 leads (2) as
required. Remove bolt (7) and mounting bracket (5) as required.
b. INSTALLATION
NOTE
If installing floodlight lamp (1), perform step 3.
1. Install mounting bracket (5) with bolt (7) if removed. From back of floodlight housing (3),
press retainer clip together and install 2 leads (2) if removed.
2. Position floodlight housing (3) on mounting bracket (5). Connect electrical plug to ambulance
body connector. Install floodlight housing with bolt (4), new Iockwasher (6), and nut (8).
3. Connect leads (2) to floodlight lamp (1). Install floodlight lamp in floodlight housing (3).
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
4-65
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
Equipment Condition Materials/Parts
Both battery negative cables disconnected. Two rivets
(See paragraph 4-38)
NOTE
If removing focus light lamp (3), perform step 1.
If removing focus light assembly, perform step 2.
If removing switch (4.1), perform steps 1, 3, and 4.
b. INSTALLATION
NOTE
If installing switch, perform steps 1, 2, and 4.
If installing focus light assembly, perform step 3.
If installing focus light lamp (3), perform step 4.
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
Connect both battery negative cables. (See paragraph 4-38)
Check operation of focus light.
TA701833
4-66 Change 2
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
Equipment Condition
Both battery negative cables disconnected. (See paragraph 4-38)
a. REMOVAL
NOTE
If removing spotlight lamp (1), perform step 1.
1. Remove screw (8). Pull spotlight lamp (1) and bracket (9) assembly out and disconnect
spotlight housing (3) leads. Remove 4 clips (2) holding spotlight lamp to bracket. Remove
spotlight lamp.
TA49901
4-67
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
NOTE
Tag lead for installation.
NOTE
Retain mounting hardware for
installation.
NOTE
If installing spotlight assembly (11), perform steps 1-3.
If installing spotlight lamp (1), perform step 4.
1. Install gasket (12) and spotlight bracket (5) on roof with 4 bolts (10), washers (13), and nuts
(14). Screw spotlight housing (3) onto shaft (4). Place spotlight assembly (11) through
spotlight bracket and gasket.
2. Position spacer (15) and handle (6) on shaft (4). Tighten bolt (7) to install handle.
TA49902
4-68
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
TA49903
TM 9-2320-289-20
Paragraph Page
Number Procedures Number
4-71
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
Manual References
TM 9-6140-200-14
WARNING
a. CABLE DISCONNECTION
NOTE
If truck is not equipped with winterization kits, perform steps 2-5.
2. Slide back cover (23) from clamp (22) of negative cable (3). Loosen nut (21) and disconnect
negative cable from front battery (4) negative (-) terminal. Rotate cover to underside of
clamp.
4-72
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
3. Slide back cover (23) from clamp (22) of connector cable (9) at rear battery (19) negative (-)
terminal. Loosen nut (21) and disconnect connector cable. Rotate cover to underside of
clamp.
4. Slide back cover (23) from clamp (22) of connector cable (9). Loosen nut (21) and
disconnect connector cable from front battery (4) positive (+) terminal. Rotate cover to
underside of clamp.
TA49904
4-73
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
5. Slide back cover (23) from clamp (22) of positive cable (11). Loosen nut (21) and disconnect
positive cable from rear battery (19) positive (+) terminal. Rotate cover to underside of clamp.
1. See TM 9-6140-200-14.
c. CABLE REMOVAL
NOTE
Battery cables may be pulled through clips (5 and 13) and retainers (10
and 16), without removing clips or retainers. Remove as required.
2. Remove bolt (2), starwasher, and washer (1). Remove battery ground (25) and frame ground
lead, and position clear of battery terminals.
3. Remove bolt (12) and clip (13) from negative cable (3), connector cable (9), and 2 slave
receptacle cables (24). Remove retaining nut (14) as required.
NOTE
4. Remove nut and Iockwasher from lower accessory wiring terminal board (15) stud and
disconnect negative cable (3). Discard Iockwasher.
5. Remove retainer (10) from negative cable (3), starter lead (20), and 2 slave receptacle cables
(24). Remove 2 locknuts (6), clips (5), screws (8), and washers (7) from negative cable,
starter lead, and slave receptacle cables. Remove negative cable. Discard locknuts.
NOTE
6. Remove nuts (18), leads, and connector cable (9) from engine wiring harness block (17).
7. Remove 3 retainers (16) from connector cable (9) as required. Remove connector cable.
8. Remove nut and Iockwasher from upper accessory wiring terminal board (15) stud and
disconnect positive cable (11). Remove positive cable. Discard Iockwasher.
4-74
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
TA49905
4-75
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
d. CABLE INSTALLATION
NOTE
If installing positive cable (11), perform step 1.
1. Install positive cable (11) on upper accessory wiring terminal board (15) stud with new
Iockwasher and nut.
NOTE
DO NOT connect connector cable (9) to front battery (4) terminal if
hold-down bracket was removed.
3. Install connector cable (9) and leads on engine wiring harness block (17) with nuts (18).
4. Install 2 clips (5) on negative cable (3), starter lead (20), and slave receptacle cables (24)
with two screws (8), washers (7), and new locknuts (6) if removed. Install retainer (10) on
negative cable, starter lead, and slave receptacle cables if removed.
5. Install negative cable (3) on lower accessory wiring terminal board (15) stud with new
Iockwasher and nut.
6. Install retaining nut (14) if removed. Install clip (13) on connector cable (9), negative cable
(3), and slave receptacle cables (24). Install clip with bolt (12) if removed.
7. Install starwasher, frame ground lead, and battery ground (25) with washer (1) and bolt (2).
e. CABLE CONNECTION
NOTE
If truck is not equipped with winterization kits, perform steps 2-5.
1. Install grommets (28) on any disconnected battery cable. Fit grommets into battery box
notches as required.
2. Install positive cable (11) clamp (22) on rear battery (19) positive (+) terminal. Tighten nut
(21) and slide cover (23) over clamp.
3. Install connector cable (9) clamp (22) on front battery (4) positive (+) terminal. Tighten nut
(21) and slide cover (23) over clamp.
4-76
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
TA49906
4-77
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
4. Install connector cable (9) clamp (22) on rear battery (19) negative (-) terminal. Tighten nut
(21) and slide cover (23) over clamp.
5. Install negative cable (3) clamp (22) on front battery (4) negative (-) terminal. Tighten nut
(21) and slide cover (23) over clamp.
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
4-78
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
WARNING
Remove all jewelry such as dog tags, rings, bracelets, etc. If jewelry or
disconnected battery ground cable contacts battery terminal, a direct
short will result, causing serious injury or death to personnel.
NOTE
4-79
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
WARNING
4. If indicator (5) appears dark with no green dot, recharge and test battery. (See
TM 9-6140-200-14)
6. Remove battery caps and check electrolyte level. If level is low, notify your supervisor.
9. If corroded, clean battery posts and cable connections with wire brush and soda solution, and
lightly coat battery posts with grease. If damaged, replace as required.
TA49908
4-80
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
b. REMOVAL
NOTE
Batteries in trucks with winterization kits are removed from battery box
instead of battery tray.
Battery supports and trays are factory-installed with hex nuts and body
studs instead of bolts (7) and mounting nuts (8). Replace hex nuts and
body studs with bolts and mounting nuts if damaged.
If removing front battery, perform step 1.
If removing front battery tray and supports, perform steps 1-3.
If removing rear battery, perform step 4.
If removing rear battery tray and supports, perform steps 4-6.
If replacing maintenance-free battery with 6TN battery, support rods
must be repositioned to outboard threaded holes.
1. Remove 2 bolts (7) and nuts (8). Remove front battery hold-down bracket (9). Remove front
battery.
Change 2 4-81
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
2. Remove 2 support rods (24). Remove 2 nuts (25), support (6), and reinforcement bracket (23)
as required.
3. Remove 2 nuts (21), 4 bolts (20), and front battery tray and support (22).
4. Remove 3 nuts (13), bolt (12), and rear battery hold-down bracket (14) and support (11)
assembly. Remove 2 nuts (10), and separate rear battery hold-down bracket and support.
5. Remove rear battery. Remove 2 support rods (15). Remove mounting nut (16) as required.
6. Remove 2 nuts (18), 4 bolts (19), and rear battery tray and support (17).
TA49910
4-82 Change 2
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
c. INSTALLATION
NOTE
Batteries in trucks with winterization kits are installed in battery box (3)
instead of battery tray. If truck is not equipped with winterization kits,
perform steps 1-6.
If installing rear battery tray and supports (11 and 17), perform steps 1
and 2.
If installing rear battery, perform steps 1-3.
If installing front battery tray and supports (6 and 22), perform steps 4-6.
If installing front battery, perform step 6.
1. Install rear battery tray and support (17) with 4 bolts (19) and 2 nuts (18).
NOTE
If replacing maintenance-free battery with 6TN battery, support rods must
be installed in outboard threaded holes.
2. Install mounting nut (16) if removed. Install short threaded end of 2 support rods (15) on rear
battery tray and support (17).
NOTE
Negative (-) terminal should face toward front of truck.
3. Position rear battery on rear battery tray and support (17) on battery box (3). Install support (11)
on rear battery hold-down bracket (14) with 2 nuts (10). Install rear battery hold-down bracket
and support (11) assembly with 3 nuts (13) and bolt (12).
4. Install front battery tray and support (22) with 4 bolts (20) and 2 nuts (21).
NOTE
If replacing maintenance-free battery with 6TN battery, support rods must
be installed in outboard threaded holes.
5. Mount reinforcement bracket (23) in fender, if removed. Install support (6) on reinforcement
bracket with 2 nuts (25), if removed. Install short threaded end of 2 support rods (24) on front
battery tray and support (22).
NOTE
Negative (-) terminal should face toward right side of truck.
6. Position front battery on front battery tray and support (22) or battery box (3). Install front battery
hold-down bracket (9) with 2 nuts (8) and bolts (7).
7. Install battery retainer (1) on hook bolts (4) with 2 nuts (2). Tighten nuts to 40-60 lb.-in.
(5-7 N•m).
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
Change 2 4-83
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
NOTE
If removing slave receptacle cables (6 and 20), perform steps 1 and 2.
Tag terminal studs and both ends of slave receptacle cables (6 and 20)
for-installation.
1. Loosen nuts (4) and remove accessory wiring terminal board covers (1). Remove 2 nuts and
Iockwashers from accessory wiring terminal board studs (2 and 3). Disconnect positive cable
(6) from stud (2). Disconnect negative cable (20) from stud (3). Discard Iockwashers.
4-84
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
NOTE
NOTE
Ensure that 1 bolt (19) is installed through slave receptacle cover (18)
retainer cord.
5. Install slave receptacle (17) and 2 spacers (10) with 4 bolts (19) and nuts (11).
TA49912
4-85
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
4-86
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
4-87
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
Equipment Condition
Both battery negative cables disconnected. (See paragraph 4-38)
1. Remove 4 nuts (7), washers (6), and bolts (5), and remove trailer electrical receptacle door
(4). Unplug trailer electrical receptacle (1) from wiring harness (2) and remove.
1. Place trailer electrical receptacle (1) through bumper (3) and connect to wiring harness (2).
Aline trailer electrical receptacle holes with holes in bumper. Install trailer electrical receptacle
door (4) and trailer electrical receptacle with 4 bolts (5), washers (6), and nuts (7).
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
4-88
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
Equipment Condition
Both battery negative cables disconnected. (See paragraph 4-38)
NOTE
Tag leads for installation.
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
C o n n e c t both battery negative cables. (See paragraph 4-38)
TA49915
4-89/(4-90 blank)
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
Paragraph Page
Number Procedures Number
4-91
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
a. REMOVAL
NOTE
If removing resistors (7), perform steps 4-6.
1. Loosen 2 nuts (16) and remove accessory wiring terminal board cover (1).
NOTE
Tag both ends of leads (5 and 9) and terminal for installation.
2. Remove nut (2) and starwasher (3), and disconnect lead (5) from accessory wiring terminal
board (4).
3. Remove nut and washer, and disconnect lead (9) from glow plug relay (13).
4. Remove 3 bolts (15) and Iockwashers (14), and remove bracket and resistor assembly (6).
5. Remove 4 nuts (10) and bolts (12), and separate resistor (7) assembly from bracket (6).
6. Remove 2 nuts (8) and screws (11), and separate 2 resistors (7) from lead (5) and lead (9).
b. INSTALLATION
1. Assemble 2 resistors (7), lead (5), and lead (9) with 2 screws (11) and nuts (8).
2. Attach resistor (7) assembly to bracket (6) with 4 bolts (12) and nuts (10).
3. Install bracket and resistor assembly (6) with 3 new Iockwashers (14) and bolts (15).
4. Connect lead (9) to glow plug relay (13) with nut and washer.
5. Connect lead (5) to accessory wiring terminal board (4) with starwasher (3) and nut (2).
6. Position accessory wiring terminal board cover (1) and tighten 2 nuts (16).
4-92
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
TA49916
4-93
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
NOTE
If removing radio feed harness (2) from all except M1009, perform
steps 1-5 and steps 7-11.
1. Remove 11 straps from radio feed harness (2) and winterization kit cargo compartment heater
wiring harness. Discard straps.
NOTE
2. Remove screw (14) or nut and clip (7) from radio feed harness (2).
3. Remove screw (12) and clip (13) from wiring harness (2).
4. Remove nut (11), washer (10), screw (16), and clip (15).
6. Pull floor mat and pad away from passenger compartment floor.
NOTE
Only M1009 radio feed harness grommet (5) uses rivets (1).
4-94
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
TA49917
4-95
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
4-96
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
b. INSTALLATION
NOTE
If installing radio feed harness (2) on M1009, perform steps 1, 2,
4 through 7, 10, and 11.
If installing radio feed harness (2) on all except M1009, perform steps
1-5 and steps 7-11.
NOTE
Only M1009 radio feed harness grommet (5) uses rivets (1).
6. Install floor mat and pad into place on passenger compartment floor.
7. Install clips (8) with screws (6).
8. Install clip (15) with screw (16), washer (10), and nut (11).
NOTE
M1009 clip (7) is attached to stud with nut.
NOTE
Step 11 only applies to M1008A1 equipped with winterization kit cargo
compartment heater.
11. Install 11 new straps around winterization kit cargo compartment heater wiring harness and
radio feed harness (2).
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
Install cargo compartment floor panel insulators if removed. (See paragraph 11-28 or 11-31)
Install radio feed leads. (See paragraph 4-46)
Check operation of radio.
4-97
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
Equipment Condition Materials/Parts
Both battery negative cables disconnected. Ten Iockwashers
(See paragraph 4-38)
a. REMOVAL
NOTE
Procedures for removing accessory wiring terminal board and radio
terminal board are similar.
If removing accessory wiring terminal board (5 or 19), perform steps
1-4 and steps 6-8.
If removing radio terminal board (5 or 19), perform steps 1-3, 5, 6, 9,
and 10.
1. Loosen nuts (11) and remove terminal board covers (10 or 12) as required.
4-98
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
2. Remove snaprings (13) holding nuts (11) in place and remove nuts if damaged.
NOTE
4. Disconnect leads from positive terminal board (5) and negative terminal board (19) as
required. Remove connectors (6 and 17) and capacitor (22) as required.
NOTE
5. Disconnect radio feed wiring harness (14) leads from upper terminal board (5) and lower
terminal board (19). Remove connectors (6 and 17) as required.
7. Remove 6 bolts (2) and nuts (8), and remove positive accessory wiring terminal board (5).
TA49920
4-99
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
8. Remove 4 bolts (21) and nuts (18), and remove negative accessory wiring terminal board
(19).
9. Remove 2 bolts (2), washers (3), and nuts (8), and remove upper radio terminal board (5).
10, Remove 2 bolts (21), washers (1), and nuts (18), and remove lower radio terminal board (19).
NOTE
Procedures for installing accessory wiring terminal board and radio
terminal board are similar.
1. Install lower radio terminal board (19) with 2 nuts (18), bolts (21), and washers (1).
2. Install upper radio terminal board (5) with 2 nuts (8), bolts (2), and washers (3).
TA49921
4-100
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
3. Install negative accessory wiring terminal board (19) with 4 nuts (18) and bolts (21).
4. Install positive accessory wiring terminal board (5) with 6 nuts (8) and bolts (2).
7. Connect radio feed wiring harness (14) leads to upper terminal board (5) and lower terminal
board (19).
9. Connect leads to positive terminal board (5) and negative terminal board (19) if removed.
11. Install nuts (11) on terminal board covers (10 or 12) with snaprings (13) if removed.
12. Install terminal board covers (10 or 12) by tightening nuts (11).
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
4-101
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
a. REMOVAL
NOTE
2. Remove 3 bolts (3), lockwashers (2), and braces (6) as required. Discard Iockwashers.
3. Remove 3 bolts (5) and washers (4), and remove radio mounting bracket (1).
b. INSTALLATION
CAUTION
Ensure that rear passenger seat is pushed to its most rearward position
before installing radio mounting bracket (1). Rack corner and edge of
platform could damage seatback.
NOTE
1. Install radio mounting bracket (1) with 3 washers (4) and bolts (5).
NOTE
Ensure that longest brace (6) is installed toward front of truck and shortest
brace is installed toward rear of truck.
2. Install 3 braces (6) on radio mounting bracket (1) with 3 new Iockwashers (2) and bolts (3).
3. Install 3 new Iockwashers (8) and bolts (7) on 3 braces (6) and mounting brackets (9).
4-102
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
TA49923
4-103
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
Personnel Required
MOS 63B ( 2 )
a REMOVAL
NOTE
Only M1008A1 trucks have communications racks (14).
If removing junction box (4), perform steps 1 and 2.
TA49924
4-104
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
3. Remove nut (6), 2 Iockwashers (7), Iockwashers (8), and screw (9). Remove nut (17), screw
(13), Iockwasher (12), and strap (10). Discard lockwashers.
NOTE
Support reinforcement brackets (16) under cargo bed during removal.
NOTE
Step 5 only applies to trucks equipped with winterization kit cargo
compartment heater.
TA49925
4-105
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
NOTE
If installing communications rack (14), perform steps 1-4, and 6.
NOTE
Step 2 only applies to trucks equipped with winterization kit cargo
compartment heater.
TA49926
4-106
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
NOTE
Support reinforcement brackets (16) under cargo bed during installation.
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
Connect both battery negative cables. (See paragraph 4-38)
TA49927
4-107/(4-108 blank)
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
CHAPTER 5
TRANSMISSION AND TRANSFER CASE MAINTENANCE
Paragraph Page
Number Procedures Number
Change 2 5-1
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
WARNING
NOTE
5-2
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
NOTE
TA49633
5-3
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
WARNING
Compressed air used for cleaning purposes will not exceed 30 psi
(207 kPa). Use only effective chip guarding and personnel protective
equipment (goggles/shield, gloves). Failure to follow this warning may
result in serious injury to personnel.
NOTE
When cleaning magnet (12),
ensure that all metal filings are
removed.
NOTE
Note markings on intake pipe (14)
and ensure that it is installed
properly. One end is marked
“FILTER” and other end is marked
“CASE.“
5-4
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
3. Install new transmission oil filter assembly (9), spacer (8), new screen grommet (13), intake
pipe (14), and seal (7) into transmission housing with bolt (10), ensuring that locating tab is
alined. Tighten bolt to 125-160 lb.-in. (14–18 N•m).
NOTE
If installing a new transmission oil pan gasket (11) with transmission oil
pan (2), perform steps 4 and 6 through 12.
4. Install new transmission oil pan gasket (11) on lip of transmission oil pan (2) and aline with
screw holes.
NOTE
Transmission oil pan (1) must be clean and dry before applying RTV
sealant.
5. Apply a 3/16 in. (4.7 mm) bead of RTV sealant around lip of transmission oil pan (2).
7. Install transmission oil pan (2) with 13 transmission oil pan screws (5). Evenly tighten screws to
125-160 lb.-in. (14-18 N•m).
NOTE
Steps 8 and 9 only apply to trucks equipped with winterization kits.
5-5
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
Equipment Conditions
Both battery negative cables disconnected. (See paragraph 4-38)
Air cleaner removed. (See paragraph 3-9)
TA701834
5-5.0 Change 2
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
b. INSTALLATION
3. Install 2 clips (2) to vacuum pipe (5). Install 2 clips to valve cover studs (3) with 2 nuts (1).
4. Install CDRV assembly (4) mounting bracket to valve cover and intake manifold with 3 nuts.
7. Install clip (10) to fill tube assembly (9) and vacuum pipe (5).
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
TA701835
Change 2 5-5.1
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
5-3. TRANSFER CASE PLATE AND BOOT REPLACEMENT (M1028A1 AND M1031).
b. INSTALLATION
5-6
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
5-4. TRANSFER CASE BEZEL AND BOOT REPLACEMENT (ALL EXCEPT M1028A1
AND M1031).
a. REMOVAL
NOTE
When installing bezel assembly
(7), lever assembly (8) must pass
through bezel’s central slot (4).
TA49637
5-7
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
NOTE
1. Remove 2 cotter pins (4), washers (9), and spring washers (10) from selector rod (1). Discard
cotter pins and spring washers.
2. Remove selector rod (1) from link (11) and control lever (2). Remove grommet (12) and
discard if damaged.
3. Remove fitting (7), pivot bolt (8), and 3 washers (5) from control lever (2).
5. Count threads where jam nut (3) rests on threaded end of control lever (2) and tag for
installation. Remove jam nut and retain for later use.
b. INSPECTION
1. Inspect selector rod (1) for breaks, bends, corrosion, or other signs of wear. Replace as
required.
2. Inspect all other components for cracks, corrosion, or other signs of wear. Replace as
required.
NOTE
1. Install jam nut (3) on threaded end of control lever (2), leaving same number of threads
showing as when removed.
2. Install control lever (2), 3 washers (5), pivot bolt (8) and fitting (7).
5-8
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
4. Install selector rod (1) into link (11) and control lever (2), with 2 new spring washers (10),
washers (9), and new cotter pins (4).
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
If control lever was replaced, install transfer case plate and boot. (See paragraph 5-3)
TA49638
5-9
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
WARNING
NOTE
1. Remove cotter pin (13) and washer (12) at actuator lever (9). Discard cotter pin.
2. Remove 8 bolts (4) and washers (5) at guide (3) and housing (11). Remove guide and housing
with assembled control lever assembly from truck. Remove seal (19).
3. Remove nut (14), washer (15), and bushing (16) securing actuator lever (9) to housing (11),
4. Remove 2 bolts (10) and locknuts (17), and remove actuator lever (9) from fork (7) and
housing (11). Discard locknuts.
5. Remove cotter pin (18), washer (1), and pin (8) and remove control lever (2), spring (6), and
fork (7). Discard cotter pin,
6. Place operating lever (20) into “4L” position. Remove cotter pin (22), washer (21), and rod
(29) from operating lever. Remove grommet (31 ) and discard if damaged. Discard cotter pin.
7. Remove nut (25), swivel (26), and nut (27) from rod (29). Remove grommet (24) if worn or
damaged.
8. Remove nut (30), Iockwasher (28), and operating lever (20) from transfer case (23) as
required. Discard Iockwasher.
5-10
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
TA49639
5-11
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
b. INSTALLATION
WARNING
NOTE
1. Install control lever (2) and spring (6) to fork (7) with pin (8), washer (1), and new cotter pin
(18).
TA49640
5-12
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
2. Position actuator lever (9) through housing (11) and install to fork (7) with 2 bolts (10) and new
locknuts (17).
3. Install actuator lever (9) to housing (11) with bushing (16), washer (15), and nut (14).
4. Place guide (3) through control lever (2). Install seal (19) and housing (11) with assembled
control lever assembly to floor of truck with 8 bolts (4) and washers (5).
5. If removed, install operating lever (20) to transfer case (23) with new Iockwasher (28) and nut
(30) .
6. Install grommet (31) to transfer case end of rod (29). Install rod to operating lever (20) with
washer (21) and new cotter pin (22).
7. Install nut (27), swivel (26), and nut (25) to threaded end of rod (29). Install grommet (24) to
swivel.
8. Install swivel (26) to actuator lever (9) with washer (12) and new cotter pin (13).
TA49641
5-13
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
c. ADJUSTMENT
1. At transfer case (23), place operating lever (20) into “4H” position.
2. Inside truck, place transfer case control lever into “4H” position.
NOTE
A 0.200 in. (0.51 cm) gage (32) must be made for use in steps 3 and 4. It
may be made from any material and shaped as illustrated.
3. Hang gage (32) over rod (29) behind swivel (26). Run nut (27) against gage with shifter
against “4H” stop.
4. Remove gage (32) and push swivel (26) rearward against nut (27).
5. Run nut (25) against swivel (26) and tighten.
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
• If removed, install transfer case bezel and boot. (See paragraph 5-4)
• Check operation of control lever and linkage.
TA49642
5-14
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
CHAPTER 6
PROPELLER SHAFTS, AXLES, AND SUSPENSION MAINTENANCE
Paragraph Page
Plumber Procedures Number
6-1
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
a. REMOVAL
NOTE
Second design propeller shafts have a boot while first design propeller
shafts do not. This does not affect propeller shaft maintenance. The
first design propeller shaft is shown in this procedure.
If removing front propeller shaft (1) from all except M1009, perform
steps 1, 3, and 4.
1. Remove 4 nuts (12), Iockwashers (11), and 2 “U” bolts (9) at axle flange (10). Discard
Iockwashers.
3. Push shaft (1) toward rear, Lower and support loose end.
b. INSTALLATION
NOTE
• If installing front propeller shaft (1) on all except M1009, perform steps
2 and 3.
1. Install front propeller shaft (1) on transfer case flange yoke (3) with 4 bolts (2). Tighten bolts to
70-80 Ib.-ft, (95-108 N•m).
2. Position 2 strain (7) on universal joint (4) and install at axle flange (8) with 4 bolts (6). Tighten
bolts to 15 lb-ft. (20 N•m).
3. Position 2 “U” bolts (9) on universal joint (4) and install at axle flange (10) with 4 new
Iockwashers (11) and nuts (12). Tighten nuts to 15 lb.-ft. (20 N•m).
6-2
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
TA49643
6-3
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
a. DISASSEMBLY
NOTE
• Universal joints (7, 14, or 16) on constant velocity joint (12) and
driveshaft (6) are factory-installed using plastic injection retainers
instead of bearing rings.
1. Remove 2 bearing rings (2), 4 bearing rings (10), or 4 bearing rings (13) as required.
2. Position universal joint (7, 14, or 16) over wood blocks. Using brass drift, drive out bearing cup
(1, 8, or 12). Drive out each bearing cup as required and remove universal joint. Discard
universal joints and bearing cups.
NOTE
3. Remove rear yoke (11) and constant velocity joint assembly (9).
4. Remove 2 clamps (17) from boot (18). Separate front yoke (3) from driveshaft (6), and
remove boot. Discard clamps.
6-4
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
NOTE
TA49644
6-5
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
WARNING
CAUTION
DO NOT allow rubber parts to soak in dry cleaning solvent for extended
periods of time. Dry cleaning solvent may damage rubber parts.
2. inspect all components for cracks, dents, burrs, or darnage. Remove burrs and install new
components as required.
c. ASSEMBLY
NOTE
NOTE
Ensure that flanged end of front yoke (3) and flanged end of driveshaft (6)
are alined when performing step 2.
2. Install new seal (4) and seal cap (5) on front yoke (3). lnstall driveshaft 6) in front yoke and
tighten seal cap.
6-6
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
6-7
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
CAUTION
Ensure that bearing cup (1, 8, or 12) is alined with yoke (3 or 11) before
pressing in with vise. Damage to universal joint and bearing cup may result
if forced into yoke.
5. Position universal joint (7, 14, or 16) in vise with a socket between vise jaw and bearing cup (1,
8, or 12) to be installed. Press bearing cup in far enough to install bearing ring (2, 10, or 13).
NOTE
Rear universal joints (7 and 14) each use 4 bearing rings (10 or 13). Front
universal joint (16) uses 2 bearing rings (2).
6. Install bearing ring (2, 10, or 13) and bearing cup (1 , 8, or 12) completely in place. Repeat
steps 5 and 6 for each bearing cup and bearing ring.
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
TA49646
6-8
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
Tools/Test Equipment
• Torque wrench
2. Slide rear propeller shaft (3) forward to disengage from axle flange (5).
3. Slide rear propeller shaft (3) rearward to disengage from transfer case (1). Remove rear
propeller shaft.
b. INSTALLATION
1. Slide rear propeller shaft yoke (2) into transfer case (1).
2. Position 2 clamps (6) on universal joint (4) and install rear propeller shaft (3) on axle flange (5)
with 4 bolts (7). Tighten bolts to 25-30 Ib.-ft. (34-41 Nom).
TA49647
6-9
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
a. DISASSEMBLY
2. Position universal joint (7 or 8) over wood blocks, Using brass drift, drive out bearing cup (3
or 6) as required, and remove universal joint (8) and yoke (1) or universal joint (7) from
driveshaft (4). Discard universal joint and bearing cups.
WARNING
CAUTION
DO NOT allow rubber parts to soak in dry cleaning solvent for extended
periods of time, Dry cleaning solvent may damage rubber parts.
2. Inspect all components for cracks, dents, burrs, or damage, Remove burrs and install new
components as required.
6-10
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
c. ASSEMBLY
1. Position new universal joint (8) in yoke (1) or driveshaft (4) and new universal joint (7) in
driveshaft. Position new bearing cup (3 or 6) on universal joint (7 or 8).
CAUTION
Ensure that bearing cup (3 or 6) is alined with yoke (1) before pressing in
with vise. Damage to universal joint (7 or 8) and bearing cup may result if
forced into yoke.
2. Position universal joint (7 or 6) in vise with a socket between vise jaw and bearing cup (3 or 6)
to be installed. Press bearing cup in far enough to install bearing ring (2 or 5).
NOTE
Rear universal joint (7) uses 2 bearing rings (5). Front universal joint (8)
uses 4 bearing rings (2).
3. Install bearing ring (2 or 5) and bearing cup (3 or 6) completely in place. Repeat steps 2 and 3
for each bearing cup and ring.
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
6-11/(6-12 blank)
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
Paragraph Page
Number Procedures Number
Change 2 6-13
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
Tools/Test Equipment
• Puller Kit
NOTE
1985-87 M1009 trucks have a spindle (6) that is 0.25 in. (6.3 mm) longer
than 1984 trucks.
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
6-14 Change 2
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
a. REMOVAL
NOTE
Rear axle shafts (3) are factory-installed with RTV sealant instead of gasket
(4). Use gasket instead of RTV sealant for installation.
1. Remove 8 bolts (1). Remove rear axle shaft (3) and gasket (4), if present, from wheel hub (5).
Discard gasket.
2. Clean any sealant from bolts (1) and mating surfaces of rear axle shaft flange (2) and exterior of
wheel hub (5).
b. INSTALLATION
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
6-15
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
a. SERVICE
NOTE
4. Install new differential cover gasket (2) and differential cover (3) with 10 bolts (1).
6-16 Change 2
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
6-8.2. SERVICE REAR DIFFERENTIAL (ALL EXCEPT M1009, M1028A2, AND M1028A3).
INITIAL SETUP:
NOTE
When removing differential cover bolts, location of clips should be noted.
NOTE
Some differentials will use a gasket (2), and some will use RTV sealant.
NOTE
Ensure that differential cover (3) is clean.
7. Apply a bead of RTV sealant to differential housing or install new gasket (2) and differential cover
(3) with 14 bolts (1).
8. Tighten 14 bolts (1) to 35 Ib.-ft (47 N•m).
Change 2 6-16.1
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
NOTE
Ensure that differential cover and magnet are clean.
TA701838
6-16.2 Change 2
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
Paragraph Page
Number Procedures Number
Change 2 6-17
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
a. REMOVAL
NOTE
b. INSTALLATION
NOTE
6-18
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
NOTE
If removing shock absorber (3),
perform step 1.
6-19
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
b. INSTALLATION
NOTE
TA49653
6-20
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
a. REMOVAL
1. Remove 4 locknuts (8), 8 washers (7), 2 clamps (9), and 4 bolts (8). Discard locknuts.
2. Remove 2 bushings (10) from stabilizer bar (3). Inspect bushings for wear and discard if
damaged.
3. Remove 2 bolts (1) and 4 washers (2). Remove stabilizer bar (3). Inspect bushings (5) for
damage. If damaged, notify your supervisor.
TA49654
6-21
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
b. lNSTALLATlON
1. Position stabilizer bar (3) and install on lower spring anchor plates (4) with 4 washers (2) and 2
bolts (1). Tighten bolts to 230 Ib.-ft. (312 N•m).
NOTE
Ensure that bushings (10) are installed with slit facing backward and are
alined under frame bracket. Install new bushings if removed.
2. Install 2 bushings (10) on stabilizer bar (3). Position 2 clamps (9) over bushings and install with
4 bolts (6), 8 washers (7), and 4 new locknuts (8). Tighten locknuts to 55 Ib.-ft. (75 N•m).
TA49655
6-22
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
a. REMOVAL
Change 1 6-23
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
NOTE
NOTE
2. Position rear stabilizer bar (9) and install on 2 reinforcement brackets (15) with 2 bolts (10), 2
spacers (11), 8 grommets (1), 8 washers (2), and 2 new locknuts (3). Tighten Iocknuts to the
nonthreaded portion of bolts.
6-24 Change 1
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
TM 9-2320-289-20
CHAPTER 7
BRAKE SYSTEM MAINTENANCE
Paragraph Page
Number Procedures Number
7-1
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
Equipment Condition
• Front wheels chocked.
• Rear of truck supported by jack stands under axle housing.
a. ADJUSTMENT
NOTE
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
TA49656
7-2
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
a. REMOVAL
NOTE
NOTE
TA49657
7-3
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
b. INSTALLATION
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
7-4
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
Equipment Condition
• Wheels chocked.
• Parking brake cable disconnected at parking brake pedal assembly, if removing front cable,
(See paragraph 7-3)
• Brake drum removed, if removing rear cable. (See paragraph 8-5)
a. REMOVAL
NOTE
• If removing front parking brake cable (16), perform steps 1 and 2.
• If removing right rear parking brake cable (2), perform steps 3-5.
• If removing left rear parking brake cable (6), perform steps 3, 4, and 6.
1. Disconnect front parking brake cable (16) at connector (15), Remove connector as required,
Retain parking brake cable grommet (20) for installation.
TA49659
7-5
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
2. Depress tabs on finger clip (19) and pull front parking brake cable (16) through bracket (17)
and into cab to remove. Remove grommet (18) as required.
3. If removing right rear parking brake cable (2), remove equalizer nut (8). If removing left rear
parking brake cable (6), loosen equalizer nut.
4. Disconnect rear parking brake cable (2 or 6) from parking brake lever. Depress tabs on finger
clip (5) and remove rear parking brake cable from backing plate (7).
5. Remove bolt (21) and clip (1), or bolt (4) and clip (3), and remove right rear parking brake
cable (2).
TA49660
7-6
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
NOTE
Only M1009 has a cable guide (14).
6. Depress finger clip (13) and disconnect left rear parking cable (6) from connector (15).
Depress tabs on finger clip (10) and pull cable through bracket (11) to remove. Remove
equalizer (9) and grommet (12) from left rear parking brake cable as required. Remove cable
guide (14) as required.
b. INSTALLATION
NOTE
• If installing left rear parking brake cable (6), perform steps 1 and 3.
• If installing right rear parking brake cable (2), perform steps 2-4.
• If installing front parking brake cable (16), perform steps 5-7.
• Only M1009 has a cable guide (14).
1. Install cable guide (14) if removed. Push left rear parking brake cable (6) through cable guide
and bracket (11) with grommet (12) installed in bracket. Install left rear parking brake cable
through equalizer (9) until finger clip (13) snaps in place. Connect left rear parking brake cable
to connector (15).
2. Install clip (1) with bolt (21 ) or clip (3) with bolt (4), Position right rear parking brake cable (2).
3. Push rear parking brake cable (2 or 6) through backing plate (7) until finger clip (5) snaps in
place and connect to parking brake lever.
4. Install equalizer nut (8).
5. Install grommet (18) on bracket (17) if removed. Push front parking brake cable (16) through
bracket. Push front parking brake cable through hole in cab. Pull through from underneath
truck until finger clip (19) snaps in place.
6. Position front parking brake cable (16) with left rear parking brake cable (6). Install connector
(15) if removed.
7. Press parking brake cable grommet (20) into place on cab floor.
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
• Install brake drum if removed. (See paragraph 8-5)
• Connect parking brake cable at parking brake pedal assembly if disconnected. (See
paragraph 7-3)
• Adjust parking brake cable. (See paragraph 7-2)
• Remove wheel chocks.
• Check parking brake operation.
7-7/(7-8 blank)
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
Paragraph Page
Number Procedures Number
7-9
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
Equipment Condition Materials/Parts
• Master cylinder filled to proper level, • Brake fluid (Item 6, Appendix C)
(See LO 9-2320-289-12)
Tools/Test Equipment Personnel Required
• Combination valve depressor, J-23709 • MOS 63B (2)
(During MANUAL BLEEDING only.)
General Safety Instructions
• Always wear goggles when bleeding brakes.
a. PRESSURE BLEEDING
WARNING
Always wear goggles when bleeding brakes. Failure to follow this warning
may result in serious eye injury.
CAUTION
7-10
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
NOTE
NOTE
7-11
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
b. MANUAL BLEEDING
WARNING
Always wear goggles when bleeding brakes. Failure to follow this warning
may result in serious eye injury.
CAUTION
DO NOT allow master cylinder to run out of brake fluid during bleeding
procedures. Frequently check master cylinder fluid level and refill as
required. Ensure that master cylinder cover is securely installed. Failure to
follow this caution will allow air into brake system.
NOTE
If only front or rear half of system has been serviced, it is usually
necessary to bleed only that half of system; however, if firm braking
action cannot be obtained after bleeding, it will be necessary to bleed
entire system.
MANUAL BLEEDING procedures cover bleeding at one wheel. Repeat
steps for each wheel and bleed brakes in the following order: right
rear, left rear, right front, left front.
TA49663
7-12
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
NOTE
If bleeding rear brakes, it may be necessary to depress brake pedal 8-10
times before seeing first sign of bubbles.
5. H a v e an a s s i s t a n t d e p r e s s b r a k e
pedal. Loosen bleeder valve (6 or 9)
to bleed air from caliper (5) or wheel
cylinder. Open bleeder valve and
observe brake fluid for bubbles.
Tighten bleeder valve, then slowly
release brake pedal.
6. Wait 15 seconds, then repeat step 5
until brake fluid flows free of bubbles.
7. Remove hose and install cap (7 or
10).
8. Fill master cylinder reservoir to
proper level, (See LO 9-2320-289-12)
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
• Check brake pedal for “sponginess” and brake system warning light for indication of unbalanced
pressure.
• Check operation of brakes,
• Check for leaks.
TA49664
7-13
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
a. REMOVAL.
WARNING
DO NOT use a dry brush or compressed air to clean brake shoes or brake
components. There may be asbestos dust on brake shoes or brake
components which can be dangerous to you if you breathe it. Brake
shoes and brake components must be wet, and a soft brush must be
used. Failure to follow this warning may result in serious illness or death
to personnel.
CAUTION
When brake shoes (5 and 17) are replaced, grooved, scored, tapered, or
out-of-round brake drums should be repaired to prevent damage to new
brake shoes. Notify your supervisor.
NOTE
• If removing brake shoes (5 and 17) and mounting hardware, perform
steps 1-12.
• If removing wheel cylinder, perform steps 1-13.
NOTE
2. Pull forward on bottom of primary brake shoe (17). Remove socket (9), washer (10), adjusting
screw (11), and nut (12).
3. Unhook primary return spring (26) and secondary return spring (19).
7-14 Change 2
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
4. Remove parking brake strut (8) and strut spring (13). Remove adjusting spring (25).
NOTE
5. Remove hold-down washer (14), spring (15), pivot (16), and pin (18) on primary brake shoe
(17) side. Remove primary brake shoe.
7. Depress bottom of adjusting lever (24). Unhook actuating link (20) from anchor pin (2) and
adjusting lever.
TA49665
7-15
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
NOTE
Brake shoe assembly is factory-installed without pivot (16).
8. Remove hold-down washer (14), spring (15), pivot (16), and pin (18) on secondary brake
shoe (5) side.
9. Remove adjusting lever (24), adjusting spring (22), and pivot (21) assembly. Disassemble as
required.
10. Remove adjusting spring (23). Remove clip (6), secondary brake shoe (5), and washer (4)
from parking brake lever (3).
11. Depress tabs on parking brake cable finger nut, and disconnect parking brake cable from
parking brake lever (3) as required.
TA49666
7-16
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
NOTE
NOTE
b. INSTALLATION
WARNING
NOTE
1. Install backing plate (1) on axle (36) with 4 new Iockwashers (32) and bolts (33). Tighten bolts
to 105 Ib.-ft. (142 N•m).
TA49667
7-17
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
2. Install wheel cylinder (34) on backing plate (1) with 2 bolts (27). Tighten bolts to 15 Ib.-ft.
(20 N•m). Install 2 link rods (35), bleeder valve (29), and cap (28) if removed.
NOTE
NOTE
5. Install washer (4) on parking brake lever (3) pin. Install secondary brake shoe (5) on parking
brake lever pin. Install clip (6) on secondary brake shoe.
6. Install pin (18) in backing plate (1) on secondary brake shoe (5) side. Position adjusting lever
(24), adjusting spring (22), and pivot (21) assembly, ensuring that pin (18) is through
secondary brake shoe and adjusting lever hole.
7. Install pivot (16), spring (15), and hold-down washer (14), turning hold-down washer to lock in
place on pin (18).
8. Position primary brake shoe (17) and install pin (18), pivot (16), spring (15), and hold-down
washer (14), turning hold-down washer to lock in place.
9. Install brake shoe guide (7) on anchor pin (2). Install actuating link (20) on pivot (21) and
anchor pin.
10. Hook adjusting spring (25) on secondary brake shoe (5) and primary brake shoe (17).
11. With primary brake shoe (17) moved forward, install strut spring (13) and parking brake strut
(8). Ensure that link rods (35) are engaged in secondary brake shoe (5) and primary brake
shoe notches.
TA49668
7-18
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
NOTE
Primary return spring (26) is longer than secondary return spring (19).
12. Hook primary return spring (26) on primary brake shoe (17) and anchor pin (2). Hook
secondary return spring (19) on secondary brake shoe (15) and actuator link (20).
13. Assemble nut (12), adjusting screw (11), washer (10), and socket (9). Grease adjusting
screw (11). Install adjusting assembly between secondary brake shoe (5) and primary brake
shoe (17).
14. Install adjusting spring (23) between adjusting lever (24) and inside of secondary brake shoe
(5). Ensure that adjusting spring (25) DOES NOT touch adjusting screw (11).
15. Check security of hold-down washers (14), link rods (35), and all springs. Ensure that parking
brake strut (8) and strut spring (13) are correctly seated. Carefully pull forward on adjusting
lever (24). Ensure that adjusting lever returns to position after releasing.
16. Firmly tap top of secondary brake shoe (5) and primary brake shoe (17) to seat in place.
TA49669
7-19
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
c. ADJUSTMENT
NOTE
To gain access to adjusting screw (11), it may be necessary to knock out
lanced area in backing plate (1) or brake drum or remove cover.
3. Hold adjusting lever (24) away from adjusting screw (11). Back off adjusting screw 30 notches.
If brake shoes (5 and 17) still drag lightly on drum, back off adjusting screw by 1 or 2 notches.
Install cover on backing plate (1) or brake drum access hole.
4. If drag is still evident, adjust parking brake cable. (See paragraph 7-2)
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
• Connect rear brake line if disconnected. (See paragraph 7-10)
• Bleed brakes if wheel cylinder was removed. (See paragraph 7-6)
• Check operation of brakes.
TA49670
7-20
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
a. R E M O V A L
NOTE
1. Remove master cylinder cover bail (2), cover (1), and gasket (3). Inspect cover and gasket
for damage and discard as required.
2. Remove 2 locknuts (12), power brake bracket (11), and master cylinder (4). Discard locknuts.
TA49671
7-21
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
NOTE
Only M1009 uses pedal rod boot (8), retain for installation.
3. Remove 2 locknuts (9) and pedal rod boot (8), Remove 4 locknuts (6), and remove power
booster (5) and seal (10). Inspect seal for damage and discard as required, Discard locknuts.
b. INSTALLATION
NOTE
When replacing power booster (5) assembly, ensure that proper power
booster is used. M1009 housing is machined flat or has 40°-50° bevel at
pushrod end and has a broadcast code sticker with “FY” or “KA” on it,
All other models are 20°-30° beveled and have a broadcast code sticker
with “CM” on it.
1. Install seal (10) on power booster (5) studs. Install power booster on engine compartment studs
(7). Install 4 new locknuts (6) on engine compartment studs. Install pedal rod boot (8) and 2 new
locknuts (9) on power booster studs. Tighten locknuts to 25 Ib.-ft. (34 N•m).
TA49672
7-22 Change 2
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
NOTE
An Installed M1009 master cylinder (4) will have larger reservoir facing
forward. On all other models, larger reservoir will be facing rearward when
installed. If incorrect master cylinder is installed, erratic braking action
may be experienced.
2. Position master cylinder (4) and power brake bracket (11) on power booster (5) studs, and
install with 2 new locknuts (12), Tighten locknuts to 35 Ib.-ft. (47 N•m).
3. Install gasket (3), cover (1), and cover bail (2) on master cylinder (4).
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
7-23
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
WARNING
Always wear goggles when bleeding brakes. Failure to follow this warning
may result in serious eye injury.
CAUTION
NOTE
• Use suitable container to catch brake fluid.
TA49673
7-24
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
6. Disconnect brake pipes (22, 16, and 19) from combination valve (20), and remove
combination valve.
7. Remove screw (18) and clip (17). Disconnect brake pipe (16) from caliper flex hose (10) and
remove. Remove bolt (13) and 2 copper washers (11), and disconnect caliper flex hose from
caliper (12). Remove clip (14) to disconnect hose from bracket (9) and remove. Inspect
fittings for damage and replace as required. Discard copper washers.
8 . Remove 2 screws (24) and clips (25). Repeat step 7, as required, to disconnect brake pipe
(19) from right caliper flex hose (10). Inspect fittings for damage and replace as required.
9. Disconnect rear brake pipe (7) from fitting (8). Remove fitting. Remove 3 screws (6) and clips
(5) and remove brake pipe (22). Inspect fittings for damage and replace as required.
TA49674
7-25
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
b. INSTALLATION
NOTE
• Remove all plugs before connection.
1. Position brake pipe (22) along frame. Install 3 clips (5) on brake pipe and install screws (6),
Install fitting (8) on brake pipe. Connect rear brake pipe (7) to fitting.
TA49675
7-26
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
2. Connect caliper flex hose (10) to caliper (12) with 2 new copper washers (11) and bolt (13).
Connect caliper flex hose to brake pipe (16) through bracket (9) and install clip (14). Install
clip (17) on brake pipe and install screw (18).
3. Position brake pipe (19) on frame and frame crossmember. Install 2 clips (25) on brake pipe
and install 2 screws (24). Repeat step 2, as required, to connect brake pipe to right side
caliper flex hose (10).
4. From underneath truck, connect brake pipes (22, 16, and 19) to combination valve (20),
5. Connect electrical lead to combination valve (20).
6. Connect brake pipes (2 and 3) to combination valve (20). DO NOT fully tighten pipes at this
time.
7. Install combination valve (20) on frame crossmember with 2 bolts (23) and new locknuts (21).
Tighten brake pipes (2 and 3) at combination valve.
8. Install retainer (4) on brake pipes (2
and 3) if removed. Install clip (26) on
brake pipes and install screw (15).
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
• Bleed brake system. (See paragraph 7-6)
• Check operation of brakes.
TA49676
7-27
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
CAUTION
NOTE
1. Disconnect fitting (1) from brake pipe (2). Remove 3 screws (4) and clips (3).
2. Remove screw (11) and clip (10). Disconnect brake pipe (2) from proportioning valve (7) and
remove. Inspect fittings for damage and replace as required.
3. Remove retainer (31). Disconnect brake pipe (2) from hose (30) and remove. Inspect fittings
for damage and replace as required.
4. Bend clip (24) and remove right brake pipe (25) from hose (9 or 30) fitting. Disconnect right
brake pipe from wheel cylinder fitting (23) and remove. Inspect fittings for damage and replace
as required.
7. Remove screw (26) and disconnect hose (9) from proportioning valve lever (8).
8. Disconnect hose (9) from pipe (5) and remove. Loosen pipe fitting, remove retainer (6), and
disconnect pipe from proportioning valve (7).
7-28
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
TA49677
7-29
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
NOTE
If proportioning valve (7) was previously replaced, proportioning valve
adjustment gage (19) located between proportioning valve lever (8) and
proportioning valve must be discarded.
9. Remove nut (16) and bushing (17), Pull proportioning valve lever (8) away from proportioning
valve (7) and remove retainer (18) as required. -
10. Remove 2 bolts (12) and Iockwashers (13) and remove proportioning valve (7), Remove 2
bolts (20) and Iockwashers (21), and remove bracket (14) as required, Discard Iockwashers.
11. Remove 2 bolts (27), spacer (28), and proportioning valve lever (8) from differential (22).
b. INSTALLATION
NOTE
• Remove all plugs before connection.
1. Install proportioning valve lever (8) on differential (22) with spacer (28) and 2 bolts (27).
Tighten bolts to 35 Ib.-ft. (47 N•m).
2. Install bracket (14) with 2 new Iockwashers (21) and bolts (20) if removed. Install proportioning
valve (7) with 2 new Iockwashers (13) and bolts (1 2). Tighten all bolts to 35 Ib.-ft. (47 N•m).
TA49678
7-30
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
4. Install retainer (18) on proportioning valve lever (8) if removed, Install proportioning valve lever
on proportioning valve (7) with bushing (17) and nut (16). Tighten nut to 10-15 lb.-ft.
(14-20 N•m).
5. Connect pipe (5) to proportioning valve (7). Connect hose (9) to pipe and install retainer (6).
6. Connect hose (9) to proportioning valve lever (8) with screw (26).
7. Install bracket (32) on differential (22) with bolt (33) if removed. Install hose (30) on bracket
(32) with screw (29). Tighten bolt to 35 Ib.-ft. (47 N•m).
8. Connect right brake pipe (25) to wheel cylinder fitting (23). Connect right brake pipe to hose
(9 or 30) fitting and secure with clip (24).
10. Connect brake pipe (2) to brake hose (30) and install retainer (31).
TA49679
7-31
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
11. Connect brake pipe (2) to proportioning valve (7). Install clip (10) on brake pipe and install with
screw (11).
12. Position brake pipe (2) along frame. Install 3 clips (3) on brake pipe and install with 3 screws
(4). Connect fitting (1) to brake pipe.
c. VALVE ADJUSTMENT
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
• Remove jack stands and lower truck as required.
• Bleed brake system. (See paragraph 7-6)
• Check operation of brakes.
TA49680
7-32
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
a. REMOVAL
NOTE
If removing caliper (2) from all except M1009, perform steps 1-4 and 8.
If removing brake pads from all except M1009, perform steps 3, 4, and 6
through 8.
1. Remove bolt and 2 copper washers and disconnect caliper flex hose from caliper (2). Discard
copper washers.
7-33
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
3. Position “C“ clamp around caliper (2) so that foot of clamp on shaft rests through access hole
(3) against outer brake pad (11 or 22) and stationary foot of clamp rests on piston (14),
Tighten “C” clamp until piston reaches bottom of piston bore. Remove “C“ clamp.
NOTE
Use soft-faced hammer and drift to remove key (5) and spring (7).
4. Remove screw (6), Tap key (5) and spring (7) from bracket (4). Remove caliper
bracket and rotor (1).
5. Remove 2 mounting bolts (15). Remove caliper (2) from bracket (18) and rotor (1).
CAUTlON
DO NOT allow caliper (2) to hang from brake hoses. Damage to hoses may
result.
TA49682
7-34
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
M1009
NOTE
7. Remove brake pads (11 and 13) or (21 and 22) from caliper housing (8 or 20). Remove
anti-rattle clip (12) or spring (23). Remove 2 sleeves (16), inner bushings (17), and outer
bushings (19) as required.
WARNING
DO NOT use a dry brush or compressed air to clean brake pads or brake
components, There may be asbestos dust on brake pads or brake
components which can be dangerous to you if you breathe it. Brake pads
and brake components must be wet, and a soft brush must be used.
Failure to follow this warning may result in serious illness or death to
personnel.
NOTE
Always replace brake pads (11, 13, 21, and 22) in sets, If 1 brake pad is
replaced, ensure that all brake pads are replaced.
8. Clean off dirt from brake pads (11 and 13) or (21 and 22). Inspect for glazing, oil saturation, or
excessive wear. Replace brake pads if glazed or oil saturated, or if brake pad lining is worn to
within 0.031 in. (0.80 mm) of a rivet head or pad itself.
TA49683
7-35
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
Figure Page
Number Figure Title Number
F-2
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
NOTE
• Use soft-faced hammer and punch to install key (5) and spring (7).
4. Position caliper (2) on bracket (4) and rotor (1). Install spring (7) and key (5) on bracket with
screw (6). Securely tighten screw.
NOTE
One copper washer must be installed between caliper flex hose and
caliper (2).
6. Connect caliper flex hose to caliper (2) with bolt and 2 new copper washers.
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
7-37
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
a. REMOVAL
1. Remove 2 screws (5) and wiring harness shield (4) from brake pedal bracket (2),
NOTE
2. Remove retainer (15) and washer (14) and disconnect power booster rod (13). Remove return
spring retainer (12) and return spring (3). Discard retainer (15).
3. Remove locknut (1), Remove brake pedal (11) assembly. Remove 2 bushings (8) and spacer
(7) from brake pedal pivot bolt (6). Remove screw (9) and brake pedal pad (10) if damaged,
Discard locknut.
TA49686
7-38
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
b. INSTALLATION
1. Install brake pedal pad (10) and screw (9) if removed. Install spacer (7) and 2 bushings (8) on
brake pedal (11). Install brake pedal assembly with pivot bolt (6) and new locknut (1).
2. Install return spring (3) and return spring retainer (12). Install power booster rod (13) on brake
pedal (11) pin with washer (14) and new retainer (15).
3. Install wiring harness shield (4) on brake pedal bracket (2) with 2 screws (5).
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
TM 9-2320-289-20
CHAPTER 8
WHEELS AND STEERING SYSTEM MAINTENANCE
Paragraph Page
Number Procedures Number
8-1
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
a. REMOVAL
WARNING
Position wheel chocks at front and rear of tires opposite axle to be raised.
Truck must be on level surface before attempting to remove wheel (3).
Failure to follow this warning may result in injury or death to personnel.
NOTE
NOTE
1.1. Position wheel chocks. Loosen lugnuts (1), but DO NOT remove. Raise truck and support on jack
stand (2). Remove Iugnuts, clamping ring (3.2), outer rear wheel (3) or front wheel, spacer ring
(3.1), and inner rear wheel.
8-2 Change 2
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
WARNING
Change 2 8-3
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
1. Install valve core (6) in valve stem (7) and install tire on wheel rim (4), (See TM 9-2610-200-14)
Inflate tire as required. (See TM 9-2320-289-10) Check for leaks in valve stem, valve core, and
around edge of wheel rim. Install valve cap (5). Balance tire and wheel assembly. (See
TM 9-4910-743-14&P)
NOTE
When installing outer rear wheel (3), ensure that valve stems are
positioned 180° apart and that inner valve stems are accessible through
hole in outer rim.
1.1. Position inner rear wheel (3), spacer ring (3.1), outer rear wheel or front wheel, and clamping
ring (3.2) on wheel hub. Install lugnuts (1) finger tight. Remove jack stand (2) and lower truck.
8-3.0 Change 2
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
FRONT
Change 1 8-3.1
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
3. For M1009, tighten Iugnuts (1) to 90 Ib.-ft. (122 N•m) in sequence shown. For all except
M1009, tighten lugnuts to 140 Ib.-ft. (190 N•m) in sequence shown. Continue tightening
sequence as required to obtain required torque. Remove wheel chocks.
4. Stow spare tire in tire carrier. For M1028A2 and M1028A3, stow tire in tire carrier with wheel
offset up.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
NOTE
Snapring (3) may not be on truck. Snapring is not necessary for operation,
but may be installed if desired.
NOTE
• Clean all components and axle shaft (7), and lubricate with grease
before installation.
1. Position locking hub body unit (6) in wheel hub (8). Install snapring (3) on axle shaft (7)
groove. Install Iockring (5) and new “O” ring seal (4) on inside of locking hubcap unit (2).
2. Aline tabs (9) with locking hub body unit (6) slots and install locking hubcap unit (2) with 6
screws (1). Tighten screws to 45 lb.-in. (5 N•m).
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
8-4
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
General/Safety Instructions
• Dry cleaning solvent is flammable and must not be used near an open flame. Use only in a
well-ventilated area.
• DO NOT use a dry brush or compressed air to clean brake pads or brake components.
NOTE
• If removing rotor, wheel bearings, and caliper bracket from all except
RA1009, perform steps 1, 4, and 5.
Change 2 8-5
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
1. Remove outer adjusting nut (5), adjusting lock (6), and inner adjusting nut (5).
NOTE
2. Remove snapring (1) and washer (2). Insert screw into end of key (3), and pull out screw and
key. Remove screw from key. Remove adjusting nut (4).
NOTE
3. Remove snapring (1) and washer (2). Remove locking nut (21), ring (22), and adjusting nut
(23) .
8-6
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
4. Remove outer wheel bearing (7). Remove rotor (9), Remove seal (18) and inner wheel bearing
(19) from rotor. Drive out outer race (8) and inner race (20) by evenly tapping around inner
edges with soft-faced drift. Press out 6 or 8 wheel studs (10) as required. Discard seal.
WARNING
Splash shield (13) and caliper bracket (17) are factory-installed with 6
locknuts and washers. Refer to TM 9-2320-289-20P for proper replacement
parts. Using improper replacement parts may cause caliper to fall off
during operation, resulting in injury or death to personnel.
NOTE
5. Remove 6 nuts (11) and Iockwashers (12). Remove splash shield (13) and caliper bracket (14)
from spindle (15). Discard Iockwashers.
NOTE
6. Remove 6 locknuts (16) and caliper bracket (17) from spindle (15). Discard locknuts.
WARNING
1. Clean wheel bearings (7 and 19) and races (8 and 20). Inspect wheel bearings and races for
scratches, discoloration, wear, bends, and cracks. Replace if rough or noisy after cleaning, or
if worn, bent, or cracked.
2. Clean cooling fins of rotor (9). Inspect rotor for scoring, pitting, or cracks. Notify your
supervisor if scored, pitted, or cracked.
8-7
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
NOTE
• If installing rotor (9), wheel bearings (19), and caliper bracket (14) on
all except M1009, perform steps 1, 3, and 4.
• If installing rotor (9), wheel bearings (19), and caliper bracket (17) on
M1009, perform steps 2, 3, 5, and 6.
1. Install caliper bracket (14) and splash shield (13) on spindle (15) with 6 new Iockwashers (12)
and nuts (11). Tighten nuts to 65 Ib.-ft. (88 N•m).
2. Install caliper bracket (17) on spindle (15) studs with 6 new locknuts (16). Tighten locknuts to
65 Ib.-ft. (88 N•m).
8-8
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
WARNING
The tapered end of inner wheel bearing assembly must be facing toward the
outboard (cap end) of axle shaft. The tapered end of the outer wheel
bearing assembly must be facing toward the inboard (splined end) of the
axle shaft. Failure to follow this warning may force wheel off truck during
operation, causing serious injury or death to personnel.
NOTE
3. Press 6 or 8 wheel studs (10) into rotor (9) if removed. Drive inner race (20) and outer race (8)
into rotor with soft-faced drift until fully seated. Install inner wheel bearing (19) and new seal (18)
on rotor. Install rotor on spindle (15). Install outer wheel bearing (7).
4. Position inner adjusting nut (5) with pin facing outward and tighten to 50 lb.-ft. (68 N•m) while
turning rotor (9) to seat wheel bearing assemblies. Loosen inner adjusting nut and tighten to
50 Ib.-ft. (68 N•m). Back off inner adjusting nut far enough to install adjusting lock (6). Position
adjusting lock with hole on inner adjusting nut pin. Install outer adjusting nut (5) and tighten to
160 Ib.-ft. (217 N•m).
NOTE
• Step 5 only applies to 1984, M1009 trucks.
• Ensure that end of key (3) with threaded hole faces outward.
5. Position adjusting nut (4) and tighten to 50 Ib.-ft. (68 N•m) while turning rotor (9) to seat wheel
bearing assemblies. Loosen adjusting nut and tighten to 25 Ib.-ft. (34 N•m). Back off adjusting
nut to nearest slot and install key (3), Install snapring (1) and washer (2).
NOTE
Step 6 only applies to 1985-87, M1009 trucks.
6. Position adjusting nut (23) and tighten to 50 Ib.-ft. (68 N•m) while turning rotor (9) to seat wheel
bearing assemblies. Loosen adjusting nut and tighten to 35 Ib.-ft. (47 N•m). Back off adjusting
nut 3/8 turn. Install ring (22) with tang alined to slot on spindle (15) and hole alined to pin on
adjusting nut. Install locking nut (21). Tighten locking nut to 160 Ib.-ft. (217 N•m). Install
snapring (1) and washer (2).
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
Change 2 8-9
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
a. REMOVAL
NOTE
• If removing hub (8), drum (9), and wheel bearings (15 or 17) from all
except M1009, perform steps 1 and 2 as required.
8-10
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
3. Remove 2 retainers, if present, from 2 wheel studs (2), Evenly tap around edge of drum (1)
and remove drum. Press 6 wheel studs from axle shaft (4) as required. Discard retainers.
WARNING
1. Clean and inspect wheel bearing assemblies (15 and 17). (See TM 9-214)
2. Clean hub (8) and drum (1 or 9). Inspect for scoring, pitting, or cracks. Notify your supervisor
if scored, pitted, or cracked.
TA49724
8-11
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
c. INSTALLATION
WARNING
The tapered end of inner wheel bearing assembly (15) must be facing
toward the outboard (cap end) of axle shaft (4 or 11). The tapered end of
the outer wheel bearing assembly (17) must be facing toward the inboard
(splined end) of the axle shaft. Failure to follow this warning may force
wheel off truck during operation, causing serious injury or death to
personnel.
NOTE
• If installing hub (8), drum (9), and wheel bearings (15 or 17) on all
except M1009, perform steps 1-3 as required.
. Before adjusting bearings (15 or 17), ensure that brakes are fully
released and do not drag.
1. Aline hub (8) and drum (9) stud holes. Press 8 wheel studs (10) into hub and drum with arbor
press. Hub must seat tightly against drum.
2. Install outer wheel bearing assembly (17) in hub (8) past snapring slot, Install snapring (16) in
slot. Tap outer wheel bearing assembly to seat on ring. Install inner wheel bearing assembly
(15) and new seal (14) in hub. Position hub and drum assembly on spindle (11).
TA49725
8-12
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
TA49726
8-13
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
Personnel Required
• MOS 63B (2)
a. TOE CHECK
b. TOE ADJUSTMENT
NOTE
• If adjusting toe on all except
M1009, perform step 1.
• If adjusting toe on M1009,
perform step 2.
2. Check toe (see TOE CHECK, step 2). If alinement is off, loosen adjusting nuts (2) at both ends
of tie-rod (3) and adjust as required to bring toe within range. Check toe (see TOE CHECK,
step 2). Tighten adjusting nuts.
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
8-14
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
Paragraph Page
Number Procedures Number
Change 2 8-15
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
a. BLEEDING
WARNING
Always wear goggles when bleeding power steering system. Hydraulic fluid
spillage can occur. Failure to follow this warning may result in serious eye
injury.
CAUTION
Hydraulic fluid and brake fluid cannot be mixed. Damage to seals will
result if hydraulic fluid contacts brake seals or brake fluid contacts
steering seals.
NOTE
TA49728
8-16
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
4. Start engine and depress brake pedal several times while rotating steering wheel right and left,
lightly contacting wheel stops. Turn off engine. Check hydraulic fluid level and add as required.
5. Check for air in hydraulic fluid. Hydraulic fluid will appear foamy or milky if it contains air. If air
is present, allow truck to stand a few minutes with engine off, then repeat steps 2 through 4 as
required. If hydraulic fIuid still appears foamy or milky after a few attempts, notify your
supervisor.
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
8-17
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
NOTE
1. Remove horn button cover (5), Remove 3 screws inside cup (4) and remove cup, horn
bushing (3), and horn contact spring (2) from steering wheel (1). Remove clip (10) and nut
(9), Remove insulator (8), eyelet (7), and spring (6).
NOTE
b. INSTALLATION
NOTE
If installing directional signal lever (12), perform step 1.
1. Aline pin on directional signal lever (12) with notch in steering column, and install directional
signal lever while turning counterclockwise.
NOTE
8-18
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
3. Install spring (6), eyelet (7), and insulator (8). Install nut (9) and tighten to 30 Ib.-ft. (41 N•m).
Install clip (10). Position horn contact spring (2) with bowed part facing outward, and install
horn bushing (3) and cup (4), Install 3 screws inside cup. Install horn button cover (5).
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
TA49730
8-19
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
a. REMOVAL
1. Remove 2 cotter pins (2) and nuts (1). Using puller, remove connecting rod sockets (5 and 8)
from steering arm (6) and pitman arm (9). Remove 2 grease fittings (4) if damaged. Discard
cotter pins.
2. Inspect connecting rod sockets (5 and 8) for damage. If damaged perform step 3. If not
damaged, clean threads on connecting rod sockets.
NOTE
Note position of sleeve (7) and number of exposed threads on connecting
rod sockets (5 and 8) for installation.
3. Loosen 2 nuts (3) and unscrew connecting rod sockets (5 and 8) from sleeve (7).
TA49731
8-20
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
b. INSTALLATION
1. Screw connecting rod sockets (5 and 8) onto sleeve (7) if removed. Tighten 2 nuts (3) to
40 Ib.-ft. (54 N•m).
NOTE
Ensure that shorter connecting rod socket (8) is installed on pitman arm
(9).
2 Install 2 grease fittings (4) if removed. Position connecting rod socket (8) on pitman arm (9)
and connecting rod socket (5) on steering arm (6), and install 2 nuts (1). Tighten nuts to
70 Ib.-ft. (95 N•m). Advance nuts as required to aline cotter pin (2) holes. Install 2 new cotter
pins.
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
8-21
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
Too/s/Test Equipment
• Mechanical puller, J-6632-01
• Torque wrench
a. REMOVAL
NOTE
b. INSTALLATION
CAUTION
If a clamp-type pitman arm (3) is used, spread pitman arm with a wedge
just enough to slip pitman arm onto steering gear shaft (l). DO NOT
spread pitman arm more than required to slip over steering gear shaft with
hand pressure. DO NOT use a hammer to install pitman arm.
NOTE
Before tightening locknut (5), ensure that position of pitman arm (3) is
alined with marks made during removal.
1. Position pitman arm (3) on steering gear shaft (1). Install bolt (2), washer (4), and new locknut
(5). Tighten locknut to 95 Ib.-ft. (129 N•m).
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
8-22
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
a. REMOVAL
b. INSTALLATION
TA49733
8-23
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
Too/s/Test Equipment
• Puller
• Torque wrench
a. REMOVAL
NOTE
• M1009 tie-rod assembly is mounted from below steering arms (3).
• All other tie-rod assemblies are mounted from above steering arms (3).
1. Attempt to move tie-rod end. If socket moves 0.015 in. (0.4 mm) on stud, tie-rod end must be
replaced.
2. Remove 2 grease fittings (6). Remove 2 cotter pins (2) and nuts (1) . Discard cotter pins.
NOTE
Note number of exposed threads on tie-rod ends (5 and 9) or (10 and 13) for
installation.
3. Use puller until tie-rod end (5 or 10) unseats. Repeat for other tie-rod end (9 or 10). Remove
tie-rod assembly. Remove 2 tie-rod socket seals (4) from steering arms (3). Discard seals.
b. DISASSEMBLY
NOTE
1. Loosen 2 nuts (14) and remove tie-rod end (10) from sleeve (11). Remove sleeve from tie-rod
tube (12). Inspect all components for damage and replace as required.
NOTE
2. Remove tie-rod ends (5 and 9) and adjusting nut (7) from tie-rod tube (8) as required. Inspect all
components for damage and replace as required.
8-24 Change 2
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
c. ASSEMBLY
NOTE
If assembling tie-rod assembly on M1009, perform step 1.
If assembling tie-rod assembly on all except M1009, perform step 2.
Ensure that tie-rod end (5 and 9) or (10 and 13) threads are clean and
lubricated.
1. Install tie-rod end (9) on tie-rod tube (8). Install adjusting nut (7) on tie-rod tube, Install tie-rod
end (5) on adjusting nut.
2. Install sleeve (11) on tie-rod tube (12). Install tie-rod end (10) on sleeve. Tighten nuts (14) to
40 Ib.-ft. (54 N•m).
TA49734
8-25
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
d. INSTALLATION
NOTE
M1009 tie-rod assembly is mounted from below steering arms (3).
All other tie-rod assemblies are mounted from above steering arms (3).
1. Position 2 new tie-rod socket seals (4) and tie-rod ends (5 and 9) or (10 and 13) on 2 steering
arms (3). Install 2 nuts (1), Tighten nuts to 40 Ib.-ft. (54 N•m). Advance nuts as required to
aline cotter pin (2) holes. Install 2 new cotter pins. Install 2 grease fittings (6).
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
Install tie-rod shock absorber. (See paragraph 8-12)
Adjust toe alinement. (See paragraph 8-6)
Lubricate tie-rod ends. (See LO 9-2320-289-12)
TA49735
8-26
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
Too/s/Test Equipment
• Open end wrench
(16 mm and 18 mm), J-33124
a. REMOVAL
CAUTION
NOTE
8-27
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
NOTE
Remove clamps (3, 5, 8, 14, or 17) from hoses (4, 10, or 15) as
required after disconnection.
1. Remove nut (19), Iockwasher (20), and bolt (1). Remove clip (7).
2. Loosen 2 clamps (14) and disconnect hose (15) from power steering pump (16) and power
steering gear (13). Remove hose. Remove outlet pipe (11) and seal (12) as required, Discard
seal if removed.
3. Disconnect line (18) and line (9) at power booster (2). Loosen clamp (3) and disconnect hose
(4) from power booster.
TA49736
8-28
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
NOTE
If disconnecting line (9) from rear of power steering pump (16), it may be
necessary to remove power steering pump mounting hardware and pull
out power steering pump.
4. Disconnect line (18) from power steering gear (13). Disconnect line (9) from power steering
pump (16). Loosen clamp (17) and disconnect hose (10) from power steering pump. Remove
hoses and lines as required. Loosen clamps (5 and 8), and disconnect hose (4) and pipe (6)
as required.
5. Inspect all hoses (4, 10, and 15), pipes (6 and 11), lines (9 and 18), and fittings for damage.
Replace as required.
b. INSTALLATION
CAUTION
NOTE
Install clamps (3, 5, 8, 14, or 17) on disconnected hoses (4, 10, or 15) if
removed.
1. Connect hose (4) to pipe (6) and pipe to hose (10), Tighten clamps (5 and 8) if disconnected.
Connect hose (10) to power steering pump (16) and tighten clamp (17). Connect line (9) to
power steering pump. Connect line (18) to power steering gear (13), install power steering
pump if removed.
2. Connect hose (4) to power booster (2) and tighten clamp (3). Connect lines (9 and 18) to
power booster.
3. Install new seal (12) and outlet pipe (11) if removed. Connect hose (15) to power steering
gear (13) and power steering pump (16), and tighten clamps (14).
4. Install clip (7) on line (9), pipe (6), and line (18), and install with bolt (1), new Iockwasher
(20), and nut (19).
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
8-29
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
a. REMOVAL
CAUTION
DO NOT pry on power steering pump (5) reservoir or pull on filler neck when
rotating power steering pump, Failure to follow this caution may result in
damage to power steering pump.
NOTE
1. Loosen adjusting nut (2) and adjusting bolts (7 and 12). Rotate power steering pump (5) to
loosen belt (1). Remove belt from pulley (14), Discard belt if worn or damaged.
NOTE
On all except M1010, bolt (12) is removed from behind power steering
pump (5).
2. Remove bolt (8), adjusting bolt (7), and bracket (9). Remove nut (10) and brace (11).
Disconnect power steering lines at power steering pump (5). (See paragraph 8-14)
3. Remove adjusting nut (2), nut (3), and adjusting bolt (12). Remove power steering pump (5) and
bracket (4) assembly.
5. Remove 3 bolts (13) and bracket from power steering pump (5).
8-30 Change 2
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
b. I N S T A L L A T I O N
NOTE
1. Install bracket (4) on power steering pump (5) with 3 bolts (13).
NOTE
On all except M1010, bolt (12) is installed from behind power steering
pump (5).
3. Position power steering pump (5) and bracket (4) assembly on studs (6) and install with
adjusting bolt (12), adjusting nut (2), and nut (3). DO NOT fully tighten adjusting bolt or nut.
4. Connect power steering lines at power steering pump (5). (See paragraph 8-14)
5. Install nut (10) and brace (11) on power steering pump (5). Install bracket (9) with bolt (8) and
adjusting bolt (7). DO NOT fully tighten adjusting bolt.
TA49737
8-31
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
CAUTION
Ensure that belt (1) tension is correct. A belt too loose or too tight can
cause damage to power steering pump (5) or belt.
6. Position belt (1) on pulleys. Rotate power steering pump (5) by placing a pry bar between engine
and bracket (4), and pulling pry bar toward power steering pump until belt appears tight. Tighten
adjusting nut (2) and adjusting bolts (7 and 12).
7. Using belt tensioning gage, check belt (1) tension. (See Appendix E)
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
TA702 18
8-32 Change 2
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
Tools/Test Equipment
• Torque wrench
2. Remove nut (7) and Iockwasher (6). Remove nut (8) and Iockwasher (9). Discard
Iockwashers.
NOTE
3. Remove 4 bolts (1) and spacers (2) while supporting steering gear (10). Remove steering
gear from frame (3).
TA49739
8-33
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
b. INSTALLATION
1. Position steering gear (10) so coupling (4) studs aline with holes in steering shaft flange (5).
Install steering gear on frame (3) with 4 spacers (2) and bolts (1). Tighten bolts to 75 Ib.-ft.
(102 N•m).
2. Install coupling (4) on steering shaft flange (5) with new Iockwasher (6) and nut (7), and new
Iockwasher (9) and nut (8). Tighten nuts to 20 Ib.-ft. (27 N•m).
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
TA49740
8-34
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
a. REMOVAL
NOTE
Ensure that position of flanged end of lower steering shaft (6) and steering
shaft are marked for assembly.
1. Remove 2 nuts (4 and 7) and washers (3 and 8) from flexible coupling (2) at steering gear (1).
Remove flanged end of lower steering shaft (6) from steering gear.
2. Remove nut securing upper shaft (5) to lower steering shaft (6) and tap out bolt. Tap steering
shaft off at upper end and remove.
TA701839
Change 2 8-35
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
b. INSTALLATION
1. Lubricate end of upper shaft (5) with grease. Install lower steering shaft (6) onto upper shaft with
notch in cover toward flat side of spline on upper shaft. Tap into place.
2. Tap bolt into upper and lower steering shafts (5 and 6) and install nut.
3. Install 2 nuts (4 and 7), washers (3 and 8), and flanged end of lower steering shaft (6) to flexible
coupling (2) at steering gear (1). Tighten nuts to 20 Ib.-ft. (27 N•m).
TA701840
8-36 Change 2
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
CHAPTER 9
FRAME MAINTENANCE
Paragraph Page
Number Procedures Number
9-1
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
a. REMOVAL
WARNING
NOTE
1. Remove 6 nuts (4), washers (3), bolts (11), and radiator grille guard (10).
2. Remove cotter pin (7) from pin (8) and remove tie-down clevis (9). Repeat step to remove
other tie-down clevis.
3. Remove 2 blackout light brackets from bumper (1). (See paragraph 4-25)
4. Remove 2 nuts (5), washers (3), bolts (12), and bumper (1).
b. INSTALLATION
WARNING
NOTE
9-2
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
2. Install bumper (1) with 2 bolts (12), washers (3), and nuts (5), DO NOT fully tighten nuts.
4. Install each tie-down clevis (9) to each tie-down extension (6) with pin (8) and new cotter pin
(7) .
5. Install radiator grille guard (10) with 6 bolts (11), washers (3), and nuts (4). Tighten nuts to
35 Ib.-ft. (47 N•m).
9-3
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
Tools/Test Equipment
• Torque wrench
NOTE
1, Remove plastic tie securing wiring harness to bumper brace (6). Discard plastic tie.
3. Remove 4 nuts (13), Iockwashers (12), washers (8), and bolts (7). Discard Iockwashers.
4. Remove nut (9), 2 washers (4), bolt (3), bumper bracket (5), shim (10), and tie-down
extension (11).
b. INSTALLATION
NOTE
1. Install tie-down extension (11) inside bumper bracket (5) and secure with bolt (3), 2 washers
(4), and nut (9). DO NOT fully tighten nut.
2. Install bumper bracket (5), shim (10), and tie-down extension (11) with 4 bolts (7), washers
(8), new Iockwashers (12), and nuts (13).
4. Install bumper brace (6) with 2 washers (2) and bolts (1). Tighten bolts to 40 Ib.-ft. (54 N•m).
9-4
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
• Install front bumper and radiator grille guard. (See paragraph 9-2)
TA49704
9-5
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
1. Remove cotter pin (4), nut (3), and washer (2). Remove pintle hook (10). Discard cotter pin.
2. Remove 4 nuts (5), Iockwashers (6), bolts (9), and 2 brackets (1 and 8). Discard
Iockwashers.
TA49705
9-6
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
9-4. PINTLE ASSEMBLY REPLACEMENT (ALL EXCEPT M1009 AND M1010) (Con’t).
b. INSTALLATION
NOTE
1. Assemble bracket (8) and pintle hook (10) with flat side of bracket facing reinforcement (7).
4. Install 4 bolts (9), new Iockwashers (6), and nuts (5), Tighten nuts to 70-80 Ib.-ft.
(95-108 N•m).
6. Loosen nut (3) until it alines with hole in pintle hook (10). Install new cotter pin (4).
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
9-7
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
Manual References
• LO 9-2320-289-12
a. REMOVAL
1. Remove cotter pin (4), nut (3), and washer (2). Remove pintle hook (10). Discard cotter pin.
2. Remove 4 nuts (5), Iockwashers (6), and bolts (9). Remove 2 brackets (1 and 8) and 2
spacers (7). Discard Iockwashers.
TA49706
9-8
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
b. INSTALLATION
NOTE
1. Install bracket (8) and spacer (7) to pintle hook (10) and install pintle hook through tow hook
bracket (11).
2. Install spacer (7) and bracket (1) with grease fitting toward bottom.
3. Install 4 bolts (9), new Iockwashers (6), and nuts (5). Tighten nuts to 70-80 lb.-ft.
(95-108 N•m).
5. Loosen nut (3) until it alines with hole in pintle hook (10). Install new cotter pin (4).
9-9
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
1. Remove cotter pin (19). Support tie-down clevis (21), and remove pin (20) and tie-down
clevis. Repeat step to remove other side tie-down clevis. Discard cotter pins.
NOTE
2. Remove 2 nuts (17), Iockwashers (16), washers (15), bolts (14), and reinforcement (18),
Discard Iockwashers.
3. Remove 8 locknuts (1), 4 bolts (10), and 4 bolts (11) on left or right side. Discard locknuts.
4. Remove 2 locknuts (3), bolts (5), and washers (4), and remove left and right tie-down
extensions (2) through holes in bumper (12). Discard locknuts.
5. Remove clips securing wiring harness to bumper (12). Clear wiring harness from underneath
bumper.
NOTE
6. Remove 4 nuts (6), Iockwashers (7), washers (8), and bolts (13) on left and right side.
Remove bumper (12). Discard Iockwashers.
9-10
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
b. INSTALLATION
NOTE
2. Install reinforcement (18) with 2 bolts (14), washers (15), new Iockwashers (16), and nuts
(17).
TA49707
9-11
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
3. Install 4 bolts (13), washers (8), new Iockwashers (7), and nuts (6) on left and right sides. DO
NOT fully tighten nuts.
4. Install 2 tie-down extensions (2) with 2 bolts (5), washers (4), and new locknuts (3). DO NOT
fully tighten locknuts.
5. Install 4 bolts (10), 4 bolts (11), and 8 new locknuts (1). DO NOT fully tighten locknuts.
TA49708
9-12
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
NOTE
Ensure that holes in bumper (12) and reinforcement (18) are alined before
tightening nuts (3 and 6) and locknuts (1) in steps 6 and 7.
6. Tighten 4 nuts (6) and 8 locknuts (1) to 60-75 Ib.-ft. (81-102 N•m).
9. Install each tie-down clevis (21) with pin (20) and new cotter pin (19).
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
9-13
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
Equipment Condition Materials/Parts
• Rear bumper removed. (See paragraph 9-6) • Six locknuts
Tools/Test Equipment
• Torque wrench
a. REMOVAL
NOTE
Rear bumper supports are removed the same way on both sides.
1. Remove 2 locknuts (6), washers (2), bolts (1), and tow hook reinforcement (3). Discard
locknuts.
2. Remove 2 locknuts (8), 2 bolts (4), and bumper brace (9). Discard locknuts.
3. Remove locknut (11), washer (10), and bolt (5). Remove locknut (7), bolt (13), and tie-down
clevis bracket (12). Discard locknuts.
TA49709
9-14
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
b. INSTALLATION
NOTE
Rear bumper supports are installed the same way on both sides.
1. Install tie-down clevis (12) to bottom of frame with bolt (5), washer (10), and new locknut
(11). DO NOT fully tighten locknut.
2. Install bolt (13) and new locknut (7) through side of frame. DO NOT fully tighten locknut.
3. Install bumper brace (9) with 2 bolts (4) and new locknuts (8). DO NOT fully tighten locknuts.
4. Install tow hook reinforcement (3) with 2 bolts (1), new washers (2), and new locknuts (6). DO
NOT fully tighten locknuts.
9-15
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
3. Remove 2 wiring harness tie-down straps from bumper braces (19). Discard tie-down straps,
TA49710
9-16
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
4. Remove cotter pin (5) from pin (3). Remove pin and tie-down clevis (4). Discard cotter pin.
Repeat step to remove other tie-down clevis.
5. Remove 2 bolts (1) and washers (14) securing tow hook bracket (12) to crossmember.
Remove 2 bolts (7) and washers (6).
NOTE
Bumper (2) is factory-installed with locknuts and washers instead of nuts
(17) and Iockwashers (16). Use nuts and Iockwashers for installation.
6. Remove 4 nuts (17), Iockwashers (16), washers (15), and bolts (24) securing bumper (2) to 2
bumper braces (18). Discard Iockwashers.
WARNING
7. Remove 4 nuts (20), lockwashers (21), washers (22), and bolts (23) securing bumper (2) to 2
bumper braces (19), Remove bumper with tow hook bracket (12) and pintle hook (8)
attached. Discard Iockwashers.
9-17
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
9. Remove 4 nuts (10), Iockwashers (11), washers (9), and bolts (13). Remove tow hook
bracket (12) from bumper (2). Discard Iockwashers.
b. INSTALLATION
1. Install tow hook bracket (12) to bumper (2) with 4 bolts (13), washers (9), new Iockwashers
(11), and nuts (10). DO NOT fully tighten nuts.
9-18
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
WARNING
NOTE
3. Position bumper (2) with tow hook bracket (12) and pintle hook (8) attached, and install 4 bolts
(24), washers (15), new Iockwashers (16), and nuts (17). DO NOT fully tighten nuts.
4. Install 4 bolts (23), washers (22), new Iockwashers (21), and nuts (20). Tighten nuts (17 and
20) to 45-60 Ib.-ft. (61-81 N•m).
5. Install tow hook bracket (12) to crossmember with 2 bolts (1) and washers (14).
7. Install each tie-down clevis (4) with pin (3) and new cotter pin (5).
8. Secure wiring harness to 2 bumper braces (19) with 2 new tie-down straps.
9-19
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
Too/s/Test Equipment
Torque wrench
Screwdriver bit set, J-29843
a. REMOVAL
NOTE
Rear bumper supports are removed the same way on both sides. Right
side removal is shown.
1. Remove 4 nuts (8), 8 washers (9), 4 bolts (25), and reinforcement (24).
2. Remove plastic tie securing wiring harness to bumper brace (16). Discard plastic tie.
3. Remove 2 nuts (3), Iockwashers (4), and bolts (15), and remove bumper brace (16). Discard
Iockwashers.
4. Remove nut (30), Iockwasher (1), and stud (7). Discard Iockwasher.
5. Remove 2 nuts (27 and 29), Iockwashers (26 and 28), and bolts (18 and 19). Discard
Iockwashers.
6. Remove nut (14), Iockwasher (13), and bolt (2) Discard Iockwasher.
7. Remove nut (23), Iockwasher (22), washer (21), and bolt (5) securing tow hook reinforcement
bracket (11) to frame. Discard Iockwasher.
8. Remove locknut (17), bolt (10), and tow hook reinforcement bracket (11). Remove tie-down
clevis bracket (12), tie-down extension (20), and bumper brace (6). Discard locknut.
b. INSTALLATION
NOTE
Rear bumper supports are installed the same way on both sides. Right side
installation is shown.
1. Install tie-down clevis bracket (12) to frame with bolt (2), new Iockwasher (13), and nut (14).
DO NOT fully tighten nut.
9-20
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
2. Install tow hook reinforcement bracket (11) and tie-down extension (20) at tie-down clevis
bracket (12) with bolt (10) and new locknut (17). DO NOT fully tighten locknut.
3. Position bumper brace (6) between frame and tow hook reinforcement bracket (11) and install
bolt (19), new Iockwasher (26), and nut (27). DO NOT fully tighten nut.
4. Install bolt (18), new Iockwasher (28), and nut (29), DO NOT fully tighten nut.
5. Install bolt (5), washer (21), new Iockwasher (22), and nut (23). DO NOT fully tighten nut.
6. Install stud (7), engage torque rod on stud, and install new Iockwasher (1) and nut (30). DO
NOT fully tighten nut.
TA49714
9-21
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
7. Install bumper brace (16) with 2 bolts (15), new Iockwashers (4), and nuts (3), Install wiring
harness to bumper brace with new plastic tie. DO NOT fully tighten nuts.
8. Install reinforcement (24) with 4 bolts (25), 8 washers (9), and 4 nuts (8). DO NOT fully tighten
nuts.
9. Tighten nuts (3, 8, 14, 23, 27, 29, and 30) and locknut (17) to 55 Ib.-ft. (75 N•m).
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
• Install rear bumper, tow hook bracket, and tie-down clevises. (See paragraph 9-8)
TA49715
9-22
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
a. REMOVAL
WARNING
Use extreme caution when lowering spare tire (9) and carrier (4). Spare
tke is heavy. Dropping It may result in serious injury to personnel.
NOTE
1. Remove nut (5) from bolt (2), Lower spare tire (9) and carrier (4) to ground. Remove locking
bracket (3) from bolt.
TA49716
9-23
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
NOTE
3. Remove nut (1) from above frame. Remove carrier (4) with attached bolt (8) and nut (10).
4. Remove nut (10) from bolt (8) and remove bolt from carrier (4).
5. Remove 4 rivets (7) and 2 guides (6) from carrier (4) if damaged. Discard rivets.
NOTE
9-24
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
b. INSTALLATION
NOTE
1. If removed, install 2 guides (6) to carrier (4) with 4 new rivets (7).
3. Install carrier (4), bolt (8), and nut (10) assembly through left frame.
6. Install spare tire (9) on carrier (4) so that guides (6) catch on spare tire rim.
WARNING
Use extreme caution when raising spare tire (9) and carrier. Spare tire is
heavy. Dropping it may result in serious injury to personnel.
7. Install locking bracket (3) to bolt (2). Lift spare tire (9) on carrier (4) until bolt passes through
slot in carrier.
8. Install nut (5) to boit (2) and turn nut at least 8 turns. Tighten nut until spare tire (9) and carrier
(4) are securely installed.
9. Tighten nut (10) on bolt (8) until nut jams against frame.
9-25/(9-26 blank)
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
CHAPTER 10
BODY AND ACCESSORIES MAINTENANCE
Paragraph Page
Number Procedures Number
10-2. Radiator Grille and Front End Panel Molding Replacement . . . . . . . 10-2
10-3. Ventilator Panel Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-4
10-4. Hood, Hinge, and Latch Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-6
10-5. Door and Hinge Assembly Maintenance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-10
10-6. Door Handle, Lock, and Cylinder Replacement ..... . . . . . . . . . 10-14
10-7. Door Panel, Armrest, and Window Regulator Replacement . . . . . . 10-18
10-8. Door and Vent Window Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-22
10-1
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
Equipment Condition
• Headlight bezels removed. (See paragraph 4-24)
a. REMOVAL
NOTE
1. Remove 5 screws (5) and 3 screws (3). Remove radiator grille (1) from behind radiator grille
guard (6).
TA49928
10-2
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
3. Remove 18 nuts (8) and molding assembly. Remove 2 side moldings (9) and 4 clips (10) from
upper molding (7) and lower molding (11) if damaged.
b. INSTALLATION
NOTE
1. Install 2 side moldings (9) and 4 clips (10) on upper molding (7), and install lower molding (11)
if removed. Install molding assembly with 18 nuts (8).
3. Install radiator grille (1) behind radiator grille guard (6) with 5 screws (5) and 3 screws (3).
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
10-3
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
Equipment Condition
• Windshield wiper arms removed. (See paragraph 10-11)
a. REMOVAL
NOTE
If removing washer nozzle (2) only, perform step 1.
b. INSTALLATION
NOTE
1. Position air inlet screen (12) and snap 2 tangs (13) into place. Install 2 screen retainers (9)
with 2 bolts (8).
2. Install 2 retainer nuts (10), 3 retainers (7), and 2 retainers (6) if removed. Install ventilator
panel (1).
3. Install each washer hose (5) with retainer (4). Install each washer nozzle (2) with 1 screw (3),
Install 4 bolts (11).
TA49930
10-4
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
10-5
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
NOTE
NOTE
TA49932
10-6
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
TA49933
10-7
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
b. INSTALLATION
NOTE
TA49934
10-8
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
c. HOOD ALINEMENT
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
10-9
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP
Personnel Required
• MOS 63B (2)
NOTE
1. Mark position of hinge assemblies (3 and 9) on body side pillar and door (4), Remove 3 bolts
(12) at lower hinge assembly (9) and 3 bolts (2) at upper hinge assembly (3), Remove door
(4) .
2. Reach up under instrument panel and remove plug from hidden bolt (1). Remove hidden bolt
and 5 bolts (8), and upper and lower hinge assemblies (3 and 9) from body side pillar.
b. HINGE DISASSEMBLY
1. If worn or damaged, remove torque rod (5) from upper hinge assembly (3). Remove pin (6)
and 2 bushings (7) from upper hinge assembly if worn or damaged.
2. Remove pin (10) and 2 bushings (11) from lower hinge assembly (9) if worn or damaged.
c. HINGE ASSEMBLY
1. Install pin (10) and 2 bushings (11) to lower hinge assembly (9) as required.
2. Install torque rod (5), pin (6), and 2 bushings (7) to upper hinge assembly (3) as required.
d. INSTALLATION
NOTE
1. Reach up under instrument panel and install upper hinge assembly (3) to body side pillar with
hidden bolt (1). Install 2 bolts (8) on upper hinge assembly. Install lower hinge assembly (9)
with 3 bolts (8), Ensure that upper and lower hinge assemblies are alined with marks on body
side pillar.
10-10
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
2. Position door (4) at upper and lower hinge assemblies (3 and 9). Aline upper and lower hinge
assemblies to marks made on door. Install 3 bolts (2) at upper hinge assembly (3) and 3 bolts
(12) at lower hinge assembly (9).
TA49936
10-11
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
e. ADJUSTMENT
Gap between windshield pillar (14) and door (4) should be 0.02 in. to 0.14 in.
(0.5 mm to 3.5 mm).
Gap between roof panel (13) and door (4) should be 0.1 in. to 0.28 in. (3 mm to
7 mm).
Gap between rear pillar (15) and door (4) should be 0.1 in. to 0.28 in. (3 mm to
7 mm).
Gap between rocker panel (16) and door (4) should be 0.15 in. to 0.33 in. (4 mm to
8 mm).
TA49937
10-12
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
3. Loosen 5 bolts (8) and hidden bolt (1). Adjust door (4) on upper and lower hinge assemblies
(3 and 9) until all measurements in step 1 are obtained. Tighten bolts and install plug on hidden
bolt.
4. Install washer (18) and door lock striker (17) on striker plate (19). Adjust door lock striker as
required to engage door (4) lock. Tighten door lock striker.
TA49938
10-13
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
CAUTION
When removing clips (11, 14, and 16), carefully push at top of clip where
it is connected to connecting links (4, 12, or 17) to pivot clip away from
link. Failure to follow this caution will result in damage to clips,
NOTE
• If removing handle (6) and lock cylinder unit (7), perform steps 1-3.
1. Remove clip (11) and disconnect outside door connecting link (4) from lock assembly (10).
TA49939
10-14
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
2. Remove 2 bolts (1), handle (6), and outside door connecting link (4) from door (2). Remove
outside door connecting link from handle. Remove large gasket (3) and small gasket (5).
Discard gaskets.
3. Remove retainer (9), lock cylinder unit (7), and gasket (8), Discard gasket.
4. Remove clips (14 and 16) and disconnect inside handle connecting link (17) and inside door
connecting link (12). Remove lock knob (13). Remove 3 screws (15) and lock assembly (10).
5. Remove seal (20). Remove 3 screws (19). Slide clip (21) until large slot alines with inside
handle connecting link (17). Disconnect inside handle connecting link and remove control
assembly (18).
TA49940
10-15
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
b. INSTALLATION
NOTE
• If installing lock assembly (10) and control assembly (18), perform
steps 1, 2, and 5.
• If installing handle (6) and lock cylinder unit (7), perform steps 3-5.
1. Connect inside handle connecting link (17) to control assembly (18). Slide clip (21) until small
slot alines with inside handle connecting link. Install control assembly with 3 screws (19), Install
seal (20).
2. Install lock assembly (10) in door (2) with 3 screws (15). Install lock knob (13). Connect inside
handle connecting link (12) and inside door connecting link (17) to lock assembly and install
clips (14 and 16).
TA49941
10-16
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
3. Install new gasket (8) and lock cylinder unit (7) on door (2). Install retainer (9).
4. Install new large gasket (3) on handle (6). Install outside door connecting link (4) on handle.
Install outside door connecting link and handle in door (2). Loosely install 1 bolt (1) on large
gasket side. Install new small gasket (5) between door and handle. Install other bolt (1) and
tighten both bolts.
5. Connect outside door connecting link (4) to lock assembly (10) and install clip (11).
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
• Install door panel. (See paragraph 10-7)
TA49942
10-17
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
Tools/Test Equipment
• Retaining clip remover, J-24595-B
a. REMOVAL
NOTE
3. Remove 2 screws (5) and 6 screws (8). Pry door panel (4) away from door (1) and remove.
Remove spacer (3) and handle plate (2) from window regulator assembly (14) pin as required.
NOTE
Perform step 4 only if armrest (7) is damaged or door panel (4) is being
replaced.
5. Inspect door panel seal (13) for damage, and replace if required. Clean all seal material from
door panel (4) if removed.
6. Remove 4 screws (20). install handle (12), without retainer (11), on window regulator
assembly (14). Crank window regulator to disengage front roller (15) from sash channel (16).
While holding front roller clear of sash channel, crank window regulator in opposite direction to
disengage lower roller (18) from regulator rail (19), Remove handle and move window
regulator assembly rearward to disengage rear roller (17) from sash channel. Remove window
regulator assembly through access hole in door.
10-18
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
10-19
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
b. INSTALLATION
NOTE
If installing door panel (4), perform steps 3-8.
1. Lubricate rollers (15, 17, and 18), sash channel (16), and regulator rail (19).
2. Insert window regulator assembly (14) through access hole in door and engage rear roller (17)
in sash channel (16). Install handle (12), without retainer (11), and crank window regulator
until lower roller (18) engages on regulator rail (19). Continue cranking window regulator until
forward roller (15) engages through notch in sash channel. Aline screw holes, then remove
handle. Install window regulator assembly with 4 screws (20).
3. Peel backing from new door panel seal (13) and install on door panel (4) if removed.
4. Install handle plate (2) and spacer (3) on window regulator assembly (14) pin if removed.
5. If removed, install armrest (7) on door panel (4) with nut (9).
6. Snap door panel (4) into place on door (1), Install 6 screws (8) and 2 screws (5).
7. Position handle plate (10) on handle (12), and install retainer (11) on notch in handle. Snap
handle assembly into place on door panel (4) and window regulator assembly (14) pin.
10-20
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
• Remove tape from window if used.
• Check operation of handle and window regulator.
TA49945
10-21
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
a. REMOVAL
NOTE
• If replacing vent window, perform DISASSEMBLY steps 2 and 3.
1. Remove screw (5) and slide up cover (3). Remove bolt (4), From inside of door, remove bolt
(1) and reinforcement (6). Remove spacer (2).
TA49946
10-22
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
NOTE
If window will not disengage using the procedure in step 5, raise window
slightly, remove bumper (15), lower window, and repeat step 5.
TA49947
10-23
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
b. DISASSEMBLY
WARNING
NOTE
• If disassembling door window, perform step 1.
2. Remove pin (32) and pull off handle (22), plunger (23), and spring (24). Remove screw (31)
and stud (30). Remove washer (29), plastic washer (25), plate (27), and spacer (26) from
vent window glass (28).
CAUTION
Immediately wipe off dry cleaning solvent if it drips onto truck. Failure to
follow this caution may result in damage to truck interior or exterior paint.
3. Open vent window and apply dry cleaning solvent to filler (44) around vent window glass (28).
When filler softens, pull vent window glass and old filler from sash (45). Discard filler.
TA49948
10-24
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
5. Remove rivet (35) and sash hinge (34) from frame hinge (36), Straighten tab on tab washer
(41), remove nut (42), tab washer, spring (40), spring retainer washer (39), 2 washers (38),
and stop (37). Discard rivet.
6. Remove sash (45) from frame (33). Remove weatherstrip (46) from frame.
c. ASSEMBLY
NOTE
• If replacing door window, perform step 8.
• If replacing vent window, perform steps 4-7.
2. Install stop (37), 2 washers (38), spring retainer washer (39), spring (40), tab washer (41),
and nut (42) on sash (45). Bend tab on tab washer back to lock nut into position. Install sash
hinge (34) on frame hinge (36) with new rivet (35).
3. Apply adhesive to weatherstrip (43) as required. Install weatherstrip on frame (33) and bend
tabs on back of weatherstrip.
TA49949
10-25
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
4. Thoroughly clean inside of sash (45), Install new filler (44) on vent window glass (28).
5. Brush inside of sash (45) with soap solution. Firmly press new filler (44) and vent window glass
(28) into sash,
6. Install spacer (26) and plastic washer (25) on vent window glass (28) with flanged side facing
glass. Install plate (27) with small end toward top of glass. Install stud (30) with screw (31).
TA49950
10-26
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
d. INSTALLATION
NOTE
If installing vent window assembly (17), perform steps 2-6.
1. Install bumper (15) if removed. Position window glass (18) and sash channel (20) assembly in
door. Push window glass forward, then tilt up and slide rear window regulator assembly roller
(21) into sash channel. Slide window glass backward until forward window regulator assembly
roller is alined with notch in sash channel, then engage. Slide window glass assembly
backward into window glass run (14) channel.
2. Install bumper (8), retaining nut (7), and screw (9) if removed. DO NOT tighten screw.
3. Position window glass run (14) along vent window assembly (17). Position vent window
assembly in door (13), and seat edge of vent window assembly and window glass run along
inside of door.
4. Tighten screw (9), Install window regulator handle and operate window. Loosen or tighten
screw as required for smooth operation, then remove window regulator handle. Install screw
(16).
5. Install screw (12). Install 2 spacers (11) and screws (10).
TA49951
10-27
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
10-28
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
Paragraph Page
Number Procedures Number
10-29
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
a. REMOVAL
1. Remove bolt (10) and slide up cover (9) while turning outside rearview mirror (7) toward window.
Remove 3 bolts (11), and remove outside rearview mirror assembly and gasket (2).
2. Remove 2 bolts (1) and separate clamp (4) from bracket (3). Remove retainer (5) and sleeve
(6), and separate cover (9) from outside rearview mirror (7). Remove 2 grommets (8) and
retaining nut (12) as required.
b. INSTALLATION
NOTE
M1028A2 and M1028A3 driver’s side mirrors have a longer shaft than do
other models.
1. Install retaining nut (12) on bracket (3) and 2 grommets (8) on outside rearview mirror (7) arm if
removed. Position outside rearview mirror arm through hole in cover (9) with lower grommet
against cover.
2. Install sleeve (6) and retainer (5) on outside rearview mirror (7) arm. Install bracket (3) and
clamp (4) around sleeve with 2 bolts (1).
3. Install gasket (2) and outside rearview mirror (7) assembly with 3 bolts (11), Slide down cover
(9) and install bolt (10).
10-30 Change 2
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
Tools/Test Equipment
• 10 mm socket
a. REMOVAL
NOTE
If removing wiper arms (1), perform step 1.
1. Remove wiper blade (2) from wiper arm (1), Remove wiper arm from wiper transmission (4
or 7). Remove insert (3) from wiper blade if damaged.
TA49954
10-31
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
3. Remove 6 bolts (23) and Iockwashers (22). Using 10 mm socket, loosen nuts (8) and
disconnect right wiper transmission (4) rod from windshield wiper motor pin (11). Remove
wiper transmission assembly. Separate left wiper transmission (7) from right wiper
transmission (4) if damaged. Discard Iockwashers.
4. Disconnect leads from windshield wiper motor (14). Disconnect pump hose (12) and 2 nozzle
hoses (6) from windshield wiper motor.
5. If ventilator panel was not removed, loosen nuts (8) using 10 mm socket through access hole
in top of bulkhead (9), and disconnect right wiper transmission (4) rod from windshield wiper
motor pin (11).
TA49955
10-32
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
6. Remove 3 bolts (20) and grommets (21). Remove windshield wiper motor (14) and gasket
(10). Discard gasket.
7. If ventilator panel was not removed, remove retainer (5) and disconnect nozzle hose (6) if
damaged.
8. Remove 2 retainers (13) and disconnect and remove pump hose (12) if damaged. Remove
and disassemble cap (19), hose (18), and filter (17). Clean filter if clogged. Remove 2 screws
(16) and washer solvent container (15).
b. INSTALLATION
NOTE
• If installing hoses (6, 12, and 18) and washer solvent container (15),
perform steps 1 and 2 as required.
1. Install washer solvent container (15) with 2 screws (16). Assemble and install filter (17), hose
(18), and cap (19). Connect pump hose (12) to washer solvent container and install retainers
(13) if removed.
3. Position new gasket (10) and windshield wiper motor (14) on bulkhead (9) and install with 3
grommets (21) and bolts (20).
4. Grease windshield wiper motor pin (11). If ventilator panel was not removed, connect right
wiper transmission (4) rod to windshield wiper motor pin. Tighten nuts (8) using 10 mm socket
through access hole in top of bulkhead (9).
5. Connect 2 nozzle hoses (6) and pump hose (12) to windshield wiper motor (14). Connect
leads to windshield wiper motor.
6. Install left wiper transmission (7) on right wiper transmission (4) if separated, Position wiper
transmission assembly. Grease windshield wiper motor pin (11). Connect right wiper
transmission rod to windshield wiper motor pin. Using 10 mm socket tighten nuts (8). Install 6
new Iockwashers (22) and bolts (23).
Install insert (3) on wiper blade (2) if removed. install wiper arm (1) on wiper transmission (4
or 7) until wiper arms are parallel. Install wiper blade on wiper arm.
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
10-33
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
Too/s/Test Equipment
• ½ in. drive metric socket set
a. REMOVAL
NOTE
If removing heater blower motor (2) and fan (13), perform steps 2-4.
1. Disconnect leads (8) from resistor (7). Remove 2 screws (6) and remove resistor.
2. Disconnect leads (5) from capacitor (3). Remove screw (4) and capacitor.
3. Disconnect vent hose (9) from heater blower motor (2). Remove 5 screws (10), heater blower
motor and fan (13) assembly, and seal (14). Discard seal.
4. Remove locknut (11), washer (12), and fan (13). Replace heater blower motor (2) and/or fan
if damaged. Discard locknut.
b. INSTALLATION
NOTE
If installing heater blower motor (2) and fan (13), perform steps 1-3.
1. Install fan (13) on heater blower motor (2) with washer (12) and new locknut (11).
2. Install new seal (14) on heater blower motor (2) assembly and position on blower motor case
(1). Install 5 screws (10). DO NOT install upper right-hand screw (4) at this time. Connect vent
hose (9) to heater blower motor.
3. Install capacitor (3) with screw (4). Connect capacitor leads (5).
4. Install resistor (7) with 2 screws (6). Connect resistor leads (8).
10-34
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
• Install rear battery if removed. (See paragraph 4-39)
TA49956
10-35
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
NOTE
• Drain coolant from hoses (3 and 9) and heater core (28) into a suitable
container.
1. Loosen clamps (2) and disconnect outlet hose (3) and inlet hose (9) from heater core tubes
(1).
TA49957
10-36
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
2. Loosen clamps (4) and disconnect outlet hose (3) from radiator (6) and inlet hose (9) from
crossover pipe (5).
3. Remove and discard strap (7). Remove hose clip (8) from inner fender and remove inlet and
outlet hoses (3 and 9). Remove hose clip from hoses.
5. Remove 2 screws (13) and spring retainers (12). Disconnect temperature cable (14) from
temperature shaft (15) and defroster cable (10) from defroster shaft (11).
TA49958
10-37
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
NOTE
TA49959
10-38
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
TA49960
10-39
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
b. INSTALLATION
NOTE
NOTE
10-40
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
NOTE
Step 3 only applies to trucks equipped with winterization kits,
TA49962
10-41
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
6. Connect defroster cable (10) to defroster shaft (11) with spring retainer (12) and install screw
(13). Connect temperature cable (14) to temperature shaft (15) with spring retainer and install
screw.
8. Install hose clip (8) to inner fender. Connect outlet hose (3) to radiator (6) and inlet hose (9)
to crossover pipe (5).
9. Connect outlet hose (3) to upper heater core tube (1) and inlet hose (9) to lower heater core
tube. Tighten 2 clamps (2) and clamps (4).
10. Install hose clip (8) to hoses (3 and 9), and install a new strap (7) around hoses.
TA49963
10-42
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
TA49964
10-43
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
Equipment Condition
• Instrument cluster plate removed. (See paragraph 4-7)
a. REMOVAL
1. Remove 4 screws (7) and pull out heater control assembly (6).
2. Remove nut (4) and disconnect defroster cable (3) from upper control arm (5) and heater
control base (2). Remove nut (10) and disconnect temperature cable (9) from lower control
arm (8) and heater control base.
TA49965
10-44
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
b. INSTALLATION
1. Connect indicator bulb (13) and wiring harness lead (12) to heater control assembly (6).
Connect wiring harness (11) to blower switch (1).
2. Connect temperature cable (9) to lower control arm (8) and heater control base (2), and
install nut (10). Connect defroster cable (3) to upper control arm (5) and heater control base,
and install nut (4).
3. Install heater control assembly (6) with 4 screws (7).
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
• Install instrument cluster plate, (See paragraph 4-7)
TA49966
10-45/(10-46 blank)
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
Paragraph Page
Number Procedures Number
Change 2 10-47
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
Personnel Required
• MOS 63B (2)
NOTE
1. Lower endgate (10) and pull up on 2 plates (1). Raise endgate partway and disconnect plates
from latch assemblies (9).
2. Lift right bushing (11) out of right trunnion (16). Lift left bushing (11) out of left trunnion (16)
and remove endgate (10).
8. Disconnect right rod (7) from clip (12) at handle assembly (13).
9. Remove 2 bolts (14) at left latch assembly (9). Disconnect rod (7) and remove left latch
assembly.
11. Disconnect left rod (7) from clip (12) at handle assembly (13).
12. Remove 2 bolts (14) and remove right latch assembly (9) and rod (7).
10-48
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
TA49967
10-49
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
b. INSTALLATION
NOTE
• If installing plates (1), perform steps 10 and 14.
3. Install right latch assembly (9) and attached right rod (7) with 2 bolts (14).
5. Install left rod (7) and handle assembly (13) through handle assembly hole in endgate (10).
6. Position left latch assembly (9) and connect to left rod (7). Install left latch assembly with 2
bolts (14) .
13. Position left bushing (11) onto left trunnion (16) and right bushing (11) onto right trunnion (16).
14. Raise endgate (10) partway and install 2 plates (1) at latch assemblies (9).
10-50
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
10-51
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
Too/s/Test Equipment
• Torque wrench
a. REMOVAL
NOTE
• Left and right shelter tie-downs are removed the same way.
• Nut (13) is tack welded. Remove nut only if threads appear damaged.
NOTE
NOTE
TA49969
10-52
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
b. INSTALLATION
NOTE
• Left and right shelter tie-downs are installed the same way.
1. Install spacer (18) into each front stake pocket (12). Position 2 pads (17) and front bracket
(16).
2. Install 2 bolts (15), 2 reinforcements (20), and 2 nuts (19). Tighten nuts to 50-65 Ib.-ft.
(68-88 N•m).
4. Position pad (14) at rear stake pocket (12) and install support (6) into cargo bed of truck.
5. Position bracket (5) at pad (14) and support (6). Thread bolt (4) through hole in pad into rear
stake pocket (12).
TA49970
10-53
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
NOTE
TA49971
10-54
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
Equipment Condition
• Heater control panel housing removed (if truck is equipped with winterization kits). (See
paragraph 11-4)
a. REMOVAL
TA701841
Change 2 10-54.1
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
2. Remove 4 screws (8) and screw (6), Lift up on instrument pad assembly (1) and remove. If
damaged, or if replacing instrument pad assembly, remove 6 retainers (5). Remove any
damaged push nuts (7) from instrument panel assembly (9).
b. INSTALLATION
1. Replace any removed push nuts (7) at instrument panel assembly (9).
2. If removed, install 6 retainers (5) to instrument pad assembly (1). Position instrument pad
assembly and snap into place, Install 4 screws (8) and screw (6).
TA701842
10-54.2 Change 2
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
• Install heater control panel housing if removed, (See paragraph 11-4)
TA701843
TM 9-2320-289-20
10-18. CARGO BENCH SEAT AND SEATBELT REPLACEMENT (ALL EXCEPT M1009).
INITIAL SETUP:
Tools/Test Equipment
• Torque wrench
a. REMOVAL
NOTE
• Bolts (4 and 6) may have plugs covering them. Save for installation.
1. Pry cover down to expose bolt (3) and remove bolt. Remove bolt (4) at seatbelt assembly (1)
retractor.
TA49972
10-55
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
10-18. CARGO BENCH SEAT AND SEATBELT REPLACEMENT (ALL EXCEPT M1009)
(Con’t).
NOTE
4. Move bench seat (2) forward to gain access to bolt (6). Remove bolt and remove seatbelt
assembly (7) through bench seat.
TA49973
10-56
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
10-18. CARGO BENCH SEAT AND SEATBELT REPLACEMENT (ALL EXCEPT Ml 009)
(Con’t).
NOTE
• Both seatbelt assemblies (7) must be removed to remove bench
seat (2).
Ž Bolts (8) may have covers. Remove these as required and save for
installation.
5. Remove 4 bolts (8) at 2 seat adjustment assemblies (12). Remove bench seat (2) and seat
adjustment assemblies from truck.
6. Remove wire assembly (11) from bench seat (2) and from 2 seat adjustment assemblies (12).
7. Remove 6 bolts (9) and 2 seat adjustment assemblies (12) from bench seat (2).
8. Remove 2 springs (10) from each seat adjustment assembly (12). Note position of springs for
installation.
TA49974
10-57
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
10-18. CARGO BENCH SEAT AND SEATBELT REPLACEMENT (ALL EXCEPT M1009)
(Con’t).
b. INSTALLATION
NOTE
2. Install 2 seat adjustment assemblies (12) to bench seat (2) with 6 bolts (9).
3. Install wire assembly (11) to bench seat (2) and to 2 seat adjustment assemblies (12).
4. Install bench seat (2) and attached seat adjustment assemblies (12) to truck with 4 bolts (8).
Install bolt covers as required.
5. Move bench seat (2) forward. Position seatbelt assembly (7) through bench seat and install to
cab floor with bolt (6). Tighten bolt to 40 Ib.-ft. (54 N•m). Install plug as required.
TA49975
10-58
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
10-18. CARGO BENCH SEAT AND SEATBELT REPLACEMENT (ALL EXCEPT M1009)
(Con’t).
6. Install seatbelt assembly (1) to door pillar with bolt (3). Tighten bolt to 40 Ib.-ft. (54 N•m).
Install cover over bolt.
NOTE
Step 7 only applies to left side.
7. Position seatbelt assembly (1) retractor and connect wire assembly (5).
8. Install seatbelt assembly (1) retractor with bolt (4). Tighten bolt to 40 Ib.-ft. (54 N•m). Install
plug as required.
TA49976
10-59
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
a. REMOVAL
NOTE
• If removing front rail assemblies (23), perform steps 1, 3, 14, and 15.
• If removing side rail assemblies (10), perform steps 1-10, and 17.
1. Inside cargo area, detach cargo cover (1) from all turnbuttons (4).
2. Inside cargo area, remove 4 straps (2) along front and rear roof bows (3).
TA49977
10-60
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
10-19. CARGO COVER AND FRAME MAINTENANCE (M1008 AND M1008A1) (Con’t).
6. At each corner, remove bow strap (11) from side rail assembly (10).
7. Fold 3 roof bows (3) forward until they rest on roof of truck cab.
8. At bow hinge bracket (15), remove nut (18), 2 washers (14), and bolt (13). Remove strut (17)
and 2 bushings (16) from bow hinge bracket.
TA49978
10-61
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
10-19. CARGO COVER AND FRAME MAINTENANCE (M1008 AND M1008A1) (Con’t).
TA49979
10-62
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
10-19. CARGO COVER AND FRAME MAINTENANCE (M1008 AND M1008A1) (Con’t).
14. Remove 2 bolts (27) and front rail assembly (23). Scrape off old RTV sealant from rail
assembly and from truck.
16. Remove 4 bolts (27) and rear rail assembly (12). Scrape off old RTV sealant from rear rail
assembly and from truck. Remove and discard 4 tube anchor nuts (28) if damaged.
17. Remove 2 nuts (26), washers (25), bolts (24), and side rail assembly (10). Scrape off old RTV
sealant from side rail assembly and from truck.
TA49980
10-63
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
10-19. CARGO COVER AND FRAME MAINTENANCE (M1008 AND M1008A1) (Con’t),
NOTE
All rail assemblies (10, 12, and 23) are repaired in same way.
2. Grind back of broken turnbutton (4) until flush with surface of rail.
3. Using a punch, drive broken turnbutton (4) out of rail assembly (10, 12, or 23).
4. Install new turnbutton (4) and install new locknut on back of turnbutton.
TA49981
10-64
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
10-19. CARGO COVER AND FRAME MAINTENANCE (M1008 AND M1008A1 ) (Con’t).
CAUTION
NOTE
1. Apply RTV sealant and install side rail assembly (10) with 2 bolts (24), washers (25), and nuts
(26). Be careful to install each side rail assembly so that built-in handles are at front and rear
corners.
3. Apply RTV sealant and install rear rail assembly (12) with 4 bolts (27).
4. Install 2 new tube anchor nuts (28) as required. Apply RTV sealant and install front rail
assembly (23) with 2 bolts (27).
TA49982
10-65
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
10-19. CARGO COVER AND FRAME MAINTENANCE (M1008 AND M1008A1) (Con’t).
6. Install bow strap (11) or strap (9) to roof bow (3) with bolt (7) and nut (8).
TA49983
10-66
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
10-19. CARGO COVER AND FRAME MAINTENANCE (M1008 AND M1008A1) (Con’t).
11. Install 4 bow straps (11) to corner handles of side rail assemblies (10).
12. Install cargo cover (1) over cargo cover frame assembly.
13. Secure 4 straps (5) to handles at front and rear rail assemblies (12 and 23).
14. Secure top of cargo cover (1) to front and rear roof bows (3) with 4 straps (2).
15. On inside and outside, secure bottom edges of cargo cover (1) to turnbuttons (4).
TA49984
10-67/(10-68 blank)
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
Paragraph Page
Number Procedures Number
Change 4 10-69
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
a. REMOVAL
NOTE
1. Remove nut (12), Iockwasher (11), and stud (9) from each frame extension (10). Discard
Iockwashers.
TA49985
10-70
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
2. Remove 2 bolts (1 6), disconnect 2 supports (15), and remove 2 spacers (14) and washers
(13).
CAUTION
Carefully guide out torque rods (1) when removing endgate (8). Failure to
follow this caution may result in damage to torque rods.
3. Remove 8 bolts (19) attaching 2 hinge assemblies (18) to floor panel. Remove endgate (8).
TA49986
10-71
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
b. DISASSEMBLY
NOTE
1. Remove 2 screws (20). Twist run channel (25) to clear window opening and remove run
channel.
2. Remove bolt (24), washer (23), spring (22), support (15), and washer (21).
TA49987
10-72
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
4. Remove 4 bolts (4) and 2 brackets (3), Remove 4 bolts (5). Remove 2 torque rods (1) with
silencers (2 and 6). Remove 2 torque rod brackets (7).
5. Remove clip (31) and disconnect latch rod (30) from control assembly (28).
6. Remove 4 screws (26) and pull out latch assembly (27) with latch rod (30). Remove clip (29)
and disconnect latch rod from latch assembly.
TA49988
10-73
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
7. Remove clip (42) and disconnect handle rod (43) from handle (40). Remove 2 screws (41)
and handle.
8. Remove 3 screws (39) and control assembly (28). Disconnect handle rod (43) from control
assembly.
NOTE
Stop (34) is factory-installed with flanged nut and washer instead of nut
(36) and Iockwasher (35). Use nut and Iockwasher for installation.
9. Remove spring (38). Remove 2 screws (33) and lockout rod (32). Remove nut (36),
Iockwasher (35), bolt (37), and stop (34). Discard Iockwasher.
TA49989
10-74
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
c. ASSEMBLY
NOTE
• If installing control assembly (28), perform steps 1-3, and 5.
1. Install stop (34) on endgate (8) with bolt (37), new Iockwasher (35), and nut (36). Install
lockout rod (32) with 2 screws (33). Install spring (38).
2. Connect handle rod (43) to control assembly (28). Engage control assembly with lockout rod
(32) and install with 3 screws (39).
3. install handie (40) with 2 screws (41). Connect handle rod (43) to handle and install clip (42).
4. Connect latch rod (30) to latch assembly (27) and install clip (29). Position latch rod with latch
assembly in endgate (8) and install with 4 screws (26).
5. Connect latch rod (30) to control assembly (28) and install clip (31).
TA49990
10-75
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
6. Position 2 torque rod brackets (7) in endgate (8). Position 2 torque rods (1) with silencers (2
and 6) in endgate. Install 4 bolts (5). Position 2 brackets (3), ensure that they cover silencers
(2), and install with 4 bolts (4).
8. Install washer (21), support (15), spring (22), and washer (23) with bolt (24).
9. Twist run channel (25) into window opening and position in endgate (8). Install 2 screws (20).
d. INSTALLATION
CAUTION
Carefully guide in torque rods (1) when installing endgate (8). Failure to
follow this caution may result in damage to torque rods.
2. Connect 2 washers (13), spacers (14), and supports (15) with 2 bolts (16).
3. Position torque rods (1), and install each on frame extension (10) with stud (9), new
Iockwasher (11), and nut (12). Tighten nuts to 45-60 Ib.-ft. (61-81 N•m).
TA49991
10-76
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
TA49992
10-77
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
a. REMOVAL
NOTE
TA49993
10-78 Change 2
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
2. Remove 2 screws (7) and cap (6) from each side of endgate (1). Remove seal (8 or 9) by
unsnapping clips (10).
3. Regulate window (17) until screws (14) are accessible. Remove 4 screws and sash channels
(13) from sash (15). Remove sash channels from window regulator (12) arms as required.
TA49994
10-79
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
WARNING
5. Carefully remove sash (15), filler (16), and window (17) assembly. Apply dry cleaning solvent
to filler along sash on both sides of window glass. When filler softens, remove window and filler
from sash. Remove old filler from sash and window. Discard filler.
7. Remove bezel (26) and gasket (20) from base (19). Remove 2 screws (29), Separate arm of
handle assembly (28) from base and remove pin (30).
8. Remove clip (25) and clutch (24). Remove retainer (23), spring washer (22), and ring (21),
Remove pawl (32) and spring (31), and remove lock unit (18).
TA49995
10-80
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
b. INSTALLATION
NOTE
1. Install lock unit (18) on base (19) with spring (31) and pawl (32). Install spring washer (22) and
retainer (23). Install clutch (24) with clip (25).
2. Install pin (30) on arm of base (19). Position arm of handle assembly (28) on base and install 2
screws (29), Install gasket (20) and bezel (26) on base.
3. Install base (19) and handle assembly (28) on endgate (1) with 2 nuts (27).
10-81
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
5. Install sash channels (13) on window regulator (12) arms if removed. Regulate window (17) until
sash channels and screws (14) can be installed.
6. Install new filler (16) on window (17) if removed. Apply a ½ in. wide strip of red tape along top
edge of rear tailgate window. Press filler and window assembly into sash (15) . Position sash,
filler, and window assembly in endgate (1).
TA49997
10-82 Change 2
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
8. Install seals (8 and 9) on endgate (1) by snapping clips (10) in place. Install cap (6) on each
side of endgate with 2 screws (7).
9. Install seals (2 and 5) on access cover (3) if removed. Install access cover on endgate (1) with
16 screws (4).
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
10-83
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
Tools/Test Equipment
• Torque wrench
• Screwdriver bit set, J-29843
a. REMOVAL
NOTE
If removing seatbelts (1 and 2), perform step 1.
TA49999
10-84
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
NOTE
Driver’s and passenger’s seat adjusters (4 and 8) are removed the
same way but component locations are reversed. Driver’s seat adjuster
removal is described.
TA50000
10-85
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
6. Remove 2 bolts (22) and disconnect strut (21) from rear bench seat (16). Remove 2 bolts (18)
and Iockwashers (19) from hinges (20). Remove rear bench seat. Discard Iockwashers.
TA50001
10-86
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
b. INSTALLATION
NOTE
• If installing seats (9) and seat adjuster assemblies (4 and 8), perform
steps 3-6.
1. Position rear bench seat (16). Install hinges (20) with 2 new Iockwashers (19) and bolts (18).
Connect strut (21) to rear bench seat with 2 bolts (22). Fold rear bench seat back. Tighten
bolts (18) to 30-45 Ib.-ft. (41-61 N•m). Tighten bolts (22) to 10-15 Ib.-ft. (14-20 N•m).
TA50002
10-87
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
NOTE
Driver’s and passenger’s seat adjusters (4 and 8) are installed the same
way but component locations are reversed. Driver’s seat adjuster
installation is described.
4. Install outer seat adjuster (4) and inner seat adjuster (8) on seat (9) with 4 bolts (14). Lock
outer seat adjuster and inner seat adjuster in place. Tighten bolts to 20-30 Ib.-ft.
(27-41 N•m).
TA50003
10-88
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
● Install radio mounting bracket if removed, (See paragraph 4-47)
TA50004
Change 4 10-89
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
a. REPAIR
1. Inside of the vehicle (driver’s side), remove the bolt that attaches the lower portion of the
seatbelt to the mounting post/pillar and discard it.
2. Outside of the vehicle, use the rear edge of the cab door opening to find the reinforcement
crossmember under the cab floor. Follow this crossmember inboard approximately 10 inches
and locate an existing 5/8-inch hole approximately 2 inches from the cab body mount.
3. From underneath the vehicle, using the existing 5/8-hch hole as a guide, drill a 1/2-inch
diameter hole straight up through the cab floor and floormat. This new attaching hole should
be approximately 6 inches straight back from the rear seat mounting bolt location.
4. If the floormat is still in the truck, cut and remove a 1 3/4-inch diameter section from the mat
around the drilled hole.
NOTE
If the floormat and jute backing are wet, go to step 5; if not, go to step 6.
5. Remove floormat. When floor is dry, remove any rust with a wire brush and paint bare spots
with primer (NSN 8010-01-193-0517). Replace floormat.
6. From inside the vehicle cab, place one hex head grade 8 bolt (1/2–inch – 13 coarse thread x
3-1/2 inch long (NSN 5305-00-071-2077) through the mounting plate of the seatbelt. Plaoe
two 1/2-inch flatwashers (NSN 5310-00-809-5997) onto the bolt and install the bolt into the
drilled hole in the floor.
10-90 Change 4
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
7. From underneath the vehicle, have an assistant place one 1/2-inch flatwasher (NSN
5310-00-809-5997) and one UNC-2B locknut (1/2–inch – 13 coarse thread, NSN
5310-00-225-6993) onto the seatbelt mounting bolt. Tighten the nut until all clearance
between the mounting plate, flatwasher, and cab floor is removed. Tighten the nut one
additional turn; don’t overtighten.
TM 9-2320-289-20
Paragraph Page
Number Procedures Number
10-91
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
—
10-25. DRIVER’S AND PASSENGER’S SEAT AND SEATBELT REPLACEMENT
(M1010).
INITIAL SETUP:
Tools/Test Equipment
• Torque wrench
a. REMOVAL
NOTE
If removing driver’s seat (11) and seat adjuster assemblies (7), perform
steps 3-7,
1. Remove bolt covers and remove bolt (2) and 2 floor-mounted bolts (4). Disconnect electrical
connector at seatbelt retractor (5). Remove driver’s seatbelt assembly (3).
TA50005
10-92
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
3. Remove 2 front bolts (12) securing 2 seat adjuster assemblies (7) to floor-mounted weldnuts
(15).
4. Adjust driver’s seat (11) forward and remove 2 rear bolts (12). Remove seat and 2 seat
adjuster assemblies (7).
NOTE
Note location of outer spring (13) and wire assembly (8) for installation.
TA50006
10-93
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
b. INSTALLATION
NOTE
If installing passenger’s seat (17) and supports (19 and 22), perform
steps 1-4.
If installing seat adjuster assemblies (7) and driver’s seat (11), perform
steps 5-9.
1. Install 2 front supports (22) and 2 rear supports (19) to passenger’s seat (17) with 8 bolts
(20). Tighten bolts to 15-25 Ib.-ft. (20-34 N•m).
2. Position passenger’s seat (17) with attached supports (19 and 22) at truck floor.
3. At right front corner, install bolt (23) through front support (22) into floor. At left front corner,
install bolt through front support into bracket assembly (21). DO NOT FULLY tighten bolts.
4. Install passenger’s seatbelt assembly (6) at 2 rear supports (19) with 2 bolts (18). Tighten
bolts to 40 Ib.-ft. (54 N•m). Tighten bolts (23) to 25 Ib.-ft. (34 N•m).
TA50007
10-94
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
6. If removed, install seat latch spring (16) to each seat adjuster assembly (7).
7. Install 2 seat adjuster assemblies (7) to driver’s seat (11) and to 2 brackets (10) with 6 bolts
(14). Tighten bolts to 20-30 Ib.-ft. (27-41 N•m). Install outer spring (13) between front of left
adjuster assembly and back of driver’s seat.
NOTE
A properly installed wire assembly (8) should not be in tension.
TA50008
10-95
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
10. Install passenger’s seatbelt assembly (6) to door pillar with bolt (1). Tighten bolt to 40 Ib.-ft.
(54 N•m). Install bolt cover.
11. Install driver’s seatbelt assembly (3) to door pillar with bolt (2). Tighten bolt to 40 Ib.-ft.
(54 N•m). P o s i t i o n s e a t b e l t r e t r a c t o r ( 5 ) a n d i n s t a l l e l e c t r i c a l c o n n e c t o r . I n s t a l l 2
floor-mounted bolts (4) and tighten to 40 Ib.-ft. (54 N•m). Install bolt covers.
TA50009
10-96
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
a. REMOVAL
WARNING
Use extreme caution when removing rear door assembly. Rear door
assembly is heavy and if dropped will cause equipment damage and
serious injury to personnel.
10-97
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
NOTE
• If removing rear door assembly (6) and hinges (5), perform steps 1
and 2.
• If removing right door assembly handles (8 and 14) and lock assembly
(7, 11, and 16), perform steps 3 and 5 through 12,
• If removing left door assembly inside handle and lock assembly (7, 11,
and 16), perform steps 4, 5, and 7 through 12.
1. Open door assembly (6). Support door assembly and remove 6 bolts (3) and washers (4).
Remove door assembly from truck.
2. Remove 6 bolts (2), washers (1), and 3 hinges (5) from truck if damaged.
TA50010
10-98
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
NOTE
7. Remove 2 bolts (15) and locknuts (10). Remove handle bracket (9). Discard locknuts.
9. Pull lock mechanism (11) aside in door assembly (6) to gain working room at access panel
(18) opening.
10. Remove cotter pin, steel washer, rubber washer, and bottom lock rod (16) through access
panel (18) opening. Discard cotter pin.
11. Remove top lock rod (7) and attached lock mechanism (11) through access panel (18)
opening.
12. Remove cotter pin, steel washer, rubber washer, and top lock rod (7) from lock mechanism
(11). Discard cotter pin.
b. INSTALLATION
WARNING
Use extreme caution when installing rear door assembly. Rear door
assembly is heavy and if dropped will cause equipment damage and
serious injury to personnel.
NOTE
If installing right door assembly handles (8 and 14) and lock assembly
(7, 11, and 16), perform steps 1-11.
If installing left door assembly inside handle and lock assembly (7, 11,
and 16), perform steps 1-7, 9, and 12.
1. Apply tape to ends of top and bottom lock rods (7 and 16) to prevent them from pivoting as
they are installed.
10-99
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
2. Install bottom lock rod (16) through access panel (18) opening and out bottom of door
assembly (6).
3. Install top lock rod (7) to lock mechanism (11) with rubber washer, steel washer, and new
cotter pin.
4. Install top lock rod (7) with attached lock mechanism (11) through access panel (18) opening
and out top of door assembly (6), Once installed, have assistant secure top lock rod to keep it
from falling out of position.
5. Install bottom lock rod (16) to lock mechanism (11) with rubber washer, steel washer, and new
cotter pin.
6. Loosely install 2 bolts (12) and new locknuts (10) through door assembly (6) and lock
mechanism (11).
TA50011
10-100
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
NOTE
7. Position handle bracket (9) behind lock mechanism (11) and loosely install 2 bolts (15) and
new locknuts (10).
NOTE
13. Install 3 hinges (5) to truck with 6 bolts (2) and washers (1). Tighten bolts to 40 Ib.-ft.
(54 N•m).
14. While supporting door assembly (6), install 3 hinges (5) to door assembly with 6 bolts (3) and
washers (4). DO NOT fully tighten bolts.
15. Close 2 door assemblies (6) and check for proper fit.
16. Adjust as required at 3 hinges (5). Tighten 6 bolts (3) to 40 Ib.-ft. (54 N•m).
10-101
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
a. REMOVAL
WARNING
If glass is cracked but still intact, crisscross glass with masking tape to
reduce risk of injury to personnel.
NOTE
Chalk mark in step 1 will be used during inspection of window flange (4).
TA50012
10-102
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
b. INSPECTION
WARNING
4. Inspect replacement fixed glass (3) to ensure that there are no rough or chipped edges.
c. INSTALLATION
WARNING
NOTE
2. Place a length of twine in glass glazing (2) groove where window flange (4) will fit. Overlap
ends of twine about 6 in. (152 mm) and locate at bottom of glass glazing.
4. Have an assistant hold glass glazing (2) with fixed glass (3) and twine up to outside window
opening. Place ends of twine through window and let them hang loosely inside.
5. While assistant holds fixed glass (3) in place, pull on one end of twine, forcing lip of glass
glazing (2) up and over window flange (4).
10-103
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
a. REMOVAL
NOTE
2. Remove 2 nuts (6), washers (9), bolts (10), and hook assembly (8).
4. Remove 2 nuts (13), 6 washers (12), 2 bolts (5), and step (11). Remove other step if
required.
5. Remove 2 nuts (3), washers (2), and bolts (1), and remove return spring (4).
b. INSTALLATION
NOTE
1. Install return spring (4) with 2 bolts (1), washers (2), and nuts (3).
2. Install step (11) with 2 bolts (5), 6 washers (12), and 2 nuts (13). Install other step if removed.
4. Install hook assembly (8) to step frame (7) with 2 bolts (10), washers (9), and nuts (6).
10-104
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
TA50014
10-105
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
a. REMOVAL
1. Depress pedal of travel adjustment arm (18) and slide attendant’s seat assembly rearward to
stop bolt. Remove stop bolt from track. Remove attendant’s seat assembly from tracks.
b. DISASSEMBLY
NOTE
2. Remove 3 screws (27), Iockwashers (1), and seat (2). Discard Iockwashers.
3. Remove 2 nuts (8), washers (9), and bolts (3), and remove 2 seatbelts (4) from seatbelt
bracket (5).
4. Remove cotter pin (11), support bracket pin (25), and support bracket (10). Discard cotter
pin.
WARNING
5. Depress pedal at height adjustment arm (21), pull back expansion pin (13) at travel adjustment
arm (18), and remove stem assembly (26) and stem spring (12).
10-106
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
10-107
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
TA50016
10-108
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
NOTE
Some models use a locknut instead of a washer (16) and nut (17) at roller
(14).
NOTE
Mark location of brackets (15) on attendant’s seat frame for Installation.
8. Remove 4 nuts (22), 4 washers (23), 2 brackets (24), and 2 brackets (15).
c. ASSEMBLY
1. Install 2 brackets (15) and 2 brackets (24) with 4 washers (23) and nuts (22).
2. Install 4 rollers (14) with washers (16) and nuts (17).
3. Install track Iockpin (19) at travel adjustment arm (18) with new locknut (20).
WARNING
4. Depress pedal at height adjustment arm (21). Install stem spring (12) and stem assembly
(26).,
5. Install support bracket (10) with support bracket pin (25) and new cotter pin (11).
6. Install 2 seatbelts (4) to seatbelt bracket (5) with 2 bolts (3), washers (9), and nuts (8).
Tighten nuts to 40 Ib.-ft. (54 N•m).
7. Install seat (2) with 3 new Iockwashers (1) and screws (27),
8. Install seatbelt bracket (5) on seat (2) with 3 new Iockwashers (6) and screws (7).
d. INSTALLATION
10-109
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
Materials/Parts
Four rivets
Two screws
a. REMOVAL
NOTE
If removing window glass, see paragraph 10-27.
If removing handles (8 and 16), slam lock (9), and hasp and shaft
assembly (11), perform steps 6-9.
1. Remove 2 rivets (14) securing bracket (13) to side frame. Discard rivets.
2. Remove 2 screws (12) and floor track (15) with attached bracket (13).
NOTE
3. Remove left nut (4) at roller track (3). Remove left bolt (1).
4. Close sliding door (2) and remove right nut (4) at roller track (3). Remove right bolt (1).
5. Open sliding door (2). Remove sliding door while holding roller track (3) stationary.
8. Turn handle (16) to gain access to 2 screws (17). Remove screws, handle, and hasp and shaft
assembly (11).
9. Remove pin and remove handle (16) from hasp and shaft assembly (11).
10. Remove 4 rivets (6), snap fastener, and blackout curtain (5). Discard rivets.
10-110
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
b. INSTALLATION
NOTE
• If installing blackout curtain (5), perform step 1.
• If installing handles (8 and 16), slam lock (9), and hasp and shaft
assembly (11), perform steps 2-5.
• If installing sliding door (2), perform steps 6-11.
1. Install blackout curtain (5) with 4 new rivets (6) and snap fastener.
2. Install handie (16) to hasp and shaft assembly (11) with pin.
3. Install handle (16) and hasp and shaft assembly (11) at sliding door (2) with 2 screws (17).
4. Install slam lock (9) with 4 bolts (7) and nuts (10).
TA50017
10-111
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
6. Fully open roller track (3). Hold roller track stationary and install sliding door (2).
NOTE
Ensure that bolts (1) are installed with heads facing toward rear of truck.
7. Close sliding door (2) and install right bolt (1) and nut (4).
8. Partially open sliding door (2) and install left bolt (1) and nut (4).
9. Clean area where floor track (15) is to be installed. Install floor track with 2 screws (12).
10. Install 2 new screws (14) at bracket (13) into side frame.
11. Check operation of sliding door (2). Adjust sliding door height by loosening 2 nuts (4),
adjusting height, and tightening nuts.
TA50018
10-112
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
Manual References
• FM 3-5
• TM 10-277
• TM 9-2320-289-10
WARNING
10-113
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
NOTE
4. Remove 4 screws (6) and Iockwashers (7), and remove manifold (5). Discard Iockwashers.
NOTE
10-114
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
NOTE
Both gas canisters (12) are replaced in same way.
WARNING
CAUTION
DO NOT allow moisture to come in contact with filter material or filter will
be damaged.
1. Clean gas-particulate filter (9) and manifold (5) with a cloth moistened with dry cleaning
solvent.
2. Inspect manifold (5), gas-particulate filter (9), and all gaskets for damage. Ensure that
gaskets will make an airtight seal. If gaskets are damaged, notify your supervisor.
TA50020
10-115
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
c. INSTALLATION
NOTE
See TM 9-2320-289-10 for gas-particulate filter (9) and gas canister
(12) part number information.
NOTE
3. Install gas-particulate filter (9) into filter housing (10) and ensure that felt gasket (8) will be
against manifold (5).
TA50021
10-116
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
4. Install manifold (5) with 4 screws (6) and new Iockwashers (7).
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
TA50022
10-117
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
a. REMOVAL
WARNING
NOTE
1. Loosen 2 nuts (4) and disconnect intake pipe (16) and output pipe (3) from 2 fittings (1 and
15).
NOTE
Trucks equipped with winterization kits will have an engine coolant heater
fuel line (2) at fitting (1) instead of cap (14) and gasket (13).
2. Remove 2 fittings (1 and 15) from heater fuel pump (5), and cap (14) and gasket (13) from
fitting (1) if damaged. Discard gasket if removed.
4. Remove 2 bolts (12) and heater fuel pump (5). Remove 2 nuts (9) if damaged.
5. Remove filter (11) from heater fuel pump (5) and set aside for cleaning.
10-118
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
b. CLEANING
WARNING
2. Flush out filter (11) with clean fuel, removing any dirt and sediment.
10-119
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
c. INSTALLATION
NOTE
If installing cut-out switch (7), perform steps 1, 2, and 5.
TA50024
10-120
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
NOTE
Trucks equipped with winterization kits will have an engine coolant heater
fuel line (2) at fitting (1) instead of cap (14) and gasket (13).
6. install new gasket (13) and cap (14) to fitting (1) if removed.
8. Connect intake pipe (16) and output pipe (3) to 2 fittings (1 and 15) by tightening 2 nuts (4).
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
10-121
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
Equipment Condition
. Both battery negative cables disconnected. (See paragraph 4-38)
a. REMOVAL
NOTE
2. Raise cover assembly (1) and disconnect 2 wires (8) at 2 condenser motors (11) and ground
wire at left condenser motor. Remove cover assembly.
TA50025
10-122
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
3. Remove bolt (15), washer (14), and ground wire (13) at clamp (2).
6. Remove condenser motor (11) and fan (10) from clamp (2).
7. Remove setscrew on fan (10) and remove fan from condenser motor (11).
b. INSTALLATION
NOTE
2. Install fan (10) to condenser motor (11) with setscrew. Ensure that setscrew is indexed to flat
side of condenser motor shaft.
3. Position condenser motor (11) and fan (10) inside clamp (2).
4. Install ground wire and tighten condenser motor (11) and fan (10) with washer (14) and bolt
(15).
7. Position cover assembly (1) and connect 2 wires (8) at 2 condenser motors (11) and ground
wire at left condenser motor.
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
10-123
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
Equipment Condition
• Air conditioner cover assembly removed. (See paragraph 10-33)
a. REMOVAL
5. Remove screw and starwasher, and remove 2 ground wires and capacitor (12) from insulated
cover (4).
TA50026
10-124
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
9. Remove bolt (9) and starwasher (10), and bend back clamp (11).
10. Aline setscrew at 1 wheel (16) with access hole in housing (14). Loosen setscrew.
11. Remove 1 wheel (16) with attached evaporator motor (6) from housing (14). Remove
remaining wheel from housing.
12. Loosen setscrew and remove attached wheel (16) from evaporator motor (6).
b. INSTALLATION
NOTE
4. Position evaporator motor (6) with attached wheel (16) in housing (14) and install to other
wheel with setscrew.
6. Install evaporator motor (6) to clamp (11) with starwasher (10) and bolt (9). Ensure that 2
wires from evaporator motor are fed straight through grommet (7) in insulated cover (4).
7. Check to see that 2 wheels (16) turn freely inside housing (14). If adjustment is needed,
loosen bolt (9), adjust, and tighten.
8. Install blower resistor (18) with 2 washers (19) and screws (1).
NOTE
When connecting wires, ensure that they are routed through side slot in
insulated cover (4) and installed to wiring harness clip (15).
11. Install 2 ground wires and capacitor (12) to insulated cover (4) with screw and starwasher.
10-125
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
13. Install insulated covers (2 and 4) with 12 screws (3). Ensure that wiring harness is not crimped.
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
TA50027
10-126
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
Tools/Test Equipment
• 90 degree angle drill
• 3/16 in. drill bit
a. REMOVAL
NOTE
2. Remove 2 pushnuts (4). Remove 2 screws (5) and clamps (3) from heater base (1).
Disconnect 2 cables (2) from vent door control levers (6).
TA50028
10-127
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
3. Disconnect wiring harness (15) from control box (11). Disconnect control box wire assembly
from blower motor lead.
4. Loosen clamp (8) and disconnect duct hose (9) from weldment (7). Loosen clamp (17) and
disconnect flex hose (16) from weldment. Remove 4 screws (13) from adapter (14). Remove
adapter and flex hose assembly from personnel heater (12).
5. Using 90 degree angle drill, remove 8 pop rivets (10). Remove control box (11) and clean old
sealant from mating surfaces. Discard pop rivets.
b. INSTALLATION
1. Apply RTV sealant to inside flange of control box (11). Install control box with 8 new pop rivets
(10).
2. Install adapter (14) and flex hose (16) assembly on personnel heater (12) with 4 screws (13).
Connect flex hose to weldment (7) and tighten clamp (17). Connect duct hose (9) to
weldment and tighten clamp (8).
3. Connect control box (11) wire assembly to blower motor lead. Connect wiring harness (15) to
control box.
TA50029
10-128
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
TA50030
10-129
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
a. REMOVAL
WARNING
NOTE
NOTE
Use suitable container to catch fuel when disconnecting hose (5) and
disassembling fuel filter assembly.
2. Disconnect hose (5) from personnel heater. Loosen fitting (3) and remove hose from fuel filter
body (2) .
3. Loosen clamp (10) and disconnect flex hose (11) from adapter (8). Remove 4 screws (7) and
adapter.
10-130
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
4. Disconnect wiring harness (9) from personnel heater (1). Unscrew 2 clamps (6) and open
completely.
TA50031
10-131
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
NOTE
TA50032
10-132
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
b. INSTALLATION
NOTE
If installing blower motor (24), perform steps 1, 3 through 8, and
HEATER BLEEDING steps.
1. Install plate (26) and blower wheel (27) on blower motor (24) with nut (28). Install blower
motor assembly by securing plate to heater base (4) with 3 screws (25). Connect lead (29) to
control box wire assembly (30). Connect ground lead (23).
2. Fill casing (22) ¼ full of fuel oil. Install new filter element (21) in casing and new filter seal (20)
on fuel filter body (2). Screw casing onto fuel filter body. Install fuel filter assembly with 2
washers (19) and screws (18). Connect hose to “IN” side of fuel filter body and open shutoff
valve under truck.
TA50033
10-133
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
7. Connect hose (5) to fuel filter body (2) and tighten fitting (3).
TA50034
10-134
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
c. HEATER BLEEDING
WARNING
Use suitable container to catch fuel from hose (5) and bleed port (31).
2. Hold personnel heater switch in “START” position. Continue operation until a clean, steady
flow of fuel is obtained, then shut off personnel heater. Connect hose (5) to personnel heater
(1).
3. Connect wiring h a r n e s s ( 9 ) t o
personnel heater (1).
TA50035
10-135/(10-136 blank)
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
CHAPTER 11
SPECIAL PURPOSE KITS MAINTENANCE
INITIAL SETUP:
a. DISASSEMBLY
NOTE
• DISASSEMBLY steps given are for one section of right side troop seat.
All other sections are disassembled the same way.
11-1
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
2. Remove 6 nuts (5) and bolts (6), and 3 seatback slats (7).
3. Remove screw (10) and detent pin (11) from bottom of slat (13) closest to support assembly
(8). Remove 8 nuts (15), washers (14), bolts (12), and 4 slats (13).
4. Remove 2 locknuts (19), bolts (20), and 2 legs (17 or 18) from 2 troop seat frames (16).
Discard locknuts.
5. Remove 2 cotter pins (21), clevis pins (22), and 2 troop seat frames (16) from support
assembly (8). Discard cotter pins.
6. Remove 3 retaining pins (4) from pin holes of 2 clamps (1) and clamp (9). If damaged,
remove 3 screws (2) and lanyards (3) from support assembly (8), Remove 3 retaining pins
from lanyards if damaged.
7. Remove 2 clamps (1) and clamp (9) from support assembly (8) and from 3 truck stake
pockets.
8. With the help of an assistant, remove support assembly (8) from truck.
b. ASSEMBLY
NOTE
• ASSEMBLY steps given are for one section of right side troop seat. All
other sections are assembled the same way.
• If installing support assembly (8) in truck, perform steps 1-4, and 10.
1. With the help of an assistant, install support assembly (8) to top of side rail with supports in 3
truck stake pockets.
2. Install front and middle clamps (1) in 2 stake pockets with clamps hooked over support
assembly (8) and clamp plugs through holes provided in support assembly.
3. Install rear clamp (9) in rear stake pocket with clamp hooked over support assembly (8) and
clamp plug through hole in side of support assembly. Apply pressure as required to install
clamp plug.
4. If removed, install 3 lanyards (3) to support assembly (8) with 3 screws (2). If removed, install
3 retaining pins (4) to lanyards. Install retaining pins through pin holes of 2 clamps (1) and
clamp (9).
5. Install 2 troop seat frames (16) to support assembly (8) with 2 clevis pins (22) and 2 new
cotter pins (21).
NOTE
6. Install 2 legs (17 or 18) to 2 troop seat frames (16) with 2 bolts (20) and new locknuts (19).
7. Install 4 slats (13) to 2 troop seat frames (16) with 8 bolts (12), washers (14), and nuts (15).
11-2
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
8. Install detent pin (11) at underside of slat (13) closest to support assembly (8) with screw
(10).
9. Install 3 seatback slats (7) with 6 bolts (6) and nuts (5).
11-3/(11-4 blank)
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
Paragraph Page
Number Procedures Number
11-5
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
a. REMOVAL
NOTE
Tag leads for installation.
NOTE
If removing heater control panel (1) assembly, tag and disconnect all
leads.
2. Remove 2 screws (10). Pull heater control panel (1) assembly away from housing.
b. DISASSEMBLY
NOTE
Each DISASSEMBLY step can be performed separately from other
DISASSEMBLY steps. Perform only as required.
1. Disconnect lead from back of indicator light (2). Remove nut from back of indicator light and
remove indicator light.
2. Remove 2 screws (3). Disconnect leads and remove circuit breaker (4). Repeat for other
circuit breaker as required.
3. Disconnect lead from back of indicator light (9). Remove nut and washer from back of
indicator light, and remove indicator light.
4. Remove nut (6, 7, or 11). Disconnect leads and remove toggle switch (5, 8, or 12).
5. On underside of heater control panel (1), remove 4 nuts (17), Iockwashers (16), and screws
(19). Remove receptacle connector (14), Repeat for other receptacle connector as required.
Remove grommet (18) as required. Discard Iockwashers.
11-6
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
NOTE
Each ASSEMBLY step can be performed separately from other ASSEMBLY
steps. Perform only as required.
11-7
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
4. Install circuit breaker (4) through heater control panel (1) hole with 2 screws (3). Connect
leads to back of circuit breaker. Repeat for other circuit breaker if removed.
5. Install indicator light (2) through heater control panel (1) hole with nut. Connect lead to back of
indicator light.
d. INSTALLATION
1. Connect all leads if not connected during ASSEMBLY. Install heater control panel (1) assembly
on housing with 2 screws (10).
2. Connect plug (15). Connect 2 wiring harness cables (13) to receptacle connectors (14).
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
TA50038
11-8
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
Tools/Test Equipment
• Torque wrench
a. REMOVAL
NOTE
If removing heater control panel housing, perform steps 1-3.
1. Loosen nut on clip (6). Remove push-on nut (5) and disconnect control cable (2) from diverter
assembly (1). Pull control cable through clip.
2. Loosen retaining strap (3) and pull control cable (2) through retaining strap. Connect guide
wire to end of control cable to assist in installation.
TA50039
11-9
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
b. INSTALLATION
NOTE
1. Install mounting nuts (13) if removed. Install mounting bracket (8) on instrument panel (12)
with 4 bolts (14) and washers (15). Tighten bolts to 50-65 lb.-in. (6–7 N•m).
2. Connect guide wire to end of control cable (2). Pull control cable through grommet (4) with
guide wire, Install heater control panel housing (9) on mounting bracket (8) with 3 screws (7),
new Iockwashers (10), and nuts (11).
TA50040
11-10
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
3. Remove guide wire from end of control cable (2). Guide control cable through retaining strap
(3) .
4. Guide control cable (2) through clip (6). Connect control cable to diverter assembly (1) and
install push-on nut (5). Tighten nut on clip. Tighten retaining strap (3).
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
TA50041
11-11
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
Tools/Test Equipment
• Torque wrench
a. REMOVAL
NOTE
• If removing hood or radiator insulators (3 or 8), perform steps 1 or 2.
1. Pry 24 retainers (2) from hood inner panel (4). Remove hood insulator (3) from hood (1).
2. From underneath bumper, disconnect and remove 3 springs (5) from insulator loops (7) and
radiator support (6). Remove 2 turnbutton studs (9), Unsnap radiator insulator (8) from top of
grille, and remove.
TA50042
11-12
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
NOTE
Remove jack, handle, and wheel wrench from all trucks except M1009.
3. Remove front seats and seatbelt floor mounting. (See paragraph 10-18, 10-23, or 10-25)
Remove transfer case bezel and boot (see paragraph 5-4) or transfer case plate and boot
(see paragraph 5-3).
TA50043
11-13
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
NOTE
M1009 sill plates (15) are fiat and use 6 vertically-removed mounting
screws (13).
6. Pry 2 retainers (12) from bulkhead (16). Remove floor mat (14). Remove front cab floor
insulator (18) and rear cab floor insulator (17).
b. INSTALLATION
NOTE
1. Install rear cab floor insulator (17) and front cab floor insulator (18). Install floor mat (14) on
bulkhead (16) with 2 retainers (12).
TA50044
11-14
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
NOTE
M1009 sill plates (15) are flat and use 6 vertically-installed mounting
screws (13).
5. Snap radiator insulator (8) to top of grille. Install 2 turnbutton studs (9). From underneath
bumper, connect 3 springs (5) to insulator loops (7) and radiator support (6).
TA50045
11-15
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
6. Position hood insulator (3) on hood (1). Install 24 retainers (2) by pressing firmly into hood
inner panel (4) holes.
TA50046
11-16
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
Personnel Required
• MOS 63B (2)
NOTE
• If removing front battery box (1), perform step 1.
1. Remove 2 bolts (9). Remove 2 bolts (2) from bracket (3) and bolt (5) from fender nut (4).
Remove front battery box (1).
TA50047
11-17
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
NOTE
All except M1010 use 1 locknut (13), Iockwasher (14), bolt (10), washer
(11), and clip (21) each for inlet and outlet heater hoses (12). M1010 uses
2 each for inlet and outlet heater hoses,
2. Remove locknut(s) (13), Iockwasher(s) (14), bolt(s) (10), and washer(s) (11) from each
heater hose (12) clip. Discard locknuts and Iockwashers.
NOTE
Perform step 4, if necessary, to
prevent damage to engine fuel
filter.
TA50048
11-18
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
TA50049
11-19
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
b. INSTALLATION
NOTE
TA50050
11-20
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
TA50051
11-21
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
NOTE
All except M1010 use 1 locknut (13), Iockwasher (14), bolt (10), washer
(11), and clip each for inlet and outlet heater hoses (12). M1010 uses 2
each for inlet and outlet heater hoses.
7. Position each heater hose (12) clip and install with washer(s) (11), bolt(s) (10), new
lockwasher(s) (14), and new locknut (s) (13).
8. Position front battery box (1). Loosely install 2 bolts (9). Install bolt (5) on fender nut (4) and 2
bolts (2) on bracket (3). Tighten all bolts (9).
TA50052
11-22
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
TA50053
11-23
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
a. REMOVAL
WARNING
NOTE
TA50054
11-24
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
4. Loosen fitting (13) and disconnect fuel line (12) from tee (14). Remove fuel line. Loosen fitting
(10) and disconnect fuel line (11) from cab heater (9). Remove fuel line. Remove connector
(21) as required.
NOTE
• If installing fuel lines (11 or 12), perform steps 1, 2, and 4.
TA50055
11-25
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
4. Connect fuel line (11) to fuel filter (2) by tightening fitting (8). Connect fuel line (12) to fuel
filter by tightening fitting (15).
c. HEATER BLEEDING
WARNING
NOTE
Use suitable container to catch fuel from fuel line (11) and bleed port
(23).
2. Loosen 2 screws (24) and remove cover (22), Open shutoff valve (6). Disconnect wiring
harness assembly from cab heater (9).
TA50056
11-26
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
5. Connect plastic tube to bleed port (23). Open bleed port. Hold cab heater switch in “START”
position. Continue operation until a clean, steady flow of fuel is obtained, then shut off cab
heater. Close bleed port and remove plastic tube.
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
11-27
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
a. REMOVAL
NOTE
• If removing diverter (8), perform steps 1-3.
1. Remove cab heater (2) cover and disconnect wiring harness assembly (1). Loosen clamp (5)
and disconnect blower inlet hose (4), Loosen clamp (7) and disconnect diverter hose (6).
Unscrew clamps (3) and completely open. Loosen clamp (9) and disconnect exhaust pipe
(10).
TA50058
11-28
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
TA50059
11-29
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
5. Remove heater clamp (21) from clamp bracket (20). Remove 2 bolts (19), washers (18), and
clamp bracket. Remove 2 nuts (22), Iockwashers (23), bolts (26), and washers (25). Remove
heater bracket (24). Discard lockwashers.
b. INSTALLATION
NOTE
TA50060
11-30
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
TA50061
11-31
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
7. Connect diverter hose (6) and tighten clamp (7). Connect blower inlet hose (4) and tighten
clamp (5). Connect wiring harness assembly (1) to cab heater (2). Tighten clamps (3)
securely. Install cab heater cover.
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
11-32
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
a. REMOVAL
NOTE
• If removing hoses (1 or 5), perform step 1.
• If removing blower motor, perform steps 2, 3, and 6 through 8.
1. Loosen clamps (2 and 4) and disconnect hoses (1 and 5) from blower motor assembly (3).
TA50063
11-33
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
2. Disconnect and remove lead (6) and lead assembly (8) from resistor (13) and harness plug
(9) .
3. Remove 2 screws (7) and resistor (13). Clean old sealant from resistor and blower motor
assembly (3).
4, Disconnect lead (6) from capacitor (14), Unplug capacitor from blower motor assembly (3).
Remove screw and capacitor.
5. Remove 3 screws (12). Remove 2 nuts (10) from studs (11) and remove blower motor
assembly (3).
6. Disconnect and remove pipe (21) from pipe (16) and blower motor (19). Remove screw (15)
and pipe (16).
7. Remove 5 screws (20) and blower motor (19) from blower motor case (17), Clean old sealant
from blower motor and blower motor case.
8. Remove nut holding fan (18) to blower motor (19), and remove fan as required.
TA50064
11-34
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
b. INSTALLATION
NOTE
• If installing blower motor (19), perform steps 1-3, 5, and 7.
• If installing hoses (1 or 5), perform step 8.
2. Apply sealant to mating surfaces of blower motor (19) and blower motor case (17). Install
blower motor on blower motor case with 5 screws (20).
3. Install pipe (16) with screw (15). Connect pipe (21) to blower motor (19) and pipe (16).
4. Position blower motor assembly (3). Install 2 nuts (10) on studs (11). Install 3 screws (12).
5. Apply sealant to mating surfaces of blower motor assembly (3) and resistor (13). Install
resistor with 2 screws (7).
6. Connect lead (6) to capacitor (14). Install capacitor to blower motor assembly (3) with screw,
Plug capacitor into blower motor assembly.
7. Connect lead assembly (8) to resistor (13) and harness plug (9).
TA50065
11-35
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
8. Connect hoses (1 and 5) to blower motor assembly (3), and tighten clamps (2 and 4).
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
TA50066
11-36
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
a. REMOVAL
NOTE
If removing relay (2), perform step 2.
1. Disconnect wiring harness (1) cable from cab heater control panel assembly (6). Remove 2
nuts (8) and disconnect wiring harness leads from safety switch (9). Remove screw (3),
washer (4), and clip (5). Loosen nut on strap (7) and disconnect wiring harness.
2. Unsnap relay (2) and wiring harness (1) connector from bracket (10). Unplug relay (2) from
wiring harness connector.
TA50067
11-37
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
4. Disconnect wiring harness (1) from cab heater (13) and diverter switch (19). Cut and discard
straps securing wiring harness.
5. Loosen 2 nuts (15) and remove positive accessory wiring terminal board (16)
. . cover. Remove
nut and Iockwasher from positive accessory wiring terminal board stud, and disconnect wiring
harness (1) lead. Repeat for negative accessory wiring terminal board (14). Discard
Iockwashers.
TA50068
11-38
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
NOTE
7. Disconnect wiring harness (1) at switch connector (21) and engine coolant heater connector
(22). Cut and discard all straps securing wiring harness to fuel lines (20). Carefully pull wiring
harness through grommet (17) into engine compartment and remove.
b. INSTALLATION
NOTE
1. Position wiring harness (1) in engine compartment. Carefully push wiring harness through
grommet (17) up to white band on wiring harness. Connect wiring harness at switch connector
(21) and engine coolant heater connector (22). Route wiring harness along fuel lines (20) and
install new straps,
TA50069
11-39
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
NOTE
Step 2 only applies to trucks equipped with cargo compartment heater.
3. Connect wiring harness (1) lead to positive accessory wiring terminal board (16) stud and
install new Iockwasher and nut. Install positive accessory wiring terminal board cover and
tighten 2 nuts (15). Repeat for negative accessory wiring terminal board (14).
TA50070
11-40
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
6. Plug relay (2) into wiring harness (1) connector. Snap relay and wiring harness connector onto
bracket (10).
7. Position wiring harness (1) in strap (7) and tighten nut. Install clip (5) on wiring harness and
install with screw (3) and washer (4). Connect 2 wiring harness leads to safety switch (9) and
install 2 nuts (8). Connect wiring harness cable to cab heater control panel assembly (6).
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
TA50071
11-41
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
WARNING
NOTE
1. Loosen clamp (7) and disconnect front exhaust pipe (4) from cab heater (1). Remove 2 nuts
(3) from rear battery box (2).
2. Loosen clamp (5) and disconnect front exhaust pipe (4) from rear exhaust pipe (6) . Remove
front exhaust pipe as required.
TA50072
11-42
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
NOTE
M1009 uses 2 clamps (11) and M1010 uses 11 clamps, All other models
use 4 clamps. Note position of clamps for installation.
3. Remove locknut (10) and screw (12) from each clamp (11). Remove each clamp from rear
exhaust pipe (6) and engine exhaust pipe (8). Remove rear exhaust pipe (M1010 only).
Discard locknuts.
TA50073
11-43
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
NOTE
4. Remove locknut (10), washer (16), clip (15), and screw (14) from frame (9) and rear exhaust
pipe (6). Remove screw (7) from fender (13), and remove rear exhaust pipe. Discard locknut.
TA50074
11-44
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
b. INSTALLATION
NOTE
• If installing rear exhaust pipe (6), perform steps 1, 2, and 4.
1. Install rear exhaust pipe (6) on fender (13) with screw (17). Install on frame (9) with screw
(14), clip (15), washer (16), and new locknut (10).
NOTE
Install M1009 rear exhaust pipe
(6) on top of engine exhaust
pipe (8). install all others below
engine exhaust pipe.
TA50075
11-45
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
3. Connect front exhaust pipe (4) to rear exhaust pipe (6) and tighten clamp (5).
4. Position front exhaust pipe (4) studs through rear battery box (2) holes and install 2 nuts (3).
Connect front exhaust pipe to cab heater (1) and tighten clamp (7).
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
TA50076
11-46
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
Equipment Condition
• Rear battery box removed. (See paragraph 11-6)
NOTE
1. Loosen clamp (2) and disconnect engine coolant heater hose (3) from pipe assembly (6).
Loosen clamps (8) and disconnect hose (1) from pipe assembly and radiator (7).
TA50077
11-47
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
NOTE
4. Loosen clamp (22) and disconnect inlet hose (23) from crossover pipe (24). Loosen clamp
(18) and disconnect inlet hose (17) from lower heater core tube (16). Remove inlet hose
assembly.
5. Loosen clamp (21) and disconnect inlet hose (23) from tube (20). Loosen clamp (19) and
disconnect tube from inlet hose (17). Remove clamp(s) (15).
TA50078
11-48
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
b. INSTALLATION
NOTE
• If installing outlet hose (11) components, perform steps 3-5.
• If installing inlet hose (17) components, perform steps 1 and 2.
1. Install clamp(s) (15) on inlet hose (23). Connect tube (20) to inlet hose (17) and tighten clamp
(19). Connect inlet hose to tube and tighten clamp (21).
TA50079
11-49
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
2. Connect inlet hose (17) to lower heater core tube (16) and tighten clamp (18). Connect inlet
hose (23) to crossover pipe (24) and tighten clamp (22).
3. Install clamp(s) (15) on outlet hose (4). Connect tube (13) to outlet hose (11) and tighten
clamp (12). Connect outlet hose (4) to tube and tighten clamp (14). Connect pipe assembly
(6) to outlet hose (4) and tighten clamp (5).
TA50080
11-50
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
5. Connect hose (1) to radiator (7) and pipe assembly (6), and tighten clamps (8). Connect
engine coolant heater hose (3) to pipe assembly and tighten clamp (2).
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
11-51/(11-52 blank)
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
Paragraph Page
Number Procedures Number
11-14. Engine Coolant Heater Fuel Filter and Lines Replacement . . . . . . . 11-54
11-15. Engine Coolant Heater Hoses and Fittings Replacement ... . .. . . .... 11-57
11-16. Engine Coolant Heater Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-60
11-17. Engine Coolant Heater Wiring Harness Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . 11-62
11-18. Engine Coolant Heater Exhaust Pipe Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-64
11-53
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
a. REMOVAL
WARNING
NOTE
TA50082
11-54
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
11-14. ENGINE COOLANT HEATER FUEL FILTER AND LINES REPLACEMENT (Con’t).
4. Loosen fitting (12) and disconnect pipe (13) from heater fuel pump tee (11). Remove pipe
(13). Loosen fitting (18) and disconnect pipe (20) from pipe (16) as required. Loosen fitting
(8) and disconnect pipe (20) from adapter (9). Remove adapter from engine coolant heater
(10) as required.
b. INSTALLATION
NOTE
• If installing fuel lines, perform steps 1, 2, and 4.
• If installing fuel filter (3), perform steps 3 and 4.
• Apply pipe sealant to all pipe threads before installation.
1. Install adapter (9) on engine coolant heater (10) if removed. Connect pipe (20) to adapter, but
DO NOT tighten fitting (8). Connect pipe (20) to pipe (16) and tighten fitting (18) if
disconnected. Position pipe (13) and connect to heater fuel pump tee (11) by tightening fitting
(12).
2. Install clamp (19) on pipe (20) and install on stud (17) with new Iockwasher (21) and nut (22).
3. Install adapter (5), coupling (2), and fuel shutoff valve (1) on fuel filter (3). Install spacer (4)
and fuel filter assembly with 2 washers (6) and screws (7).
4. Connect pipe (13) to fuel filter (3) and tighten fitting (14). Connect pipe (16) to fuel filter and
tighten fitting (15).
TA50083
11-55
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
11-14. ENGINE COOLANT HEATER FUEL FILTER AND LINES REPLACEMENT (Con’t).
c. HEATER BLEEDING
WARNING
1. Bleed engine coolant heater (10) the same way as cab heater, except that pipe plug must be
removed to open bleed valve. (See paragraph 11-7)
2. Ensure that fitting (8) is tightened on adapter (9) and pipe plug is installed after bleeding is
completed.
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
TA50084
11-56
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
Materials/Parts
• Pipe sealant (Item 43, Appendix C)
a. REMOVAL
NOTE
1. Remove bolt and clamp (5) from alternator bracket (20), inlet hose (7), and outlet hose (6).
Remove nut (22), washer (21), bolt (1), and clamp (2) from outlet hose.
TA50085
11-57
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
2. Disconnect coupling half (10) from coupling half (11). Disconnect coupling half (16) from
coupling half (15).
3. Loosen clamp (4) and disconnect inlet hose (7) from crossover pipe (3). Loosen clamp (23)
and disconnect outlet hose (6) from pipe assembly (24). Remove inlet hose and outlet hose.
4. Disconnect coupling half (10) from adapter (9). Loosen clamp (8) and disconnect adapter (9)
from outlet hose (6). Disconnect coupling half (16) from adapter (17). Loosen clamp (18) and
disconnect adapter (17) from inlet hose (7).
5. Disconnect electrical connector from heater thermostat (14). Remove coupling half (15).
Remove heater thermostat from engine coolant heater (19). Remove coupling half (11) and
elbow (12). Remove pipe nipple (13) from engine coolant heater.
TA50086
11-58
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
b. INSTALLATION
NOTE
• If installing fittings, perform steps 1, 2, and 4.
• If installing hoses, perform steps 3-5 as required.
1. Apply pipe sealant to pipe nipple (13) threads and install on engine coolant heater (19). Apply
pipe sealant to elbow (12) and coupling half (11) threads and install. Install heater thermostat
(14) on engine coolant heater. Apply pipe sealant to coupling half (15) threads and install.
Connect electrical connector to heater thermostat.
2. Connect adapter (17) to inlet hose (7) and tighten clamp (18). Apply pipe sealant to coupling
half (16) threads and connect to adapter (17). Connect adapter (9) to outlet hose (6) and
tighten clamp (8), Apply pipe sealant to coupling half (10) threads and connect to adapter
(9) .
3. Connect outlet hose (6) to pipe assembly (24) and tighten clamp (23). Connect inlet hose (7)
to crossover pipe (3) and tighten clamp (4).
4. Apply pipe sealant to coupling half (16) threads and connect to coupling half (15). Apply pipe
sealant to coupling half (10) threads and connect to coupling half (11).
NOTE
5. Install clamp (2) on outlet hose (6). Install clamp (2) with bolt (1), washer (21), and nut (22).
Install clamp (5) on outlet hose and inlet hose (7). Install clamp (5) on alternator bracket (20)
with bolt.
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
11-59
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
a. REMOVAL
NOTE
If removing engine coolant heater (1), perform step 1.
TA50087
11-60
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
b. INSTALLATION
NOTE
If installing engine coolant heater (1), perform step 2.
1. Install heater bracket (14) on fender with 2 washers (11), bolts (10), new Iockwashers (12),
and nuts (13). Install 2 mounts (15) on heater bracket with 2 new Iockwashers (8) and nuts
(9). Install clamp bracket (16) on mounts with 2 new Iockwashers (7) and nuts (6). Install
heater clamp (4) through clamp bracket.
2. Position engine coolant heater (1), Connect exhaust pipe (3) and tighten clamp (2). Install 2
clamps (4) around engine coolant heater and tighten securely. Connect wiring harness
assembly (5). Install engine coolant heater cover.
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
• Install engine coolant heater fittings, (See paragraph 11-15)
• Connect engine coolant heater fuel lines. (See paragraph 11-14)
TA50088
11-61
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
a. REMOVAL
NOTE
• If removing relay (10), perform step 3.
Ž Tag all leads and connectors for installation.
2. Disconnect wiring harness (2) from cab heater control panel assembly (8). Loosen nut on
strap (9) and disconnect wiring harness.
4. Remove wiring harness (2) and grommet (3) from bulkhead. Retain grommet for installation if
not damaged.
TA50089
11-62
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
b. INSTALLATION
NOTE
If installing relay (10), perform step 2.
1. Install grommet (3) on wiring harness (2). Position wiring harness in cab. Push wiring harness
through bulkhead.
2. Plug relay (10) into wiring harness (2) and connect to mount.
3. Position wiring harness (2) in strap (9) and tighten nut. Connect wiring harness to cab heater
control panel assembly (8).
4. Connect wiring harness connector (6) to cab heater connector (7). Connect wiring harness (2)
to engine coolant heater (1). Install engine coolant heater cover. Connect wiring harness
connector (5) to engine coolant heater thermostat (4). Install new tie-down straps to wiring
harness.
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
TA50090
11-63
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
a. REMOVAL
WARNING
NOTE
1. Loosen clamp (2) and disconnect front exhaust pipe (7) from engine coolant heater (1).
Remove nut (3) and clip (4) to free front exhaust pipe. Remove screw (6) and bracket (5) as
required.
TA50091
11-64
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
2. Loosen clamp (8) and remove front exhaust pipe (7) from engine oil pan (9).
3. Remove 4 screws (10) and remove heat exchange pipe (12) from engine oil pan (9) and
transmission oil pan (11).
4. Loosen clamp (22) and disconnect rear exhaust pipe (21) from transmission oil pan (11).
TA50092
11-65
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
NOTE
NOTE
6. Remove locknut (18), washer (19), clip (20), and screw (13). Remove locknut (17), washer
(16), and screw (14) from rear quarter panel (15). Remove rear exhaust pipe (21), Discard
locknuts.
NOTE
7. Remove locknut (27), clip (23), and screw (24). Remove screw (26) from rear quarter panel
(25). Remove rear exhaust pipe (21). Discard locknut.
b. INSTALLATION
NOTE
1. Install rear exhaust pipe (21) on rear quarter panel (25) with screw (26). Install clip (23) on
rear exhaust pipe with screw (24) and new locknut (27).
NOTE
2. Install rear exhaust pipe (21) on rear quarter panel (15) with screw (14), washer (16), and new
locknut (17), Install clip (20) on rear exhaust pipe with screw (13), washer (19), and new
locknut (18).
TA50093
11-66
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
NOTE
M1009 uses 2 clamps (29), all others use 3 clamps.
3. Position rear exhaust pipe (21) along engine exhaust pipe (28). Install each clamp (29) around
rear exhaust pipe and engine exhaust pipe with screw (30) and new locknut (31). Connect rear
exhaust pipe to transmission oil pan (11) and tighten clamp (22).
TA500i94
11-67
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
4. Install heat exchange pipe (12) to transmission oil pan (11) and engine oil pan (9) with 4
screws (10).
5. Connect front exhaust pipe (7) to engine oil pan (9) and tighten clamp (8).
6. Install bracket (5) with screw (6) if removed, Install clip (3) on front exhaust pipe (7) with nut
(3), Connect front exhaust pipe to engine coolant heater (1) and tighten clamp (2).
TA50095
11-68
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
Paragraph Page
Number Procedures Number
11-69
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
a. REMOVAL
NOTE
• If removing control box (7), perform steps 1 and 2.
• If removing lead (4), perform steps 1-3 as required.
2. Disconnect lead (4) from control box (7). Disconnect control box plug from heater wiring
harness. Remove 2 nuts (3) and control box.
NOTE
3. Remove 2 screws, washers, and clamps from lead (4), Disconnect lead from cargo
compartment heater (6).
4. Remove 2 locknuts (14), washers (13), and bolts (8). Remove upper bracket (5). Discard
locknuts.
TA50096
11-70
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
5. Remove 2 locknuts (9), washers (10), and bolts (11). Remove lower bracket (12). Discard
locknuts.
b. INSTALLATION
NOTE
• If installing iead (4), perform steps 2-4 as required.
• If installing control box (7), perform steps 3 and 4.
1. Install lower bracket (12) on cargo compartment heater (6) bracket with 2 bolts (11), washers
(10), and new locknuts (9). Install upper bracket (5) on lower bracket with 2 bolts (8), washers
(13), and new locknuts (14).
2. Connect iead (4) to cargo compartment heater (6). install 2 clamps on lead. Install clamps on
cargo compartment heater with 2 washers and screws.
3. Install control box (7) on upper bracket (5) with 2 nuts (3). Connect lead (4) to control box.
Connect control box plug to heater wiring harness.
4. Install heater shieid (1) over cargo compartment heater (6) and lock 2 catches (2) in place.
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
11-71
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
Equipment Condition Materials/Parts
• Heater shield, control box, and lead removed. • Seven locknuts
(See paragraph 11-20) • One gasket
• Communications rack mounting hardware • T WO cotter pins
and ground strap removed (M1008A1 only). • RTV sealant (Item 41, Appendix C)
(See paragraph 4-48)
Personnel Required General Safety Instructions
• MOS 63B (2) • DO NOT perform this procedure near
fire, flames, or sparks.
a. R E M O V A L
WARNING
1. Close fuel shutoff valve (2). Loosen fitting (1) and disconnect fuel line.
2. Loosen clamp (4), disconnect air duct hose (3) from ventilator (6), and move air duct hose
out of the way.
TA50098
11-72
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
NOTE
• Assistance is required to
perform steps 4 and 5.
TA50099
11-73
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
b. DISASSEMBLY
NOTE
1. Loosen setscrew (31) and disconnect control lever (28) from. rod (32). Remove cotter pin
(14), washer (15), and spring (16). Remove rod from ventilator (6). Discard cotter pin.
TA50100
11-74
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
2. Remove 2 screws (30) and bracket (29). Remove 4 screws (27) and outlet adapter (22).
3. Loosen fitting (41) and disconnect fuel pipe (38) from adapter (42). Remove 2 locknuts (39),
4 washers (40), and 2 screws (43). Remove fuel filter (35) assembly and spacer (36).
Remove fuel shutoff valve (2), elbow (34), and adapter. Discard locknuts.
4. Loosen fitting (37) and disconnect fuel pipe (38) from heater (5).
5. Remove locknut (25), washer (26), and screw (33). Remove bolt (17) and clamp (18).
Remove ventilator (6) from heater (5). Remove 3 screws (19) and inlet adapter (20) if
damaged. Discard locknut.
6. Unscrew 2 clamps (23) and open completely. Remove heater (5) and gasket (21) from
mounting plate (24). Remove clamps if damaged. Discard gasket.
TA50101
11-75
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
c. ASSEMBLY
NOTE
1. Install 2 clamps (23) on mounting plate (24) if removed. Install new gasket (21) on heater (5)
and position heater on mounting plate. Tighten clamps around heater.
TA50102
11-76
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
2. Install inlet adapter (20) on heater (5) with 3 screws (19) if removed. Install ventilator (6) on
heater with clamp (18) and bolt (17). Install screw (33), washer (26), and new locknut (25).
3. Connect fuel pipe (38) to heater (5) and tighten fitting (37).
4. Install adapter (42), elbow (34), and fuel shutoff valve (2). Install spacer (36) and fuel filter
(35) assembly with 2 screws (43), 4 washers (40), and 2 new locknuts (39). Connect fuel pipe
(38) to adapter and tighten fitting (41).
5. Install outlet adapter (22) with 4 screws (27), Install bracket (29) with 2 screws (30).
6. Install rod (32) in ventilator (6) with spring (16), washer (15), and new cotter pin (14).
Connect control lever (28) to rod and tighten setscrew (31).
d. INSTALLATION
TA50103
11-77
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
NOTE
CAUTION
NOTE
TA50104
11-78
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
5. Connect air duct hose (3) to ventilator (6) and tighten clamp (4).
6. Connect fuel line to fuel shutoff valve (2) and tighten fitting (1).
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
Install communications rack mounting hardware and ground strap if removed. (See
paragraph 4-48)
Install heater control box, lead, and shield. (See paragraph 11-20)
Bleed heater. (See paragraph 11-22)
TA50105
11-79
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
a. REMOVAL
WARNING
NOTE
1. Loosen fitting (21) and disconnect fuel pipe (12) from fuel hose assembly (24).
2. Loosen fitting (14) and disconnect fuel pipe (12) from tee (13). Remove bolt (17) and clamp
(16) from coolant heater fuel line (15) and fuel pipe.
3. Remove bolt (19) and clamp (18) from frame (2). Remove nut (20) as required. Remove fuel
pipe (12).
4. Remove 2 nuts (6), Iockwashers (7), and screw (11) from clamp (23), clamp (8), and clamp
(10). Separate wiring harness (22), fuel hose assembly (24), and brake line (9) from frame
(2). Remove clamp (8). Discard Iockwashers.
5. Remove 2 nuts (5), Iockwashers (4), screws (25), and clamps (3). Loosen fitting (26) and
disconnect fuel hose assembly (24) from fuel hose assembly (27). Remove fuel hose
assembly (24). Discard Iockwashers.
11-80
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
TA50106
11-81
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
b. INSTALLATION
NOTE
2. Position fuel hose assembly (24) along frame (2). Connect fuel hose assembly (27) to fuel
hose assembly (24) and tighten fitting (26). Install 2 clamps (3) on fuel hose assembly (24)
and install on frame with 2 screws (25), new Iockwashers (4), and nuts (5).
3. Install clamp (8) on fuel hose assembly (24). Position brake line (9), fuel hose assembly, and
wiring harness (22). Install screw (11) through clamp (10) and clamp (8). Install new
Iockwasher (7) and nut (6). Install clamp (23) with new Iockwasher and nut.
4. Route fuel pipe (12) along bulkhead. Connect fuel pipe (12) to fuel hose assembly (24) and
tighten fitting (21). Connect fuel pipe (12) to tee (13) and tighten fitting (14).
5. Install nut (20) if removed. Install clamp (18) on fuel pipe (12). Install clamp on frame (2) with
bolt (19).
6. Install clamp (16) on fuel pipe (12) and coolant heater fuel line (15). Install clamp with bolt
(17).
TA50107
11-82
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
c. HEATER BLEEDING
WARNING
11-83
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
2. Open 2 catches and remove heater shield, (See paragraph 11-20, REMOVAL, step 1) Loosen
2 screws (33) and remove cover (31). Open fuel shutoff valve (1). Disconnect lead from
heater.
6. Position cover (31) and tighten 2 screws (33). Install heater shield over heater and lock 2
catches in place. (See paragraph 11-20, INSTALLATION, step 4)
TA50109
11-84
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
a. REMOVAL
NOTE
• If removing wiring harness (1) from M1008, perform steps 1-4.
• If removing wiring harness from M1008A1, perform steps 5-7.
• Tag all leads and connectors for installation.
1. Loosen 2 nuts (6) and remove positive accessory wiring terminal board cover (5). Remove nut
and lockwasher from positive accessory wiring terminal board stud, and disconnect wiring
harness (1) lead. Repeat for negative accessory wiring terminal board (7). Discard
Iockwashers.
TA50110
11-85
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
2. Disconnect wiring harness lead (8) from cab heater wiring harness connector (9).
3. Remove 3 screws (13) and clamps (3). Remove nut (12), Iockwasher (11), and clamp (10)
from heater fuel line clamp (4). Discard Iockwasher.
4. Disconnect wiring harness (1) from heater control box plug (2). Remove grommet (14) from
wiring harness and cargo bed. Carefully remove wiring harness through hole in cargo body.
5. Disconnect wiring harness (16) from cab heater wiring harness connector (19).
6. Remove 11 straps (20) from wiring harness (16) and radio feed cable (17). Discard straps.
7. Disconnect wiring harness (16) from junction box (18) and heater control box plug (15).
Remove grommet (21) from wiring harness and cargo bed. Carefully remove wiring harness
through hole in cargo body.
TA50111
11-86
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
b. INSTALLATION
NOTE
1. Install wiring harness (16) through hole in cargo bed. Connect wiring harness to junction box
(18) and heater control box plug (15). Install grommet (21) on wiring harness at hole in cargo
body.
2. Install wiring harness (16) along radio feed cable (17) with 11 new straps (20).
3. Connect wiring harness (16) to cab heater wiring harness connector (19).
TA50112
11-87
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
4. Install wiring harness (1) through hole in cargo bed. Connect wiring harness to heater control
box plug (2). Install grommet (14) on wiring harness at hole in cargo bed.
5. Install clamp (10) on wiring harness (1). Install clamp on heater fuel line clamp (4) with new
lockwasher (11) and nut (12). Install 3 clamps (3) on wiring harness. Install clamps on frame
with 3 screws (13).
6. Connect wiring harness lead (8) to cab heater wiring harness connector (9).
7. Connect wiring harness (1) lead to positive accessory wiring terminal board stud and install
new Iockwasher and nut. Install positive accessory wiring terminal board cover (5) and tighten
2 nuts (6). Repeat for negative accessory wiring terminal board (7).
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
TA50113
11-88
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
a. REMOVAL
WARNING
NOTE
TA50114
11-89
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
4. At upper right side of cargo compartment cover insulation, remove 4 screws (11), access
door (12), strainer element (13), and gasket (14) from access cover (16). Clean strainer
element. Discard strainer element if damaged. Discard gasket.
5. Remove 8 nuts (20), bolts (19), and ventilator (18) from enclosure (17). Remove 2 bolts (15)
and access cover (16) from rear door assembly panel (21). Clean old sealant from all
components.
b. INSTALLATION
NOTE
1. Apply sealant to access cover (16) and install on rear door assembly panel (21) with 2 bolts
(15). Apply sealant to ventilator (18) and install on enclosure (17) with 8 bolts (19) and nuts
(20).
TA50115
11-90
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
2. Install new gasket (14), strainer element (13), and access door (12) on access cover (16)
with 4 screws (11).
3. Install gasket (7), new gasket (8), and retainer (9) with 4 bolts (10) if removed.
TA50116
11-91
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
a. REMOVAL
NOTE
• If removing air duct hose (3), perform steps 1 and 2.
3. Remove 4 nuts (7), bolts (9), and ventilator (8) from air inlet adapter assembly (1). Clean old
sealant from all components.
TA50117
11-92
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
b. INSTALLATION
NOTE
• If installing ventilator (8), perform step 1.
• If installing air duct hose (3), perform steps 2 and 3.
2. Connect air duct hose (3) to air inlet adapter assembly (1) and tighten clamp (2).
3. Connect air duct hose (3) to ventilator (6) and tighten clamp (5), Buckle strap (4) around air
duct hose.
TA50118
11-93/(11-94 blank)
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
Paragraph Page
Number Procedures Number
11-95
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
a. REMOVAL
1. Remove 4 screws (13) from each radio antenna bracket (14). Remove radio antenna bracket.
2. Remove 4 nuts (4), bolts (6), and air circulation ventilator (5). Clean off old sealant material.
3. Remove 8 nuts (1), bolts (3), and air circulation ventilator (2). Clean off old sealant material.
TA50119
11-96
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
4. Remove 8 nuts (16), screws (18), and washers (17) holding cover insulator (15) to top and
bottom of rear door opening panels.
5. Remove 12 screws (20) securing cover insulator (15) to each side of rear door opening
panels. Remove tube anchor nuts (19) only if damaged.
6. Remove 32 screws (21) and washers (22) holding cover insulator (15) to each side of truck
cargo box. Remove tube anchor nuts (23) only if damaged.
8. On inside of cargo compartment, remove cover insulator (15) from turnbuttons on front rail
assembly.
TA50120
11-97
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
11. Remove 18 screws (7) and nuts (12) from cargo cover insulator window assembly.
b. INSTALLATION
2. Apply RTV sealant to mating surfaces. Install retainer (11) and gasket (10) to plastic window
(9) .
3. Install retainer (11), gasket (10), and plastic window (9) to opening in cargo cover insulator.
4. Apply RTV sealant to mating surfaces. Install retainer (8) and secure through all layers with 18
screws (7) and nuts (12).
7. Spread cover insulator (15) over roof, alining front hole with air inlet adapter and right rear hole
with air exhaust adapter.
8. On inside of cargo compartment, install cover insulator (15) to turnbuttons at front rail
assembly.
TA50121
11-98
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
9. If removed, install tube anchor nuts (23). Aline grommets on both sides of cover insulator (15)
with tube anchor nuts, Partially install 32 washers (22) and screws (21).
10. On inside of cargo compartment, install retaining strap around air inlet duct.
11. Aline grommets on back of cover insulator (15) with rear door opening panels.
12. Partially install 8 screws (18), washers (17), and nuts (16) at top and bottom of rear door
opening panels.
13. If removed, install tube anchor nuts (19). Partially install 12 screws (20) down sides of rear
door opening panels.
TA50122
11-99
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
14. Apply RTV sealant to mating surfaces. Install air circulation ventilator (2) with 8 bolts (3) and
nuts (1).
15. Apply RTV sealant to mating surfaces. Install air circulation ventilator (5) with 4 bolts (6) and
nuts (4).
CAUTION
DO NOT overtighten screws in tube anchor nuts or tube anchor nuts will
break.
17. Install each radio antenna bracket (14) with 4 screws (13).
TA50123
11-100
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
a. REMOVAL
NOTE
• There will be no front insulator (18) or front outer insulator (5) If truck
is equipped with communications rack.
1. Remove 3 locknuts (17), 6 washers (2), 3 bolts (1), and front insulator (18) from truck.
Discard locknuts.
TA50124
11-101
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
2. Remove 2 locknuts (15), 4 washers (4), 2 bolts (3), and front outer insulator (5) from truck.
Discard locknuts.
4. Remove 2 locknuts (14), 4 washers (13), and 2 bolts (6) holding center insulator (16) to cargo
box floor. Discard locknuts.
TA50125
11-102
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
5. Remove 16 screws (8) and 4 brackets (9) from 2 wheel house insulators (7).
7. Remove 8 screws (11) and 2 brackets (12) holding 2 rear outer insulators (10) to rear side
insulators. Remove rear outer insulators.
b. INSTALLATION
NOTE
Ž If installing rear outer insulators (10), perform steps 1, 2, and 5.
• If installing center insulator (16), perform steps 3-5.
• If installing front insulator (18), perform step 6.
• If installing front outer insulator (5), perform step 7.
2. Install 2 brackets (12) to 2 rear outer insulators (10) and rear side insulators with 8 screws
(11).
3. Place center insulator (16) in line with 2 mounting holes in floor and install 2 bolts (6), 4
washers (13), and 2 new locknuts (14).
4. Install 4 brackets (9) to 2 wheel house insulators (7) and center insulator (16) with 16 screws
(8) .
NOTE
There will be no front insulator (18) or front outer insulator (5) if truck is
equipped with communications rack.
6. Install front insulator (18) with 3 bolts (1), 6 washers (2), and 3 new locknuts (17).
7. Install front outer insulator (5) with 2 bolts (3), 4 washers (4), and 2 new locknuts (15).
11-103
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
NOTE
1. Remove 4 screws (18) securing 2 brackets (10) to front side insulator (12).
2. Remove 4 screws (18) securing 2 brackets (20) to rear side insulator (13).
3. Remove 8 screws (18), 2 brackets (22), and wheel house insulator (21).
4. Remove cable attached to dummy receptacle connector (11) at right sidewall if present.
6. Remove 4 screws (18) at 2 brackets (10) and remove front side insulator (12).
7. Remove 2 screws (14), bolts (16), bolts (17), and rear angle bracket (15).
8. Remove 4 screws (18), bracket (19), and rear side insulator (13).
9. Remove 2 bolts (7), washers (6), and wiring harness (5) from front insulator (23). Remove
screw (8) and locknut (9) from ground wire (3) (M1008), or remove nut (2), ground strap (1),
and ground wire (3) from stud (4) (M1008A1). Discard locknut.
11-104
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
TA50126
11-105
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
TA50127
11-106
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
b. INSTALLATION
NOTE
2. Install ground wire (3) with screw (8) and new locknut (9) (M1008) or install ground wire (3)
and ground strap (1) on stud (4) with nut (2) (M1008A1). Install wiring harness (5) to front
insulator (23) with 2 bolts (7) and washers (6).
3. Install front side insulator (12) flush with side of cargo bed.
4. Install 2 brackets (10) to front side insulator (12) with 4 screws (18).
7. Install rear side insulator (13) flush with side of cargo bed.
8. Install bracket (19) to floor and to rear side insulator (13) with 4 screws (18).
9. Install rear angle bracket (15) with 2 screws (14) to rear side insulator (13), 2 bolts (16) into
rear endgate post, and 2 bolts (17) into rear door side panel.
10. Install wheel house insulator (21) over wheel house flush with side and fIoor panels.
11. Install 2 brackets (20) to front side insulator 12) with 4 screws (18).
12. Install 2 brackets (20) to rear side insulator (13) with 4 screws (18).
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
11-107
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
a. REMOVAL
NOTE
• If removing roof cover (6), perform steps 1-8.
5. Pull roof cover (6) forward over cab of truck and place upside down.
6. Remove 14 screws (2), washers (1), 2 side retainers (5), and 2 top retainers (3). Set screws
aside for later use.
9. Remove endgate curtain (9) from 14 turnbuttons (10) and remove endgate curtain.
10. Open endgate and inspect each side lip of endgate for tightness of 8 locknuts (11).
b. INSTALLATION
NOTE
1. Replace all broken turnbuttons (8 and 10) and tighten 8 locknuts (11).
2. Replace any loose or damaged expansion shields (4) by applying corrosion-resistant sealing
compound to holes and installing new expansion shields.
11-108
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
11-109
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
TA50129
11-110
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
4. Place roof cover (6), with lettering facing up, over cab and hood, with front fold over edge of
removable cargo cover and centered right-to-left. Line up grommets in roof cover (6) with
existing expansion shield (4) holes.
CAUTION
5. Install 2 top retainers (3) and 2 side retainers (5) with 14 washers (1) and screws (2).
6. Spread roof cover (6) over rear of truck and smooth it out.
7. Install bottom edges of roof cover (6) with 12 washers (16) and screws (15).
8. Install roof cover (6) to rear sides of truck with 4 turnbuttons (12).
10. Seal front edge of roof cover (6) with corrosion-resistant sealing compound. Seal top only.
Stop at left and right side drip rails.
11. Install radio antenna bracket (13) through holes in roof cover (6) with 4 screws (14) if
removed.
11-111
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
Personnel Required
• MOS 63B (2)
a. REMOVAL
NOTE
• Spare tire and spare tire carrier must be removed to perform this task.
• If removing molding (13) and rear floor insulators (12), perform steps 2
and 3.
• If removing front and floor insulators (17 and 22), perform steps 2 and
6 through 8.
1. Remove 40 screws (2) and 10 brackets (3) from 2 wheel house insulators (1) and remove
wheel house insulators from wheel housings.
3. Remove 8 screws (4), 2 brackets (5), and 2 rear floor insulators (12).
4. Remove 6 bolts (8), 12 washers (7), and 6 locknuts (11) at 6 brackets (10). Remove 2 side
insulators (6). Discard locknuts.
NOTE
If wheel house insulators (1) have not been removed, perform step 6.
6. Remove 16 screws (2) and 4 brackets (3) securing 2 wheel house insulators (1) to floor
insulator (22).
7. Remove 4 locknuts (16), 8 washers (15), and 4 bolts (23). Remove 4 screws (18) at front
edge of floor insulator (22) and remove floor insulator. Discard locknuts.
8. Remove 2 nuts (19), washers (20), bolts (21), and front insulator (17).
11-112
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
11-113
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
TA50131
11-114
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
b. INSTALLATION
NOTE
• If installing front and floor insulators (17 and 22), perform steps 1-4,
and 9.
• If installing side and rear floor insulators (6 and 12) and molding
- (13),
. .
perform steps 5-9.
1. Apply RTV sealant to 2 bolts (21), Install f rent insulator (17) with bolts, washers (20), and nuts
(19).
NOTE
Open and close endgate before securing floor insulator (22) to check
clearance at endgate.
2. Place floor insulator (22) in cargo compartment, alining holes in floor insulator with holes in
floor of truck.
3. Apply RTV sealant to 4 bolts (23), Install 4 bolts, 8 washers (15), and 4 new locknuts (16).
5. Install 6 brackets (10) to 2 side insulators (6) with 12 screws (9) if removed.
6. Install 2 side insulators (6) with 6 bolts (8), 12 washers (7), and 6 new locknuts (11).
7. Install 2 brackets (5) to 2 rear floor insulators (12) with 4 screws (4).
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
11-115
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
Personnel Required
• MOS 63B (2)
NOTE
2. Remove domelight wiring harness clips (14) from front support (15).
3. Remove 4 nuts (17) and roof support bracket (18) with attached domelight.
4. Remove 2 nuts (7) and disengage slot in front support (15) from air inlet adapter assembly
(6). Remove front support and air inlet assembly.
5. Disengage rear support (12) from panel assembly (10) and remove rear support.
7. At front of roof bow (1), remove 2 nuts (5), retaining straps (4), and bolts (2).
8. Remove roof support bracket (3), 2 roof support brackets (13), and 3 roof support brackets
(9) .
11-116
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
TA50132
11-117
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
10. Remove wiring harness (24) and clips (23) from right roof bow support (22).
11. Remove pin (26) from roof bow support (22) and remove roof bow support from front rail
assembly (25).
12. Remove screw (27), locknut (29), pin (26), and clamp (28). Discard locknut.
13. Remove 2 screws (19), nuts (21), bracket (20), and roof bow support (22) from roof bow (1).
NOTE
• If installing roof bow supports (22), perform steps 1-4.
1. Install clamp (28) to roof bow support (22). Install pin (26) to clamp with screw (27) and new
locknut (29).
TA50133
11-118
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
2. Install bracket (20) to roof bow support (22) and to roof bow (1) with 2 screws (19) and nuts
(21).
3. Install roof bow support (22) to front rail assembly (25) and secure with pin (26).
4. At right roof bow support (22) install wiring harness (24) and clips (23).
NOTE
When installing roof panels (8), place the words “THIS SIDE UP” (if
present) to the outside.
5. Place 2 roof panels (8) on top of 3 roof bows (1) and center panels.
TA50134
11-119
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
TA50135
11-120
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
6. Install 3 roof support brackets (9) to panel assembly (10) with 6 nuts (11).
7. Place roof support bracket (3) through 2 roof panels (8) and air inlet adapter assembly (6).
Loosely install 2 nuts (7) but DO NOT tighten.
8. Place 2 roof support brackets (13) through 2 roof panels (8). DO NOT install 4 nuts (17).
9. At front edge of 2 roof panels (8), install 2 bolts (12), retaining straps (4), and nuts (5).
10. Install slotted end of rear support (2) into panel assembly (10). Raise forward end of rear
support to center bow support (1).
11. Install slotted end of front support (15) to air inlet adapter assembly (6). Raise rear end of front
support to center bow support (1).
12. Install roof support bracket (18) with attached domelight with 4 nuts (17).
14. Install domelight wiring harness clips (14) to front support (15) and connect domelight wiring
harness connector (16) at ceiling.
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
11-121
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
a. REMOVAL
NOTE
If removing 2 bulbs (25), 2 lenses (26 and 29), or cover plate (28),
perform steps 4 and 5.
2. Remove 4 nuts (23) and roof support bracket (30) from front and rear roof supports (1).
3. Remove 4 screws (2) and roof support bracket (30) from base assembly (24).
5. Remove blue lens (29) and clear lens (26) from cover plate (28) and 2 bulbs (25) from base
assembly (24).
NOTE
Tag wires for installation.
6. Disconnect purple wire (18) from “DOME” and orange wire (16) from “T-LPS” positions on
fuse box (17) under dash.
7. Remove grommet (15) at bulkhead and carefully pull wiring harness (12) through bulkhead.
Discard grommet if damaged.
8. Remove 5 screws (14), clamps (13), and wiring harness (12) from under hood and along
frame.
9. Disconnect wiring harness (12) from electrical lead (3) at connector at front of cargo box.
10. Remove 2 screws (6), washers (5), and clamps (20), and remove wiring harness (12) from
front of cargo box.
11. Remove screw (7) and locknut (8) from ground wire (10) (M1008), or nut (9) from stud (11),
and remove ground wire (10) and communications rack ground strap (M1008A1). Discard
locknut.
11-122
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
TA50136
11-123
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
TA50137
11-124
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
12. Remove grommet (19) and carefully pull wiring harness (12) into cargo box and remove. DO
NOT discard grommet.
13. Remove electrical lead (3) from clips (21) at right bow roof support (4), right side of front roof
bow, and front section of roof support (1).
14. Disconnect electrical lead (3) from domelight at connector (22) and remove electrical lead.
b. INSTALLATION
NOTE
2. Install clear lens (26) and blue lens (29) into cover plate (28) with clear iens to the front. Install
cover plate to base assembly (24) with 6 screws (27).
3. Install base assembly (24) to roof support bracket (30) with 4 screws (2).
4. Install roof support bracket (30) to 4 studs from roof supports (1) with 4 nuts (23).
5. Install electrical iead (3) to clips (21) at front section of roof support (1), right side of front roof
bow, and right bow roof support (4).
8. Carefully push wiring harness (12) through hole in cargo box front. install grommet (19).
9. Install ground wire (10) to cargo bed using boit (7) and new locknut (8) (M1008), or install
ground wire (10) with communications rack ground strap to stud (11) with nut (9) (M1008A1).
10. Install wiring harness (12) to front of cargo box with 2 clamps (20), washers (5), and screws
(6) .
11. Install wiring harness (12) along frame and under hood with 5 clamps (13) and screws (14).
12. Carefully push wiring harness (12) through hole in left front of bulkhead and install grommet
(15).
13. Connect purple wire (18) to uDOME” and orange wire (16) to “T-LPS” positions on fuse box
(17) under dash.
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
11-125
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INITIAL SETUP:
a. REMOVAL
NOTE
1. Remove 4 nuts (4), screws (1), and washers (2) securing check strap (5) to rear door
assembly (6) and rear side panel. Remove check strap from rear door assembly and door
holder (3) from loop in check strap.
TA501i38
11-126
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
NOTE
2. Remove 4 nuts (11), 4 screws (14), and 8 washers (9) holding rear door assembly (6) to
hinge (10). Remove rear door assembly.
3. Remove 4 nuts (13), 4 screws (7), and 8 washers (8) holding hinge (10) to door opening panel
assembly. Remove hinge and molding (12).
TA50139
11-127
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
NOTE
Latch assembly (19), handle assemblies (21 and 24), and window
assembly (26, 27, 28, and 29) can be replaced without removing door
assembly (6) from truck.
If disassembling window assembly (26, 27, 28, and 29), perform steps 7
and 8.
2. Remove 3 screws (25) and outer handle assembly (24). Remove 3 nuts (22) from rear door
assembly (6) by tapping them out if damaged.
5. Remove 12 nuts (23) from rear door assembly (6) by tapping nuts out if damaged.
7. At window assembly, remove 18 screws (26), retainer (27), and gasket (28). Discard gasket
only if worn.
8. Remove plastic window (29) from opening, Scrape off old RTV sealant from wood.
c. ASSEMBLY
NOTE
If assembling window assembly (26, 27, 28 and 29), perform steps
1 and 2.
2. Install plastic window (29), gasket (28), and retainer (27) with 18 screws (26).
NOTE
3. Install 4 door frames (15) to rear door assembly (6) with 14 screws (16).
11-128
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
4. Install 12 nuts (23) and 3 nuts (22) into holes in rear door assembly (6) if removed.
11-129
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
d. INSTALLATION
NOTE
If installing hinge (10), molding (12), and rear door assembly (6),
perform steps 1-3.
1. Install hinge (10) and molding (12) to door opening panel with 4 screws (7), 8 washers (8),
and 4 nuts (13).
TA50141
11-130
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
NOTE
2. Install rear door assembly (6) to hinge (10) with 4 screws (14), 8 washers (9), and 4 nuts
(11).
3. Check operation of rear door assembly (6). If binding occurs, loosen nuts (11), adjust rear
door assembly, and tighten nuts.
5. Install check strap (5) to rear door assembly (6) and rear side panel with 4 screws (1),
washers (2), and nuts (4).
TA50142
11-131
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
11-35. REAR DOOR FRAME AND PANEL ASSEMBLY REPLACEMENT (M1008 AND
M1008A1).
INITIAL SETUP:
a. REMOVAL
NOTE
If removing door frame assembly (7), perform steps 1-4.
If removing left or right side panel assembly (6), perform steps 1-7.
1. Remove 2 nuts (16), 4 washers (10), 2 screws (11), and handle (12).
TA50143
11-132
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
11-35. REAR DOOR FRAME AND PANEL ASSEMBLY REPLACEMENT (M1008 AND
M1008A1) (Con’t).
2. Remove 2 nuts (1), 4 washers (2), and 2 screws (8) at top of door frame assembly (7).
3. Remove 2 nuts (3), 4 washers (4), 2 screws (9), and molding (5).
4. Remove 2 nuts (15), 4 washers (13), and 2 screws (14). Remove door frame assembly (7) by
moving bottom rearward and downward.
NOTE
Left and right side panel assemblies (6) are removed the same way.
5. Remove 2 bolts (21) from 2 nuts (25) in right side panel assembly (6). Remove 2 nuts from
right side panel assembly if damaged. Remove 2 bolts (19) from inside right side panel and
remove air vent (20).
6. Remove nut (30), 2 washers (27), and screw (26) at bottom of right side panel assembly (6).
7. Remove extended nut (17), washer (23), and screw (24) at top of right side panel assembly
(6). Remove right side panel assembly and rubber strip (22).
TA50144
11-133
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
11-35. REAR DOOR FRAME AND PANEL ASSEMBLY REPLACEMENT (M1008 AND
M1008A1) (Con’t).
8. Remove 3 screws (32) from center of molding (29). Remove 4 nuts (34), 8 washers (33), 4
bolts (31), and molding.
9. Remove 5 bolts (38) and molding (36). Remove 2 gaskets (37) from molding. Replace gaskets
if damaged. Remove 5 expansion shields (35) if damaged.
TA50145
11-134
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
11-35. REAR DOOR FRAME AND PANEL ASSEMBLY REPLACEMENT (M1008 AND
M1008A1) (Con’t).
b. INSTALLATION
NOTE
If installing molding (36), perform steps 1 and 2.
If installing left or right side panel assembly (6), perform steps 1-10.
2. Install 2 gaskets (37) into molding (36). Install molding with 5 bolts (38).
3. Install molding (29) to cargo floor with 4 bolts (31), 8 washers (33), and 4 nuts (34).
NOTE
Left and right side panel assemblies (6) are installed the same way. Use an
assistant to support side panel assemblies during installation.
5. Install 2 nuts (25) into right side panel assembly (6) if removed.
TA50146
11-135
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
11-35. REAR DOOR FRAME AND PANEL ASSEMBLY REPLACEMENT (M1008 AND
M1008A1) (Con’t).
6. Position rubber strip (22) at angle bracket (28). Install right side panel assembly (6) with 2
bolts (21) into 2 nuts (25). DO NOT fully tighten bolts. Install air vent (20) on right side panel
assembly with 2 bolts (19),
7. Install screw (26), 2 washers (27), and nut (30) through bottom of right side panel assembly
(6) into molding (29).
8. Install screw (24), washer (23), and extended nut (17) through top of right side panel
assembly (6) into panel assembly (18). DO NOT fully tighten extended nut.
NOTE
10. Install door frame assembly (7) with 2 screws (8), 4 washers (2), and 2 nuts (1). DO NOT fully
tighten nuts.
TA50147
11-136
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
11-35. REAR DOOR FRAME AND PANEL ASSEMBLY REPLACEMENT (M1008 AND
M1008A1) (Con’t).
11. Along bottom of door frame assembly (7), install 2 screws (14), 4 washers (13), and 2 nuts
(15). DO NOT fully tighten nuts.
12. Install molding (5) on inside of right side panel assembly (6), and install 2 screws (9), 4
washers (4), and 2 nuts (3) through mounting holes. DO NOT fully tighten nuts.
13. Install handle (12) with 2 screws (11), 4 washers (10), and 2 nuts (16). Tighten nuts (1, 3, 15,
and 16).
FOLLOW-ON TASKS:
TA50148
11-137/(11-138 blank)
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
CHAPTER 12
PREPARATION FOR STORAGE OR SHIPMENT
12-1. OVERVIEW.
a. This chapter describes preparation of CUCV Series trucks for shipment within the
continental United States and for limited storage.
12-1/(12-2 blank)
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
12-2. GENERAL.
a. This section provides instructions on preserving and otherwise protecting CUCV Series
trucks in preparation for shipment.
b. Protection for trucks and accompanying equipment must be sufficient to protect the
materiel against deterioration and physical damage.
12-3. CLEANING.
WARNING
CAUTION
a. Interior of Truck. Remove all dirt and other foreign matter from all painted metal
surfaces of the truck by scrubbing with cloths soaked in dry cleaning solvent (Item 15, Appendix C).
DO NOT apply solvent to electrical equipment, vinyl, or rubber parts of any nature. Notify your
supervisor for cleaning of electrical equipment. Use warm water and mild soap for cleaning vinyl. Dry
vinyl thoroughly. Apply preservative compound (Item 38, Appendix C) to vinyl and rubber.
b. Exterior of Truck. Clean exterior surfaces of the truck to ensure removal of all dirt and
foreign matter. After cleaning, immediately dry parts to remove excess cleaning solutions or residual
moisture. Let parts air dry or wipe with clean, dry, lint-free cloths. (See MIL P-116).
12-3
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
12-4. LUBRICATION.
WARNING
After cleaning has been accomplished, wipe all grease fittings clean with dry cleaning
solvent (Item 15, Appendix C) and lubricate the truck in accordance with LO 9-2320-289-12. Remove
excess grease after lubrication and before processing.
12-5. PRESERVATION.
a. All critical unpainted metal surfaces must be protected during shipment. Use
procedures and materials listed in paragraphs (1) and (2) below. If the preservatives listed are not
available, oil or grease specified in LO 9-2320-289-12 may be used for this purpose.
(1) Battery Leads. Disconnect both batteries. (See paragraph 4-38). Each battery
lead terminal, including the jumper lead ends, must be cleaned, coated with grease (Item 26,
Appendix C) and wrapped with tape (Item 48, Appendix C).
12-6. PACKAGING.
a. Lenses. Cover all truck lamp lenses with grease proof barrier material (Item 5,
Appendix C) and secure with tape (Item 48, Appendix C).
b. Electrical Openings. Cover all electrical receptacles with tape (Item 48, Appendix C)
or with plastic caps which will afford the same degree of protection.
12-7. PACKING.
a. Pack all Basis Issue Items (BII) and Additional Authorization List (AAL) items to prevent
mechanical damage.
b. For shipment, disconnect both battery negative cables (see paragraph 4-38) and wrap
with tape (Item 48, Appendix C).
12-8. MARKING.
12-4
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
12-5/(12-6 blank)
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
For transportability guidance for the logistical handling and movement of the CUCV Series
trucks, refer to TM 55-2320-289-14.
12-7/(12-8 blank)
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
12-11. GENERAL.
Commanders are responsible for ensuring that all trucks issued or assigned to their
command are maintained in a serviceable condition and properly cared for, and that personnel under
their command comply with technical instructions. Lack of time, lack of trained personnel, or lack of
proper tools may result in a unit being incapable of performing maintenance for which it is
responsible. In such cases, unit commanders may, with the approval of major commanders, place a
truck that is beyond the maintenance capability of the unit in administrative storage or return it to
supply agencies.
(1) The truck should be stored on level ground in the most favorable location
available, preferably one which affords protection from exposure to the elements and from pilferage.
(3) Remove both batteries and place in covered storage, maintaining a charged
condition.
(4) Provide access to the truck to permit inspection, servicing, and subsequent
removal from storage.
c. Inspection in Storage.
12-9/(12-10 blank)
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
APPENDIX A
REFERENCES
A-1 . SCOPE.
This appendix lists all forms, field manuals, technical manuals, and other publications
required for use with this manual.
A-2. INDEXES.
The following indexes should be frequently consulted for latest changes to, or revisions of,
references given in this appendix and for new publications or instructions relating to materiel covered in
this manual.
a. Military Publications:
b. General References:
The following Department of the Army Supply Catalogs pertain to this manual:
A-4. FORMS.
Refer to DA Pam 310-1, Consolidated Index of Army Publications and Blank Forms, for a
current and complete list of blank forms. Refer to DA Pam 738-750, The Army Maintenance
Change 1 A-1
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
Management System (TAMMS), for instructions on the use of maintenance forms pertaining to this
materiel.
The following publications contain information pertinent to the major item materiel and
associated equipment.
a. Truck:
b. C a m o u f l a g e :
Camouflage, . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . FM 5-20
Camouflage Materials, . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . TM 5-200
Color, Marking, and Camouflage Painting of Military
Vehicles, Construction Equipment, and Materials
Handling Equipment, . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . TB 43-0209
c. Decontamination:
A-2 Change 1
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
d. General:
Change 2 A-3
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
A-4 Change 2
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
APPENDIX B
MAINTENANCE ALLOCATION CHART
Section I. INTRODUCTION
B-1 . GENERAL.
a. This section provides a general explanation of all maintenance and repair functions
authorized at the various maintenance levels.
b. The Maintenance Allocation Chart (MAC) in Section II designates overall authority and
responsibility for the performance of maintenance functions on the identified end item or component.
The application of the maintenance functions to the end item or component will be consistent with the
capacities and capabilities of the designated maintenance levels.
c. Section Ill lists the tools and test equipment (both special tools and common tool sets)
required for each maintenance function as referenced from Section II.
g. Remove/Install. To remove and install the same item when required to perform service
or other maintenance functions. Install may be the act of emplacing, seating, or fixing into position a
spare, repair part, or module (component or assembly) in a manner to allow the proper functioning
of an equipment or system.
B-1
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
k. R e b u i l d . C o n s i s t s o f t h o s e s e r v i c e s / a c t i o n s n e c e s s a r y f o r t h e r e s t o r a t i o n o f
unserviceable equipment to a like new condition in accordance with original manufacturing
standards. Rebuild is the highest degree of materiel maintenance applied to Army equipment. The
rebuild operation includes the act of returning to zero those age measurements (hours/miles, etc.)
considered in classifying Army equipment/components.
a. Column 1, Group Number. Column 1 lists functional group code numbers, the purpose
of which is to identify maintenance significant components, assemblies, subassemblies, and
modules with the next higher assembly. End item group number shall be “00.”
d. Column 4, Maintenance Level. Column 4 specifies, by the listing of a work time figure
in the appropriate subcolumn(s), the level of maintenance authorized to perform the function listed in
Column 3. This figure represents the active time required to perform that maintenance function at the
indicated level of maintenance. If the number or complexity of the tasks within the listed maintenance
function vary at different maintenance levels, appropriate work time figures will be shown for each
level. The work time figure represents the average time required to restore an item (assembly,
subassembly, component, module, end item, or system) to a serviceable condition under typical
field operating conditions. This time includes preparation time (including any necessary
disassembly/assembly time), troubleshooting/fault location time, and quality assurance/quality
control time in addition to the time required to perform the specific tasks identified for the
maintenance functions authorized in the Maintenance Allocation Chart. The symbol designations for
the various maintenance levels are as follows:
e. Column 5, Tools and Equipment. Column 5 specifies, by code, those common tool
sets (not individual tools) and special tools, TMDE, and support equipment required to perform the
designated function.
f. Column 6, Remarks. This column shall, when applicable, contain a letter code, in
alphabetic order, which shall be keyed to the remarks contained in Section IV.
B-2
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
a. Column 1, Tool or Test Equipment Reference Code. The tool and test equipment
reference code correlates with a code used in the MAC, Section II, Column 5.
B-3
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
01 ENGINE
B-4 Change 1
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
Change 1 B-5
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
03 FUEL SYSTEM
B-6 Change 2
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
Change 1 B-7
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
04 EXHAUST SYSTEM
05 COOLING SYSTEM
B-8 Change 1
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
06 ELECTRICAL SYS-
TEM
Change 1 B-9
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
2roup Maintenance
umber ComponentlAssembly
‘2) Function
B-10 Change 1
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
..... me
Group Maintenance
‘3) *To~antt ‘-(6)
Number Comrlonent/Assembl Function c
F H DoEquipmen Remark:
0608 RESISTOR (BTRY BSTR) INSPECT 0.1
(Cont’d) REPLACE 0.7 1,2
Change 1 B-11
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
B-12 Change 2
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
Change 1 B-13
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
07 TRANSMISSION
B-14 Change 2
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
Group
Number component/Assembly c C) F }+ D Equipment Remarks
0710 TRANSMISSION , H’Y’DR
(Cont’d) 1,2
1,2
1,2,6 A
4,5 1,2,6,10
10.0 B
CONVERTER, TFm
1,2,6
PAN, TRANS FL
1,2,4
Change 1 B-15
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
08 TRANSFER AND
DRIVE ASSEMBLY
B-16 Change 1
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
09 PROPELLER SHAFTS
Change 1 B-17
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
10 FRONT AXLE
I
I
I
I
I I
1
I
0,4
I
I
I
1 I
2,4
B-18 Change 1
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
11 REAR AXLE
Change 1 B-19
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
12 BRAKES
B-20 Change 1
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
Change 2 B-21
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
14 STEERING
B-22 Change 2
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
15 FRAME, TOWING
ATTACHMENTS AND
DRAWBAR
Change 1 B-23
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
16 SPRINGS AND
SHOCK ABSORBERS
B-24 Change 2
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
Change 1 B-25
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
‘ii
DOOR /%SSY, CAB INSPECT 0.1
ALINE 0.5 1 ,2.8
REPLACE 15 1,2.8
‘i
HINGE ASSY, DOOR lNsPEc-r 0.1
SERVICE 0.2
REPLACE 0.7 1 ,2,4
\ ‘
PANEL, INSIDE DOOR IN SPEC”: ,0,1 ~
REPLACE ~ 0.5 : 1 ,2,8
B-26 Change 1
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
Change 1 B-27
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
— —
B-28 Change 2
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
Group
Number ComponentlAssembly Equipment Remarks
1812 FRONT FRAME A.SSY INSPECT 0.2
(Cont’d) REPAIR 4.0 1,’2,4
Change 1 B-29
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
22 K2DY, CHASSIS,
ND ACCESSORY
TEMS
— . - — --
B-30 Change 1
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
Change 1 B-31
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
33 SPECIAL PURPOSE
KITS
.-
B-32 Change 1
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
Change 1 B-33
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
39 SEARCHLIGHT AND
ELECTRICAL lLLUMl-
NATING EQUIPMENT
47 GAGES, NONELEC-
TRICAL
52 AIR CONDITIONER
B-34 Change 1
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
— —
Change 1 B-35
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
91 :BR ECJUIP!VIENT
B-36 Change 1
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
rool or Test
Equipment
Reference Maintenance National/NATO Tool
Code Level Nomenclature Stock Number Number
1 0 Tool Kit, General Mechanic’s Automo- 5180-00-177-7033
tive
Consisting of:
Change 2 B-37
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
rool or Test
Equipment
Reference Maintenance National/NATO Tool
Code Level Nomenclature Stock Number Number
consisting of:
CROWFOOT ATTACHMENT
(Injection Line) 5120-00-189-7898 J-29698-A
CROWFOOT ATTACHMENT
(Fuel Line) 5120-00-224-7288 J-28402
WRENCH, NUT (Differential) 5120-01-170-0627 J-24429
INSERTER, BEARING, ANNULAR 5120-01-170-3279 J-23690
ADAPTER, SOCKET WRENCH 5120-01-171-5233 J-29873
REMOVER, ACCUMULATOR 4910-01-178-8864 J-26889
GAGE ASSY, TIMING 4910-01-178-9788 J-29601
PACKER, SEAL (Rear Main) 5120-01-179-1033 J-33154
ADAPTER SET, BALL JOINT 4910-01-179-2515 J-23454-D
B-38 Change 2
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
rool or Test
Equipment
Reference Maintenance National/NATO Tool
Code Level Nomenclature Stock Number Number
Cons/sting of:
B-39
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
B In this category, nospecific times can reestablished, Time required for repair/overhaul
will depend on the extent of the repair required for the damaged components,
c If body side panel is also damaged and must be replaced, side panel must be cut using
modification template to accept fender flares,
B-40 Change 1
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
APPENDIX C
EXPENDABLE/DURABLE SUPPLIES AND MATERIALS LIST
Section I. INTRODUCTION
C-1 . SCOPE.
This appendix lists expendable/durable supplies and materials you will need to maintain the
CUCV Series trucks. This listing is for informational purposes only and is not authority to requisition
the listed items. These items are authorized to you by CTA 50-970, E x p e n d a b l e / D u r a b l e I t e m s
(Except Medical, Class V, Repair Parts, and Heraldic Items), or CTA 8-100, A r m y M e d i c a l
Department Expendable/Durable Items.
a. Column (1) - Item Number. This number is assigned to the entry in the listing and is
referenced in the Initial Setup of applicable tasks under the heading of Materials/Parts.
b. Column (2) - Level. This column identifies the lowest level of maintenance that
requires the listed item.
C - Operator/Crew
O - Unit Maintenance
c . Column (3) - National Stock Number. This is the National Stock Number assigned to
the item; use it to request or requisition the item.
C-1
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
hem National
Number Level Stock Number Description UIM
3, c ANTIFREEZE: Arctic
(81349) MIL-A-11755
9, 0 CHALK, MARKING:
(61348) SS-C-255
7510-00-223-6701 1 Gross gr
C-2 Change 2
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
Item National
dumber Level Stock Number Description UIM
C-3
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
Item National
Uumber Level Stock Number Description UIM
30. 0 LOCTITE:
(24617) 9985283
C-4
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
Item National
Number Level Stock Number Description UIM
8010-00-264-8866 Kit ea
C-5
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
Item National
Number Level Stock Number Description LJIM
8030-00-009-5023 Kit ea
C-6 Change 2
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
APPENDIX D
ILLUSTRATED LIST OF MANUFACTURED ITEMS
Section I. INTRODUCTION
D-1 . SCOPE.
b. A part number index in alphanumeric order is provided for cross-referencing the part
number of the item to be manufactured to the figure which covers fabrication criteria. Items requiring
complicated manufacturing instructions will be illustrated with dimensions and locations of holes to be
drilled. Items requiring simple manufacturing instructions will not be illustrated.
c. All bulk materials needed for manufacture of an item are listed by National Stock Number,
part number, or specification number in the manufacturing instructions.
d. All dimensions given in Section II, Illustrated Manufacturing Instructions, are in inches,
except as noted.
D-1
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
D-2 Change 2
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
1. Fabricate from rubber hose, ¼ in. inside diameter, stock size 25 ft. long,
NSN 4720-01-163-7833.
1. Fabricate from rubber hose, 5/16 in. inside diameter, stock size 25 ft, long,
NSN 4720-01-156-0547.
1. Fabricate from rubber hose, 3/8 in. inside diameter, stock size 25 ft. long,
NSN 4720-01-156-0548.
D-3
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
1. Fabricate from rubber hose, ¼ in. inside diameter, stock size 25 ft. long,
NSN 4720-01-156-0549.
1. Fabricate from rubber hose, 5/8 in. inside diameter, stock size 25 ft. long,
NSN 4720-01-182-3457.
1. Fabricate from rubber hose, ¼ in. inside diameter, stock size 25 ft. long,
NSN 4720-01-155-7784.
1. Fabricate from rubber hose, 5/16 in. inside diameter, stock size 25 ft. long,
NSN 4720-01-156-0547.
1. Fabricate from rubber hose, 3/8 in. inside diameter, stock size 24 ft. long,
NSN 4720-01-159-5796.
D-4
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
1. Fabricate from heater hose, 5/8 in. inside diameter, stock size 25 ft. long,
NSN 4720-00-432-1179.
1. Fabricate from cover, stock size 12.041 in. long, NSN 5490-00-984-9088.
2. Count off 3 dimplings (1) from end of stock for Part Number MS18029-13L-3.
Using dimpling as a center point, drill 0.64 in. diameter hole through first and
third dimpling. Cut stock 1.062 in. from center of each hole, Total length will be
6.664 in.
3. Count off 5 dimplings (1) from end of stock for Part Number MS18029-13L-5.
Using dimpling as a center point, drill 0.64 in. diameter hole through first and
fifth dimpling. Cut stock 1.062 in. from center of each hole, Total length will be
9.664 in.
TA49687
D-5
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
1. Fabricate from board, stock size 12.041 in. long, NSN 5940-00-753-7753.
2. Count off 4 pairs of flanges (1) from end of stock for Part Number
MS27212-4-3. There will be a total of 3 studs (2) between these flanges. Cut
stock 5.124 in. from outside of first pair of flanges to outside of fourth pair of
flanges.
3. Count off 6 pairs of flanges (1) from end of stock for Part Number
MS27212-4-5. There will be a total of 5 studs (2) between these flanges. Cut
stock 8.124 in. from outside of first pair of flanges to outside of sixth pair of
flanges.
TA49688
D-6
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
1. Fabricate from conduit, ½ in. inside diameter, stock size 15 ft. long,
NSN 5975-01-160-8458.
1. Fabricate from rubber hose, 5/16 in. inside diameter, stock size 25 ft. long,
NSN 4720-01-156-0547.
1. Fabricate from rubber hose, 5/16 in. inside diameter, stock size 25 ft. long,
NSN 4720-01-156-0547.
10 Fabricate from rubber hose, 5/16 in. inside diameter, stock size 25 ft. long,
NSN 4720-01-148-2768.
D-7
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
1. Fabricate from rubber hose, 3/8 in. inside diameter, stock size 10 ft. long,
NSN 4720-01-154-1241.
1. Fabricate from front door trim panel seal, stock size 46.50 in. x 0.36 in. x
0.50 in., NSN 5330-01-096-7698.
1. Fabricate from filler, stock size 0.047 in. x 100 ft. long, NSN 5330-00-753-8036.
1. Fabricate from filler, stock size 0.047 in. x 100 ft. long, NSN 5330-00-753-8036.
D-8
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
1. Fabricate from vacuum hose, 7/32 in. inside diameter, stock size 25 ft. long,
NSN 4720-01-096-7718.
1. Fabricate from rubber hose, 5/32 in. inside diameter, stock size 25 ft. long,
NSN 4720-00-230-6523.
1. Fabricate from heater hose, 5/8 in. inside diameter, stock size 25 ft. long,
NSN 4720-00-432-1179.
D-9
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
2. Using Figure FO-1, cut to dimensions shown and drill holes as indicated for Part
Number 14076209.
4. Treat and seal wood per MIL-T-704J, paragraph 3.2.4. Prime with epoxy primer
coating (Item 39, Appendix C), per MlL-STD-l 93. Finish paint lusterless forest
green (Item 11, Appendix C) on both sides.
2. Using 2 x stock material, cut to 30.60 in. long for Part Number 14076864.
3. Using 4 x stock material, cut to 56.38 in. long for Part Number 14076212.
D-10
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
NOTE
Part Number 14076871 is the left half (LH) panel and 14076872 is the right
half (RH) panel. Only drill holes indicated for part to be fabricated.
5. Treat and seal wood per MIL-T-704J, paragraph 3.2.4. Prime with epoxy primer
coating (Item 39, Appendix C), per MlL-STD-193. Finish paint lusterless forest
green (Item 11, Appendix C) on both sides.
TA49689
D-11
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
2. Cut to 24.00 in. x 96.00 in. and drill holes as indicated for Part
Number 14076222.
4. Treat and seal wood per MIL-T-704J, paragraph 3.2.4. Prime with epoxy primer
coating (Item 39, Appendix C), per MlL-STD-193. Finish paint lusterless forest
green (Item 11, Appendix C) on both sides.
TA49690
D-12
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
2. Cut to dimensions shown and drill holes as indicated for Part Number 14076232.
1. Fabricate from steel tubing, ¼ in. outside diameter, stock size 25 ft. long,
NSN 4720-01-161-0138.
3. Use old pipe as a guide and bend steel tubing to same shape.
TA49691
Change 2 D-13
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
2. Cut to dimensions shown and drill holes as indicated for Part Number 14076201.
4. Treat and seal wood per MIL-T-704J, paragraph 3.2.4. Prime with epoxy primer
coating (Item 39, Appendix C), per MIL-STD-193. Finish paint lusterless forest
green (Item 11, Appendix C) on both sides.
1. Fabricate from rubber hose, 7/32 in. inside diameter, stock size 25 ft. long,
NSN 4720-01-192-3519.
TA49692
D-14 Change 2
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
2. Cut to dimensions shown and drill holes as indicated for Part Number 14076229.
4. Treat and seal wood per MIL-T-704J, paragraph 3.2.4. Prime with epoxy primer
coating (Item 39, Appendix C), per MlL-STD-193. Finish paint lusterless forest
green (Item 11, Appendix C) on both sides.
TA49693
D-15
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
2. Cut to dimensions shown and drill holes as indicated for Part Number 14076271.
D-16
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
4. Treat and seal wood per MIL-T-704J, paragraph 3.2.4. Prime with epoxy primer
coating (Item 39, Appendix C), per MlL-STD-193. Finish paint lusterless forest
green (Item 11, Appendix C) on both sides.
2. Using Figure FO-2, cut to dimensions shown and drill holes as indicated for Part
Number 14076272.
4. Treat and seal wood per MIL-T-704J, paragraph 3.2.4. Prime with epoxy primer
coating (Item 39, Appendix C), per MlL-STD-193. Finish paint lusterless forest
green (Item 11, Appendix C) on both sides.
NOTE
2. Using Figure FO-3, cut to dimensions shown and drill holes as indicated for Part
Numbers 14076273 and 14076274.
4. Treat and seal wood per MIL-T-704J, paragraph 3.2.4. Prime with epoxy primer
coating (Item 39, Appendix C), per MlL-STD-193. Finish paint lusterless forest
green (Item 11, Appendix C) on both sides.
D-17
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
NOTE
4. Treat and seal wood per MIL-T-704J, paragraph 3.2.4. Prime with epoxy primer
coating (Item 39, Appendix C), per MlL-STD-193. Finish paint lusterless forest
green (Item 11, Appendix C) on both sides.
TA49695
D-18
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
NOTE
Except where noted, 14076277 is the opposite part to 14076278, so all
dimensions will be identical.
2. Using Figure FO-4, cut to dimensions shown for Part Numbers 14076277 and
14076278.
4. Treat and seal wood per MIL-T-704J, paragraph 3.2.4. Prime with epoxy primer
coating (Item 39, Appendix C), per MlL-STD-193. Finish paint lusterless forest
green (Item 11, Appendix C) on both sides.
NOTE
Part Number 14076279 is the opposite part to 14076280, so all dimensions
will be identical.
2. Using Figure FO-5, cut to dimensions shown for Part Numbers 14076279 and
14076280.
4. Treat and seal wood per MIL-T-704J, paragraph 3.2.4. Prime with epoxy primer
coating (Item 39, Appendix C), per MlL-STD-193. Finish paint lusterless forest
green (Item 11, Appendix C) on both sides.
D-19
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
2. Cut to dimensions shown and drill holes as indicated for Part Number 14076281.
4. Treat and seal wood per MIL-T-704J, paragraph 3.2.4. Prime with epoxy primer
coating (Item 39, Appendix C), per MlL-STD-193. Finish paint lusterless forest
green (Item 11, Appendix C) on both sides.
TA49696
D-20
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
2. Using Figure FO-6, cut to dimensions shown and drill holes as indicated for Part
Number 14063341.
4. Treat and seal wood per MIL-T-704J, paragraph 3.2.4. Prime with epoxy primer
coating (Item 39, Appendix C), per MlL-STD-193. Finish paint lusterless forest
green (Item 11, Appendix C) on both sides.
2. Using Figure FO-7, cut to dimensions shown and drill holes as indicated for Part
Number 14063343.
4. Treat and seal wood per MIL-T-704J, paragraph 3.2.4. Prime with epoxy primer
coating (Item 39, Appendix C), per MlL-STD-193. Finish paint lusterless forest
green (Item 11, Appendix C) on both sides.
2. Using Figure FO-8, cut to dimensions shown and drill holes as indicated for Part
Number 14063344.
4. Treat and seal wood per MIL-T-704J, paragraph 3.2.4. Prime with epoxy primer
coating (Item 39, Appendix C), per MlL-STD-193. Finish paint lusterless forest
green (Item 11, Appendix C) on both sides.
D-21
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
2. Cut to dimensions shown and drill holes as indicated for Part Number 14063346.
4. Treat and seal wood per MIL-T-704J, paragraph 3.2,4. Prime with epoxy primer
coating (Item 39, Appendix C), per MlL-STD-193. Finish paint lusterless forest
green (Item 11, Appendix C) on both sides.
TA49697
D-22
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
2. Using Figure FO-9, cut to dimensions shown and drill holes as indicated for Part
Number 14063347.
4. Treat and seal wood per MIL-T-704J, paragraph 3.2.4. Prime with epoxy primer
coating (Item 39, Appendix C), per MlL-STD-193. Finish paint lusterless forest
green (Item 11, Appendix C) on both sides.
2. Using Figure FO-10, cut to dimensions shown and drill holes as indicated for
Part Number 14063348.
4. Treat and seal wood per MIL-T-704J, paragraph 3.2.4. Prime with epoxy primer
coating (Item 39, Appendix C), per MlL-STD-193. Finish paint lusterless forest
green (Item 11, Appendix C) on both sides.
D-23
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
TA49698
D-24
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
2. Cut to dimensions shown and drill holes as indicated for Part Number 14063342.
TA49699
D-25
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
2. Cut to dimensions shown and drill holes as indicated for Part Number 14063345.
4. Treat and seal wood per MIL-T-704J, paragraph 3.2.4. Prime with epoxy primer
coating (Item 39, Appendix C), per MlL-STD-193. Finish paint lusterless forest
green (Item 11, Appendix C) on both sides.
TA49700
D-26
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
2. Cut to fit for Part Numbers 14075862, 14075863, 14075864, 14076802, and
14076803.
2. Cut to dimensions shown and drill hole as indicated for Part Number 14063352.
TA49701
D-27
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
2. Cut to dimensions shown and drill holes as indicated for Part Number 14063353.
TA49702
D-28
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
APPENDIX E
TORQUE LIMITS
E-1. SCOPE.
This appendix lists standard torque values, as shown in Table E-1, and provides general
information for applying torque. Special torque values and sequences are indicated in the
maintenance procedures for applicable components.
E-2. GENERAL.
a. Always use the torque values listed below when the maintenance procedure does not
give a specific torque value.
c. Torque values listed are based on clean and dry threads. Reduce torque by 10% when
engine oil is used as a lubricant.
FINE & COARSE THREADS Ib.-ft. N • m Ib.-ft. N•m Ib.-ft. N • m Ib.-ft. N-m
1/4 6 6 10 14 6 10 14 12 16
5/16 15 20 21 29 8 20 27 23 31
3/8 26 35 37 50 10 40 54 48 65
7/16 43 58 60 81 12 70 95 80 109
E-1
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
NOTE
If belt has been replaced, refer to new belt specification, run engine for
15 minutes, and adjust to old belt specifications.
NEW BELT:
146 lb. 146 lb. 169 lb.
Before Operating Engine 650 N 650 N 750 N
OLD BELT:
67 lb. 67 lb. 67 lb.
After Operating Engine 300 N 300 N 300 N
E-2
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
APPENDIX F
WIRING DIAGRAMS AND SCHEMATICS
F-1. SCOPE.
This appendix contains wiring diagrams and schematics of each CUCV Series electrical
circuit. This appendix should be used when performing the Electrical Troubleshooting procedures in
Table 2-4.
Figure Page
Number Figure Title Number
Change 1 F-1
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
Figure Page
Number Figure Title Number
F-2
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
F-1.
TM 9-2320-289-20
F-3
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
F-4
TM 9-2320-289-20
F-2.
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
F-3.
TM 9-2320-289-20
F-5
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
F-6
TM 9-2320-289-20
F-4.
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
F-5.
TM 9-2320-289-20
F-7
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
F-8
TM 9-2320-289-20
F-6.
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
F-7.
Change 2
TM 9-2320-289-20
F-9
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
F-10
TM 9-2320-289-20
Change 2
F-8.
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
F-9.
TM 9-2320-289-20
F-11
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
F-12
TM 9-2320-289-20
F-10.
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
F-11.
TM 9-2320-289-20
F-13
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
F-14
TM 9-2320-289-20
F-12.
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
F-13.
TM 9-2320-289-20
F-15
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
F-16
TM 9-2320-289-20
F-14.
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
F-14.1
F-15.
TM 9-2320-289-20
F-17
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
F-18
TM 9-2320-289-20
F-16.
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
F-17.
TM 9-2320-289-20
F-19
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
F-20
F-18.
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
F-19.
TM 9-2320-289-20
F-21
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
F-22
TM 9-2320-289-20
F-20.
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
F-21.
TM 9-2320-289-20
F-23
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
F-24
TM 9-2320-289-20
F-22.
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
F-23.
TM 9-2320-289-20
F-25
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
F-26
TM 9-2320-289-20
F-24.
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
F-25.
TM 9-2320-289-20
F-27
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
F-28
TM 9-2320-289-20
F-26
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
F-27.
TM 9-2320-289-20
F-29
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
F-30
TM 9-2320-289-20
F-28.
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
F-29.
TM 9-2320-289-20
F-31
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
F-32
F-30.
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
GLOSSARY
Section I. ABBREVIATIONS
Glossary 1
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
Glossary 2
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
TM 9-2320-289-20
Throughout this manual all assemblies, subassemblies, components, component parts, kits,
and bulk items are referred to by their official nomenclature as found in the Repair Parts and Special
Tools List (RPSTL) manual (TM 9-2320-289-20P).
TM 9-2320-289-20
INDEX
Absorber, shock:
Front . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-10 6-18
Rear . ..... . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . 6-11 6-19
Tie-rod . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-12 8-23
Accelerator:
Cable assembly . ... . . . . . . . . . .... . . . . . . . . . ... . . . . . . . . 3-23 3-66
Lever . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-24 3-69
Pedal . ..... . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-24 3-69
Accessory wiring terminal board . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-46 4-98
Adapter, speedometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-10 4-28
Air cleaner and seal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-9 3-14
Air conditioner (M1010):
Belt . . . . . . . . .. .... . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-35 3-106
Blower . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-34 10-124
Cover and condenser assembly . . . . . . . . . ... . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-33 10-122
Air inlet, cargo compartment heater (winterization kit) . .... . . . . . . . . . 11-25 11-92
Alinement, front wheel toe.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-6 8-14
Alternator:
All except M1010:
Belt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-2 4-2
Brackets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-2 4-2
M1010:
Belt . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-3 4-6
Pulley . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ... . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-3 4-6
Regulator ... . . . . . . ...... . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-4 4-10
Ambulance (M1010):
Air conditioner:
Belt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ...... . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-35 3-106
Mower . ... . ... . . . . . . . . . ... ...... . .... . . . . . 10-34 10-124
Cover and condenser assembly ... .... . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-33 10-122
Alternator:
Belt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. ... . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ... 4-3 4-6
P u l l e y . . . . . . . . ... .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-3 4-6
Regulator . .... . . . . . . . . . ... ... .... . .... . . . . . . . . . . . 4-4 4-10
Attendant’s seat maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ... .... . .... . . . . . . 10-29 10-106
Blackout:
Domelight lamp . .... . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .... 4-33 4-63
Light, rear ... ... . ..... . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-31 4-61
Blower:
Air conditioner . . . . . . . . . ...... . ... . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-34 10-124
Personnel heater . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-36 10-130
Body fuses . . . . . . . . . ...... . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-13 4-32
Components, principles of operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-25 1-18
Condenser, air conditioner ..... . . . . . . . . . ...... . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-33 10-122
Control box, personnel heater . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-35 10-127
Cover, air conditioner . ..... . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-33 10-122
Index 1
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INDEX
Door:
Interior sliding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-30 10-110
Rear:
Assembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-26 10-97
Fixed glass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-27 10-102
Hinge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-26 10-97
Lock mechanism ....... . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-26 10-97
Driver’s:
Seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-25 10-92
Seatbelt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-25 10-92
Fixed glass, rear door ..... . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-27 10-102
Floodlight:
Assembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-34 4-64
Lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-34 4-64
Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-21 4-44
Focus light and lamp, interior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-35 4-66
Fuel:
Filter, personnel heater . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-36 10-130
Pump, heater . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-32 10-118
Fuses, body . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-13 4-32
Gas-particulate filter unit (GPFU):
Maintenance . . . . ...... . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-31 10-113
Switches . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-21 4-44
Glass, fixed, rear door..... . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-27 10-102
Heater:
Blower, personnel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-36 10-130
Control box, personnel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. 10-35 10-127
Fuel:
Filter, personnel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-36 10-130
Pump . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-32 10-118
Personnel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-36 10-130
Hinge, rear door........ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-26 10-9
Interior:
Focus light.............. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-35 4-66
Sliding door . ... . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-30 10-110
Light:
Blackout:
Dome . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-33 4-63
Rear . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-31 4-61
Flood . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-34 4-64
Fluorescent . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-32 4-62
Interior focus ... . .. ..... . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-35 4-66
Spot . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-36 4-67
Surgical . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .... . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ..... 4-32 4-62
Tail . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-29 4-57
Location and description of major components . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-11 1-6
Lock mechanism, rear door . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-26 10-97
Index 2
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INDEX
Passenger’s:
Seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-25 10-92
Seatbelt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-25 10-92
Personnel heater:
Blower . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-36 10-130
Control box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-35 10-127
Fuel Filter . . . . . . . . . .. . . . .. . . .. . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . .. . . . .. 10-36 10-130
Principles of operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-25 1-18
Pulley, alternator . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. .... 4-3 4-6
Pump, fuel heater . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-32 10-118
Rear:
Blackout light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-31 4-61
Door:
Assembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-26 10-97
Fixed glass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-27 10-102
Hinges . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-26 10-97
Lock mechanism . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-26 10-97
Step assembly . . . . . . . ........ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-28 10-104
Regulator, alternator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. ..... . . . . . . . . . . . 4-4 4-10
Relay, body . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-13 4-32
Seat:
Attendant’s, maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-29 10-106
Driver’s . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. .. . . . . . . . . .. ........ . . . . . . . . . 10-25 10-92
Passenger’s . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ..... . . . . . .. 10-25 10-92
Seatbelt:
Driver’s . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-25 10-92
Passenger’s . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-25 10-92
Sliding door, interior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-30 10-110
Spotlight and lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-36 4-67
Step assembly, rear . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-28 10-104
Surgical lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . .. . . . . . . ..... . . . . . . 4-32 4-62
Switch :
Floodlight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-21 4-44
Gas-particulate filter unit (GPFU). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-21 4-44
Taillight and lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-29 4-57
Window, door:
Interior sliding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-30 10-110
Rear . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-27 10-102
Arm, pitman . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-11 8-22
Army:
Documentation, shipment of. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-9 12-4
Materiel, destruction of..... . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-3 1-1
Armrest . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-7 10-18
Annual schedule, PMCS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 2-2 2-21
Attendant’s seat maintenance (M1010) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-29 10-106
Axle:
Bumper:
Front . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-10 6-18
Rear . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-11 6-19
Index 3
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INDEX
Index 4 Change 1
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INDEX
Heater:
Cab (winterization kit) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-9 11-33
Motor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-12 10-34
Personnel (M1010) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-36 10-130
Board, accessory wiring and radio terminal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-46 4-98
Body fuses (M1010) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-13 4-32
Booster, power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-8 7-21
Boot, transfer case:
All except M1028A1, M1028A2, and M1031 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-4 5-7
M1028A1, M1028A2, and M1031. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-3 5-6
Box:
Battery, front and rear (winterization kit) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-6 11-17
Junction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-48 4-104
Personnel heater control (M1010) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-35 10-127
Bracket:
Radio mounting (M1009) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. 4-47 4-102
Resistor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. 4-44 4-92
Tow hook (M1009) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. ... . 9-8 9-16
Brake:
Indicator light wire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-22.1 4-46.1
Lines, bleeding instructions:
Front . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-9 7-24
Rear . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. 7-10 7-28
System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-6 7-10
Pads . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ... 7-11 7-33
Parking:
Cable:
Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-2 7-2
Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-4 7-5
Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. .. 4-17 4-39
Pedal:
Parking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . 7-3 7-3
Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . .. .. . .... .... 7-12 7-38
Principles of operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-21 1-16
Shoes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. .... ...... 7-7 7-14
Wheel cylinder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-7 7-14
Bumper:
Axle:
Front . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-10 6-18
Rear . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .... 6-11 6-19
Spring, front . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . .. . ... ....... 6-10 6-18
Front . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ....... 9-2 9-2
Rear:
All except M1009 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ....... 9-6 9-10
M1009 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . .. . .. .. 9-8 9-1
Support:
Front . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. 9-3 9-4
Rear:
All except M1009 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. .. . 9-7 9-14
M1009 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. .. . . 9-9 9-20
Change 2 Index 5
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INDEX
Cab:
Armrest . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-7 10-18
Door:
Assembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-5 10-10
Handle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-6 10-14
Hinges . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-5 10-10
Lock and cylinder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-6 10-14
Panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-7 10-18
Flashers, . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .... 4-12 4-31
Floor insulators (winterization kit) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-5 11-12
Fuses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ... 4-12 4-31
Heater blower:
Assembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-13 10-36
Capacitor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-12 10-34
Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-14 10-44
Fan . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-12 10-34
Motor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-12 10-34
Resistor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-12 10-34
Heater (winterization kit):
Assembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-8 11-28
Blower, . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-9 11-33
Coolant hoses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-12 11-47
Diverter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-8 11-28
Exhaust pipe . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-11 11-42
Fuel filter and lines... . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-7 11-24
Hoses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-9 11-33
Principles of operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-20 1-15
Wiring harness . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-10 11-3
Window:
Regulator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-22 10-78
Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-8 10-22
Vent . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-8 10-22
Cable:
Accelerator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-23 3-66
Battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-38 4-72
Parking brake:
Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-2 7-2
Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-4 7-5
Speedometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-10 4-28
Caliper, brake . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-11 7-33
Cap, fuel tank (M1009) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-16 3-50
Index 6
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INDEX
Capabilities, equipment:
Ambulance (M1010) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-10 1-3
Cargo (M1008, M1008A1, M1028, M1028A1, M1028A2,
and M1028A3) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-10 1-3
Chassis (M1031) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-10 1-3
Utility (M1009) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-10 1-3
Capacitor, heater . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-12 10-34
Cargo body:
Cover:
Insulator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-27 11-96
Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-19 10-60
Endgate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-16 10-48
Frame maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-19 10-60
Seat, bench (all except M1009) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-18 10-55
Seatbelt (all except M1009) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-18 10-55
Shelter tie-down . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-17 10-52
Cargo compartment:
Domelight and wiring harness (M1008 and M1008A1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-33 11-122
Endgate curtain (M1009) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-30 11-108
Heater (M1008 and M1008A1) (winterization kit):
Air inlet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-25 11-92
Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-20 11-70
Exhaust pipe . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-24 11-89
Fuel:
Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-21 11-72
Lines . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-22 11-80
Ventilator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-24 11-89
Wiring harness . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-23 11-85
Insulators:
M1008 and M1008A1:
Cover . . .. . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-27 11-96
Floor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-28 11-101
Front . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-29 11-104
Side . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-29 11-104
Wheelhouse . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-29 11-104
M1009:
Floor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-31 11-112
Side . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-31 11-112
Wheelhouse . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-31 11-112
Rear door (M1008 and M1008A1):
Frame, . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-35 11-132
Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-34 11-126
Panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-35 11-132
Roof:
Cover (M1009) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-30 11-108
Panels (M1008 and M1008A1). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-32 11-116
Supports (M1008 and M1008A1). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-32 11-116
Cargo truck, equipment characteristics, capabilities, and features . . . . . . . 1-10 1-3
Carrier, spare tire (all except M1009) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-10 9-23
Change 2 Index 7
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INDEX
Index 8 Change 2
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INDEX
Change 1 Index 9
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INDEX
Data:
Equipment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-14 1-8
Plates, location and contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-13 1-7
Description and location of major components . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-11 1-6
Designations, official ..... . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-5 1-1
Destruction of Army materiel to prevent enemy use . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-3 1-1
Diagrams, wiring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Appendix F F-1
Differences between models . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-12 1-7
Dipstick (engine oil level indicator) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-3 3-3
Directional signal lever .... . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-9 8-18
Diverter, cab heater (winterization kit) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-8 11-28
Documents, shipment of Army . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-9 12-4
Domelight:
Blackout lamp (M1010) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-33 4-63
Replacement (M1008 and M1008A1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-33 11-122
Door:
Armrest . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-7 10-18
Assembly, cab . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-5 10-10
Fuel tank filler:
All except M1009 and M1010. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-15 3-48
M1009 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-16 3-50
Handle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-6 10-14
Hinge:
Cab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-5 10-10
Rear (M1010)............ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-26 10-97
interior sliding (M1010) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-30 10-110
Lock:
Assembly .............. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-6 10-14
Cylinder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-6 10-14
Mechanism, rear (M1010) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-26 10-97
Open, buzzer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-11 4-30
Panel, . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-7 10-18
Rear:
Assembly (M1010) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-26 10-9
Fixed glass (M1010) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-27 10-102
Frame and panel assembly (M1008 and M1008A1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-35 11-132
Maintenance (M1008 and M1008A1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-34 11-126
Sliding, interior (M1010) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-30 10-110
Window:
Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-8 10-22
Rear, fixed glass (M1010) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-27 10-102
Regulator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-7 10-18
Vent, maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-8 10-22
Index 10
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INDEX
Drainback, fuel:
Hoses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ....... . . . . . 3-18 3-56
Pipe assembly.. . . .. . . .. . ... ... . . . . . . . . . . . . . ... . ... ... 3-19 3-58
Drive light and lamp, blackout . .... ... ..... .. ............................. ... . . . . . . 4-25 4-50
Drivebelt tensions.... . . . .. . . . . . . . . . .. . . .. . . . . ........ . . ... Table E-2 E-2
Driver’s:
Seat:
M1009 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-23 10-84
M1010 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-25 10-92
Seatbelt:
M1009 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ... . . . . . . . . . . ... 10-23 10-84
M1010 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. .... . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . ..... . 10-25 10-92
Drivetrain system, principles of operation . .... . . . . .. . . . . . . . .. ..... . . 1-16 1-12
Drum, hub, and wheel bearings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-5 8-10
Electrical:
Diagrams, wiring ... . .. . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Appendix F F-1
Principles of operation . . . . . . . . . . . ... .. . . .... . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-19 1-14
Trailer, receptacle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ... .. 4-41 4-88
Troubleshooting:
M a l f u n c t i o n s . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ... . . . . . . . . . . . Table 2-4 2-57
Symptom index. . . . . . .. . .. . .. . .... . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . .. . .. .. 2-11 2-33
Endgate:
Curtain (M1009) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-30 11-108
Maintenance (M1009) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ... .. ... . . . . . 10-21 10-70
Replacement (M1008 and M1008A1) . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . .... .... 10-16 10-48
Window:
Regulator (M1009) ... . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-22 10-78
Replacement (M1009) ... . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-22 10-78
Engine:
Compartment insulator (winterization kit) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-5 11-12
Heater coolant (winterization kit):
Exhaust pipe . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ... . . . . . . . . . . . 11-18 11-64
Fuel filter and lines . . . .. . . . .. . . . . . . . .. . . . .. . .. .... . . . . . . . 11-14 11-54
Hoses and fittings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-15 11-57
R e p l a c e m e n t . ... . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . .. .... . . . . . . 11-16 11-60
Wiring harness . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-17 11-62
Idle speed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .... . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-25 3-71
Oil:
Cooler lines . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. ....... . . . . . . . 3-6 3-8
Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ... . . .. . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-4 3-4
Level indicator (dipstick):
Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-3 3-3
Tube seal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-3
Pan . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-7.1 3-12.1
Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-4 3-4
Wiring harness block . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-42 4-89
Change 2 Index 11
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INDEX
Equipment:
Characteristics, capabilities and features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-10 1-3
Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-14,1-1 4.2 1-8,1 -10
Improvement Recommendations (EIRs) Reporting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-6 1-1
Exhaust:
Heater (winterization kit):
Cab, pipe . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ... 11-11 11-42
Cargo compartment . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-24 11-89
Engine coolant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-18 11-64
Manifold . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-28 3-82
Muffler ............ . ............ .... . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. 3-27 3-74
Pipe . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-27 3-74
Tailpipe . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-27 3-74
Expendable/durable supplies and materials list . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Appendix C C-1
Fan:
Heater blower...... . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-12 10-34
Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-35 3-106
Shroud . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-31 3-90
Fast idle solenoid assembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-23 3-66
Features, equipment:
Ambulance (M10100) . . . . . . ..................... 1-10 1-3
Cargo (M1008, M1008A1, M1028, M 1 028A1, M1028A2,
and M1028A3) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ... . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-10 1-3
Chassis (M1031) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-10 1-3
Utility (M1009) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-10 1-3
Fill pipe:
All except M1009 and M1010.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-15 3-48
M1009 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-16 3-50
Filler door, fuel tank:
All except M1009 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-15 3-48
M1009 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-16 3-50
Fill/vent hose (all except M1009 and M1010) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-15 3-48
Filter:
Air cleaner . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-9 3-14
Fuel:
Cab heater . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-7 11-24
Cargo compartment heater, maintenance (winterization kit) . . . . . . . . . 11-21 11-72
Engine coolant heater, (winterization kit) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-14 11-54
Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-17 3-52
Personnel heater (M1010) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-36 10-130
Gas-particulate, unit (GPFU) (M1010) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-31 10-113
Oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-4 3-4
Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-2 5-2
Fittings, engine coolant heater hoses (winterization kit) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-15 11-57
Fixed glass:
Rear door (M1010) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-27 10-102
interior sliding door (M1010) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-30 10-110
Index 12 Change 2
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INDEX
Index 13
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INDEX
Engine:
Coolant heater (winterization kit)... . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-14 11-54
Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-17 3-52
Personnel heater (M1010) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-36 10-130
Hoses, drainback . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-18 3-56
Lines, cargo compartment heater (winterization kit) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-22 11-80
Pump:
Heater (M1010) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-32 10-118
Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-10 3-16
System, principles of operations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-17 1-13
Tank:
Cap (M1009) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-16 3-50
Fill pipe assembly:
All except M1009 and M1010. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-15 3-48
M1009 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-16 3-50
Filler door:
All except M1009 and M1010.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-15 3-48
M1009 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-16 3-50
Fill/vent hoses (all except M1009 and M1010) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-15 3-48
Replacement:
All except M1009 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-11 3-18
M1009 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-12 3-24
Return hoses:
All except M1009 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-13 3-32
M1009 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-14 3-40
Shield:
AIl except M1009 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-11 3-18
M1009 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-12 3-24
Supply hoses:
All except M1009 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-13 3-32
M1009 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-14 3-40
Fuses:
Body (M1010) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-13 4-32
Cab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-12 4-31
Index 14
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INDEX
Handle:
Cab door . . . . . . . . . . ... . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-6 10-14
Endgate:
M1008 and M1008A1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .... . . . . 10-16 10-48
M1009 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .... . . . . . . . 10-21 10-70
interior sliding door (M1010) . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-30 10-110
Rear door (M1010) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .... . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-26 10-97
Harness:
Domelight wiring (winterization kit) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-33 11-122
Engine wiring block . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . ..... . . . . . 4-42 4-89
Radio feed (all except M1010) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .... . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-45 4-94
Wiring, heater (winterization kit):
Cab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-10 11-37
Cargo compartment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-23 11-85
Engine coolant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-17 11-62
Hazard warning control . . . . . . . ... .... . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-20 4-43
Headlight:
Control switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ... . . ... . 4-15 4-37
Service . . . . . . . . . . . . ...... . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-24 4-48
Heater:
Assembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ... . ..... . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-13 10-36
Blower:
Motor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. .... . ...... . . .. . . . . . . 10-12 10-34
M1010 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-36 10-130
Index 15
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INDEX
Index 16
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INDEX
Index 17
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INDEX
I
Idle:
Fast, solenoid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-23 3-66
Speed, engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-25 3-71
Illustrated list of manufactured items . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Appendix D D-1
Index:
Principles of operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-15 1-11
Troubleshooting, electrical.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-11 2-33
Troubleshooting, mechanical . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-11 2-30
References . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Appendix A A-1
Indicator, engine oil level (dipstick) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-3 3-3
lndicator light wire, brake . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-22.1 4-46.1
Inspection instructions, upon receipt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-2 2-1
Instructions:
Inspection, upon receipt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-2 2-1
Limited storage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ...... 12-12 12-9
Servicing upon receipt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-3 2-1
Instrument:
Cluster . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-7 4-16
Pad . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-17.1 10-54.1
Insulators (winterization kit):
Cab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ... 11-5 11-12
Cargo cover (M1008 and M1008A1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-27 11-96
Endgate:
M1008 and M1008A1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ..... 10-16 10-48
M1009 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-21 10-70
Engine compartment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ... 11-5 11-12
Floor panel:
M1008 and M1008A1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-28 11-101
M1009 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-31 11-112
Front (M1008 and M1008A1). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-29 11-104
Side:
M1008 and M1008A1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-29 11-104
M1009 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-31 11-112
Wheel house:
M1008 and M1008A1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-29 11-104
M1009 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ... 11-31 11-112
Interior:
Focus light and lamp (M1010) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. 4-35 4-66
Sliding door (M1010) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-30 10-110
Intervals, PMCS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .... 2-5 2-3
J
Junction box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-48 4-104
Joints, universal:
Front . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-3 6-4
Rear . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ... 6-5 6-10
K
Kit, troop seat, repair . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-1 11-1
Index 18 Change 2
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INDEX
Change 2 Index 19
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INDEX
Maintenance:
Allocation Chart (MAC). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Appendix B B-1
Forms and records . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-2 1-1
Major components:
Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ..... . . . . . . . . . . 1-11 1-6
Location . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-11 1-6
Principles of operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-15 1-11
Malfunctions:
Electrical troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-11 2-33
Mechanical troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-11 2-30
Manifold, exhaust . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-28 3-82
Manufactured items, illustrated Iist of . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Appendix D D-1
Marker light and lamp .... . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-27 4-53
Master cylinder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-8 7-21
Materials and supplies, expendable/durable list . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Appendix C C-1
Mechanical troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 2-3 2-35
Mechanism, lock (M1010) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-26 10-97
Metric:
Conversion chart . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Back
Cover
System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-8 1-2
Mirror, rearview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-10 10-30
Index 20 Change 1
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INDEX
Pad:
Brake . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ........................ 7-11 7-33
Instrument . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ........................ 10-17.1 10-54.1
Pan:
Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .... . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-7.1 3-12.1
Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ........................ 5-2 5-2
Panels:
Door . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ....................... 10-7 10-18
Front end molding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .... . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-2 10-2
Heater control:
Housing ... .. . . . . .. ...... . . . . . . . . . ........................ 11-4 11-9
Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ........................ 11-3 11-6
Insulators:
Cab (winterization kit) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ........................ 11-5 11-17
Cargo cover (M1008 and M1008A1) . . . . . ........................ 11-27 11-96
Endgate:
M1008 and M1008A1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ..... . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-16 10-48
M1009 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-21 10-70
Engine compartment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ........................ 11-5 11-12
Change 2 Index 21
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INDEX
Floor:
M1008 and M1008A1 ...... . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-28 11-101
M1009 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-31 11-112
Front (M1008 and M1008A1). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-29 11-104
Side:
M1008 and M1008A1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-29 11-104
M1009 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-31 11-112
Wheel house:
M1008 and M1008A1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-29 11-104
M1009 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-31 11-112
Rear door (winterization kit). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-35 11-132
Roof (winterization kit) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-32 11-116
Ventilator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-3 10-4
Parking brake:
Cable:
Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-2 7-2
Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-4 7-5
Pedal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-3 7-3
Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-17 4-39
Parking light and lamp... . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-26 4-52
Passenger’s:
Seat:
M1009 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-23 10-84
M1010 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-25 10-92
Seatbelt:
M1009 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-23 10-84
M1010 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-25 10-92
Pedal:
Accelerator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-24 3-69
Brake . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-12 7-38
Parking brake . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-3 7-3
Personnel heater (M1010):
Control box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-35 10-127
Fuel filter and blower . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-36 10-130
Principles of operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-25 1-18
Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-36 10-130
Pintle assembly:
All except M1009 and M1010. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-4 9-6
M1009 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-5 9-8
Pipe:
Crossover . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-34 3-100
Drainback, fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-19 3-58
Engine oil cooler supply and return . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-6 3-8
Exhaust:
Cab heater (winterization kit). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-11 11-42
Cargo compartment heater (winterization kit) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-24 11-89
Engine coolant heater (winterization kit) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-18 11-64
Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-27 3-74
Index 22
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INDEX
Fill:
All except M1009 and M1010 .... . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-15 3-48
M1009 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ........ . . . . . 3-16 3-50
Fuel tank supply and return:
All except M1009 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-13 3-32
M1009 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-14 3-40
Tail ... . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-27 3-74
Pitman arm . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-11 8-22
Plate:
Instrument cluster ....... . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-7 4-16
Transfer case (M1028A1, M1028A2, and M1031) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-3 5-6
Plug, glow:
Relay . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-8 4-24
Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-20 3-60
PMCS procedures:
Annual . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 2-2 2-21
General . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-7 2-3
Intervals. . . . . . . .. ....... . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-5 2-3
Semiannual ... . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .... . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 2-1 2-5
Specific . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-8 2-4
Power:
Booster . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-8 7-21
Steering:
B e l t . . .... . .... . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-15 8-30
Bleeding, system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-8 8-16
Gear . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-16 8-33
Lines . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-14 8-27
Pulley . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ... . . . . . . ... . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-15 8-30
Pump . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-15 8-30
Preparation of truck for:
Limited storage:
General information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-11 12-9
Instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .... . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-12 12-9
Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .... . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-1 12-1
Shipment:
Cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-3 12-1
General . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-2 12-2
Lubrication . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-4 12-3
Marking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-8 12-3
Packaging . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-6 12-3
Packing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .... ... . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-7 12-3
P r e s e r v a t i o n . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ... .... . . . . . . . . . . 12-5 12-3
Of Army documents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-9 12-4
Pressure, oil, sending unit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-14 4-35
Preventive Maintenance Checks and services (PMCS):
Annual checks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 2-2 2-21
General . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-7 2-3
Intervals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-5 2-3
Change 1 Index 23
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INDEX
Paragraph Page
Subject
Index 24
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
Rear:
Axle:
Bumper . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-11 6-19
Shaft (all except M1009) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-8 6-15
Battery box (winterization kit) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-6 11-17
Bench:
Seat (M1009) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-23 10-84
Seatbelt (M1009) ., . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-23 10-84
Blackout light:
All except M1O1O and M1031 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-30 4-60
M1O1O and M1031 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-31 4-61
Brake:
Lines . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-10 7-28
Shoes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-7 7-14
Wheel cylinder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-7 7-14
Bumper:
Replacement:
All except M1009 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-6 9-10
M1009 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-8 9-16
supports:
All except M1009 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-7 9-14
M1009 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-9 9-20
Door:
Fixed glass (M1O1O) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-27 10-102
Frame (M1008 and M1008A1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-35 11-132
Hinges (M1O10) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-26 10-97
Lock mechanism (M1O1O) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-26 10-97
Maintenance (M1008 and M1008Al) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-34 11-126
Panel assembly (M1008 and M1008A1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-35 11-132
Replacement (M1O1O) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-26 10-97
Propeller shaft:
Repair, . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-5 6-10
Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-4 6-9
Shaft, axle (all except M1009). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-8 6-15
Shock absorber . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-11 6-19
Stabilizer bar (M1028A2 and M1028A3) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-13 6-23
Step assembly (M1O1O) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-28 10-104
Rearview mirror . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-10 10-30
Receptacle:
Slave . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-40 4-84
Trailer electrical . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-41 4-88
Records, maintenance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-2 1-1
Recovery reservoir, coolant., . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-32 3-96
References . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Appendix A A-1
Regulator:
Alternator (M1O1O) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-4 4-10
Door window . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-7 10-18
Endgate window (M1009) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-22 10-78
Relay:
Air conditioner (M1O10) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-13 4-32
Change 2 Index 25
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
Subject Paragraph
s
Schematics, wiring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Appendix F F-1
Seal:
Air cleaner . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-9 3-14
Engine oil level indicator tube . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-3 3-3
Seat:
Attendant’s, maintenance (M1010) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-29 10-106
Bench, cargo (all except M1009) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-18 10-55
Driver’s:
M1009 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-23 10-84
M1010 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-25 10-92
Passenger’s:
M1009 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-23 10-84
M1010 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-25 10-92
Rear bench (M1010) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-23 10-84
Troop, kit, repair . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-1 11-1
Seatbelt:
Anchorpoint Repair (M1009) ...................................................................... 10-23A 10-90
Assemblies:
10-18 10-55
Cargo bench seat (all except M1009) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Driver’s:
M1009 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-23 10-64
M1010 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-25 10-92
PIN: 053627-004
lndex 26 Change 4
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INDEX
Passenger’s:
M1009 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-23 10-84
M1010 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-25 10-92
Buzzer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-11 4-30
Sending unit:
Coolant temperature . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-14 4-35
Fuel tank:
All except M1009 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-11 3-18
M1009 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-12 3-24
Oil pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-14 4-35
Service brake:
Front:
Caliper . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-11 7-33
Combination valve . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-9 7-24
Lines . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-9 7-24
Pad . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-11 7-33
Master cylinder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-8 7-21
Pedal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-12 7-38
Power booster . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-8 7-21
Rear:
Lines . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-10 7-28
Proportioning valve . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-10 7-28
Shoe . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-7 7-14
Wheel cylinder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-7 7-14
System:
Bleeding instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-6 7-10
Principles of operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-21 1-16
Service headlight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-24 4-48
Service upon receipt:
General . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-1 2-1
Inspection instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-2 2-1
Servicing:
Cooling system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-30 3-88
Instructions:
For storage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-12 12-9
Upon receipt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-3 2-1
Shaft:
Propeller:
Front:
Repair . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-3 6-4
Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-2 6-2
Rear:
Repair . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-5 6-10
Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-4 6-9
Rear axle (all except M1009) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-8 6-15
Shelter tie-down (M1028, M1028A1, M1028A2, and M1028A3) . . . . . . . . . . . 10-17 10-52
Shield, fuel tank:
All except M1009 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-11 3-18
M1009 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-12 3-24
Change 2 Index 27
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INDEX
Shipment:
Of Army documents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-9 12-4
Preparation for:
General information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-2 12-2
Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-1 12-1
Preparation of truck:
Cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-3 12-2
General . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-2 12-2
Lubrication . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-4 12-3
Marking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-8 12-3
Packaging . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-6 12-3
Packing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-7 12-3
Preservation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-5 12-3
Shock absorber:
Front . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-10 6-18
Rear . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-11 6-19
Tie-rod . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-12 8-23
Shoe, brake . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-7 7-14
Shroud, fan . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-31 3-90
Side insulators:
M1008 and M1008A1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-29 11-104
M1009 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-31 11-112
Signal, directional, lever . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-9 8-18
Slave receptacle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-40 4-84
Sliding door, interior (M1010) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-30 10-110
Solenoid, fast idle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-23 3-66
Spare tire carrier (all except M1009) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-10 9-23
Special tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Appendix B B-1
Speed, idle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-25 3-71
Speedometer:
Adapter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-10 4-28
Cable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-10 4-28
Gear . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-10.1 4-29.0
Spindle, front axle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-7 6-14
Spotlight and lamp (M1010) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-36 4-67
Spring bumper:
Front . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-10 6-18
Rear . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-11 6-19
Stabilizer bar:
Front . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-12 6-21
Rear (M1028A2 and M1028A3) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-13 6-23
Starter:
Relay . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-5 4-11
Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-5 4-11
Index 28 Change 2
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INDEX
Steering:
Connecting rod . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-10 8-20
Pitman arm . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-11 8-22
Power:
Belt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-15 8-30
Gear . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-16 8-33
Lines:
Bleeding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-8 8-16
TM 9-2320-289-20
INDEX
Index 29
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INDEX
Tables:
Drivebelt tensions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table E-2 E-2
Electrical troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 2-4 2-57
Equipment data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 1-1 1-8
Mechanical troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 2-3 2-35
Metric conversion . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Back
Cover
PMCS:
Annual . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 2-2 2-21
Semiannual . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 2-1 2-5
Standard torque specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table E-1 E-1
Tailgate (endgate):
M1008 and M1008A1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-16 10-48
M1009:
Curtain . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-30 11-108
Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-21 10-70
Window . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-22 10-78
Taillight:
All except M1010 and M1031 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-28 4-55
M1010 and M1031 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-29 4-57
Tailpipe . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-27 3-74
Tank, fuel:
Fill pipe assembly:
All except M1009 and M1010 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-15 3-48
M1009 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-16 3-50
Filler door:
All except M1009 and M1010 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-15 3-48
M1009 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-16 3-50
Fill/vent hoses (all except M1009 and M1010) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-15 3-48
Replacement:
All except M1009 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-11 3-18
M1009 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-12 3-24
Return hoses:
All except M1009 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-13 3-32
M1009 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-14 3-40
Sending unit:
All except M1009 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-11 3-18
M1009 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-12 3-24
Shield:
All except M1009 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-11 3-18
M1009 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-12 3-24
Supply hoses:
All except M1009 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-13 3-32
M1009 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-14 3-40
Temperature sending unit, coolant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-14 4-35
Terminal boards, accessory wiring and radio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-46 4-98
Thermostat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-34 3-100
Index 30
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INDEX
Tie-down:
Clevis:
Front . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-2 9-2
Rear:
All except M1009 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-6 9-10
M1009 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-8 9-16
Shelter (M1028) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-17 10-52
Tie-rod:
Shock absorber . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-12 8-23
Steering system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-13 8-24
Tire:
Carrier, spare (all except M1009) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-10 9-23
Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-2 8-2
Toe alinement, front wheel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-6 8-14
Tool and test equipment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Appendix B B-1
Tools:
Common . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-9 1-2
Repair . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-9 1-2
Special . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-9 1-2
Torque limits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Appendix E E-1
Tow hook bracket (M1009) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-8 9-16
Trailer, electrical receptacle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-41 4-88
Transfer case:
All except M1028A1, M1028A2, and M1031:
Bezel and boot . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-4 5-7
Control lever assembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-6 5-10
Linkage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-6 5-10
M1028A1, M1028A2, and M1031:
Boot . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-3 5-6
Control lever . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-5 5-8
Linkage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-5 5-8
Plate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-3 5-6
Transmission:
Filter assembly maintenance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-2 5-2
Pan . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-2 5-2
Vacuum hoses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-21 3-62
Vacuum valve . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-21.1 3-6.4
Tray, maintenance, battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-39 4-79
Troop seat kit repair . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-1 11-1
Troubleshooting:
Electrical . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 2-4 2-57
Electrical malfunctions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-10 2-26
General . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-9 2-25
Mechanical . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 2-3 2-35
STE/lCE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-12 2-77
Symptom index:
Electrical . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-11 2-33
Mechanical . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-11 2-30
Index 31
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INDEX
Warning:
Hazard control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-20 4-43
Plates, location and contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-13 1-7
Summary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Warning a
Warranty information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-7 1-2
Washer and wiper, windshield . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-11 10-31
Water outlet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-34 3-100
Wheel:
Bearings:
Drum and hub . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-5 8-10
Index 32 Change 2
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INDEX
Index 33
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INDEX
Index 34
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
INDEX
Engine coolant:
Exhaust pipe . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-18 11-64
Fuel filter and lines . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-14 11-54
Hoses and fittings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-15 11-57
Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-16 11-60
Wiring harness . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-17 11-62
Hoses:
Cab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-9 11-33
Coolant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-12 11-47
Engine coolant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-15 11-57
Housing, cab heater control panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-4 11-9
Insulator:
Cab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-5 11-12
Engine compartment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-5 11-12
M1008 and M1008A1:
Cargo cover . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-27 11-96
Floor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-28 11-101
Front . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-29 11-104
Side . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-29 11-104
Wheelhouse . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-29 11-104
M1009:
Floor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-31 11-112
Side . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-31 11-112
Wheelhouse . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-31 11-112
Rear battery box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-6 11-17
Ventilator, cargo compartment heater . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-24 11-89
Wiring harness:
Domelight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-33 11-122
Heater:
Cab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-10 11-37
Cargo compartment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-23 11-85
Engine coolant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-17 11-62
Wiper and washer, windshield . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-11 10-31
Wire, brake light indicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-22.1 4-46.1
Wiring diagrams . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Appendix F F-1
Wiring harness:
Block, engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-42 4-89
Domelight (winterization kit) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-33 11-122
Glow plug . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-8 4-24
Heater:
Cab (winterization kit) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-10 11-37
Cargo compartment (winterization kit) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-23 11-85
Engine coolant (winterization kit) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-17 11-62
Wiring terminal board, accessory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-46 4-98
TM 9-2320-289-20
FP-1/(FP-2 blank)
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
FO-2.
TA49608
FP-3/(FP-4 blank)
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
TM 9-2320-289-20
FP-11/(FP-12 blank)
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
By Order of the Secretaries of the Army, the Navy, and the Air Force:
CARL E. VUONO
General, United States Army
Official: Chief of Staff
R.L. DILWORTH
Brigadier General United States Army
The Adjutant General
LARRY D. WELCH
General, USAF
Chief of staff
Official:
J.J. WENT
Lieutenant General, USMC
Deputy Chief of Staff for Installations and Logistics
Distribution
To be distributed in accordance with DA Form 12-38, Unit Maintenance requirements for Truck Commercial
Utility Vehicle, Cargo, Tatical 4x4, M1008, M1008A1, M1009, M1010, M1028A1, M1031.
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
Downloaded from http://www.everyspec.com on 2010-01-07T4:25:45.
PIN: 053627-000